Merge branch 'master' into bug23712-rra
[debian-policy.git] / policy.sgml
blob1b5b217f4d5e7b58bb3316d0cf2e338429959e82
1 <!doctype debiandoc system [
2 <!-- include version information so we don't have to hard code it
3 within the document -->
4 <!entity % versiondata SYSTEM "version.ent"> %versiondata;
5 <!-- current Debian changes file format -->
6 <!entity changesversion "1.8">
7 ]>
8 <debiandoc>
10 <book>
11 <titlepag>
12 <title>Debian Policy Manual</title>
13 <author><qref id="authors">The Debian Policy Mailing List</qref></author>
14 <version>version &version;, &date;</version>
16 <abstract>
17 This manual describes the policy requirements for the Debian
18 distribution. This includes the structure and
19 contents of the Debian archive and several design issues of
20 the operating system, as well as technical requirements that
21 each package must satisfy to be included in the distribution.
22 </abstract>
24 <copyright>
25 <copyrightsummary>
26 Copyright &copy; 1996,1997,1998 Ian Jackson
27 and Christian Schwarz.
28 </copyrightsummary>
29 <p>
30 These are the copyright dates of the original Policy manual.
31 Since then, this manual has been updated by many others. No
32 comprehensive collection of copyright notices for subsequent
33 work exists.
34 </p>
36 <p>
37 This manual is free software; you may redistribute it and/or
38 modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
39 as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version
40 2, or (at your option) any later version.
41 </p>
43 <p>
44 This is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
45 <em>without any warranty</em>; without even the implied
46 warranty of merchantability or fitness for a particular
47 purpose. See the GNU General Public License for more
48 details.
49 </p>
51 <p>
52 A copy of the GNU General Public License is available as
53 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/GPL</file> in the Debian
54 distribution or on the World Wide Web at
55 <url id="http://www.gnu.org/copyleft/gpl.html"
56 name="the GNU General Public Licence">. You can also
57 obtain it by writing to the Free Software Foundation, Inc.,
58 51 Franklin St, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA.
59 </p>
60 </copyright>
61 </titlepag>
63 <toc detail="sect1">
65 <chapt id="scope">
66 <heading>About this manual</heading>
67 <sect>
68 <heading>Scope</heading>
69 <p>
70 This manual describes the policy requirements for the Debian
71 distribution. This includes the structure and
72 contents of the Debian archive and several design issues of the
73 operating system, as well as technical requirements that
74 each package must satisfy to be included in the
75 distribution.
76 </p>
78 <p>
79 This manual also describes Debian policy as it relates to
80 creating Debian packages. It is not a tutorial on how to build
81 packages, nor is it exhaustive where it comes to describing
82 the behavior of the packaging system. Instead, this manual
83 attempts to define the interface to the package management
84 system that the developers have to be conversant with.<footnote>
85 Informally, the criteria used for inclusion is that the
86 material meet one of the following requirements:
87 <taglist compact="compact">
88 <tag>Standard interfaces</tag>
89 <item>
90 The material presented represents an interface to
91 the packaging system that is mandated for use, and
92 is used by, a significant number of packages, and
93 therefore should not be changed without peer
94 review. Package maintainers can then rely on this
95 interface not changing, and the package management
96 software authors need to ensure compatibility with
97 this interface definition. (Control file and
98 changelog file formats are examples.)
99 </item>
100 <tag>Chosen Convention</tag>
101 <item>
102 If there are a number of technically viable choices
103 that can be made, but one needs to select one of
104 these options for inter-operability. The version
105 number format is one example.
106 </item>
107 </taglist>
108 Please note that these are not mutually exclusive;
109 selected conventions often become parts of standard
110 interfaces.
111 </footnote>
112 </p>
115 The footnotes present in this manual are
116 merely informative, and are not part of Debian policy itself.
117 </p>
120 The appendices to this manual are not necessarily normative,
121 either. Please see <ref id="pkg-scope"> for more information.
122 </p>
125 In the normative part of this manual,
126 the words <em>must</em>, <em>should</em> and
127 <em>may</em>, and the adjectives <em>required</em>,
128 <em>recommended</em> and <em>optional</em>, are used to
129 distinguish the significance of the various guidelines in
130 this policy document. Packages that do not conform to the
131 guidelines denoted by <em>must</em> (or <em>required</em>)
132 will generally not be considered acceptable for the Debian
133 distribution. Non-conformance with guidelines denoted by
134 <em>should</em> (or <em>recommended</em>) will generally be
135 considered a bug, but will not necessarily render a package
136 unsuitable for distribution. Guidelines denoted by
137 <em>may</em> (or <em>optional</em>) are truly optional and
138 adherence is left to the maintainer's discretion.
139 </p>
142 These classifications are roughly equivalent to the bug
143 severities <em>serious</em> (for <em>must</em> or
144 <em>required</em> directive violations), <em>minor</em>,
145 <em>normal</em> or <em>important</em>
146 (for <em>should</em> or <em>recommended</em> directive
147 violations) and <em>wishlist</em> (for <em>optional</em>
148 items).
149 <footnote>
150 Compare RFC 2119. Note, however, that these words are
151 used in a different way in this document.
152 </footnote>
153 </p>
156 Much of the information presented in this manual will be
157 useful even when building a package which is to be
158 distributed in some other way or is intended for local use
159 only.
160 </p>
161 </sect>
163 <sect>
164 <heading>New versions of this document</heading>
167 This manual is distributed via the Debian package
168 <package><url name="debian-policy"
169 id="http://packages.debian.org/debian-policy"></package>
170 (<httpsite>packages.debian.org</httpsite>
171 <httppath>/debian-policy</httppath>).
172 </p>
175 The current version of this document is also available from
176 the Debian web mirrors at
177 <tt><url name="/doc/debian-policy/"
178 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/debian-policy/"></tt>.
180 <httpsite>www.debian.org</httpsite>
181 <httppath>/doc/debian-policy/</httppath>)
182 Also available from the same directory are several other
183 formats: <file>policy.html.tar.gz</file>
184 (<httppath>/doc/debian-policy/policy.html.tar.gz</httppath>),
185 <file>policy.pdf.gz</file>
186 (<httppath>/doc/debian-policy/policy.pdf.gz</httppath>)
187 and <file>policy.ps.gz</file>
188 (<httppath>/doc/debian-policy/policy.ps.gz</httppath>).
189 </p>
192 The <package>debian-policy</package> package also includes the file
193 <file>upgrading-checklist.txt.gz</file> which indicates policy
194 changes between versions of this document.
195 </p>
196 </sect>
198 <sect id="authors">
199 <heading>Authors and Maintainers</heading>
202 Originally called "Debian GNU/Linux Policy Manual", this
203 manual was initially written in 1996 by Ian Jackson.
204 It was revised on November 27th, 1996 by David A. Morris.
205 Christian Schwarz added new sections on March 15th, 1997,
206 and reworked/restructured it in April-July 1997.
207 Christoph Lameter contributed the "Web Standard".
208 Julian Gilbey largely restructured it in 2001.
209 </p>
212 Since September 1998, the responsibility for the contents of
213 this document lies on the <url name="debian-policy mailing list"
214 id="mailto:debian-policy@lists.debian.org">. Proposals
215 are discussed there and inserted into policy after a certain
216 consensus is established.
217 <!-- insert shameless policy-process plug here eventually -->
218 The actual editing is done by a group of maintainers that have
219 no editorial powers. These are the current maintainers:
221 <enumlist>
222 <item>Russ Allbery</item>
223 <item>Bill Allombert</item>
224 <item>Andrew McMillan</item>
225 <item>Manoj Srivastava</item>
226 <item>Colin Watson</item>
227 </enumlist>
228 </p>
231 While the authors of this document have tried hard to avoid
232 typos and other errors, these do still occur. If you discover
233 an error in this manual or if you want to give any
234 comments, suggestions, or criticisms please send an email to
235 the Debian Policy List,
236 <email>debian-policy@lists.debian.org</email>, or submit a
237 bug report against the <tt>debian-policy</tt> package.
238 </p>
241 Please do not try to reach the individual authors or maintainers
242 of the Policy Manual regarding changes to the Policy.
243 </p>
244 </sect>
246 <sect id="related">
247 <heading>Related documents</heading>
250 There are several other documents other than this Policy Manual
251 that are necessary to fully understand some Debian policies and
252 procedures.
253 </p>
256 The external "sub-policy" documents are referred to in:
257 <list compact="compact">
258 <item><ref id="fhs"></item>
259 <item><ref id="virtual_pkg"></item>
260 <item><ref id="menus"></item>
261 <item><ref id="mime"></item>
262 <item><ref id="perl"></item>
263 <item><ref id="maintscriptprompt"></item>
264 <item><ref id="emacs"></item>
265 </list>
266 </p>
269 In addition to those, which carry the weight of policy, there
270 is the Debian Developer's Reference. This document describes
271 procedures and resources for Debian developers, but it is
272 <em>not</em> normative; rather, it includes things that don't
273 belong in the Policy, such as best practices for developers.
274 </p>
277 The Developer's Reference is available in the
278 <package>developers-reference</package> package.
279 It's also available from the Debian web mirrors at
280 <tt><url name="/doc/developers-reference/"
281 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/developers-reference/"></tt>.
282 </p>
283 </sect>
285 <sect id="definitions">
286 <heading>Definitions</heading>
289 The following terms are used in this Policy Manual:
290 <taglist>
291 <tag>ASCII</tag>
292 <item>
293 The character encoding specified by ANSI X3.4-1986 and its
294 predecessor standards, referred to in MIME as US-ASCII, and
295 corresponding to an encoding in eight bits per character of
296 the first 128 <url id="http://www.unicode.org/"
297 name="Unicode"> characters, with the eighth bit always zero.
298 </item>
299 <tag>UTF-8</tag>
300 <item>
301 The transformation format (sometimes called encoding) of
302 <url id="http://www.unicode.org/" name="Unicode"> defined by
303 <url id="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3629.txt"
304 name="RFC 3629">. UTF-8 has the useful property of having
305 ASCII as a subset, so any text encoded in ASCII is trivially
306 also valid UTF-8.
307 </item>
308 </taglist>
309 </p>
310 </sect>
311 </chapt>
314 <chapt id="archive">
315 <heading>The Debian Archive</heading>
318 The Debian system is maintained and distributed as a
319 collection of <em>packages</em>. Since there are so many of
320 them (currently well over 15000), they are split into
321 <em>sections</em> and given <em>priorities</em> to simplify
322 the handling of them.
323 </p>
326 The effort of the Debian project is to build a free operating
327 system, but not every package we want to make accessible is
328 <em>free</em> in our sense (see the Debian Free Software
329 Guidelines, below), or may be imported/exported without
330 restrictions. Thus, the archive is split into areas<footnote>
331 The Debian archive software uses the term "component" internally
332 and in the Release file format to refer to the division of an
333 archive. The Debian Social Contract simply refers to "areas."
334 This document uses terminology similar to the Social Contract.
335 </footnote> based on their licenses and other restrictions.
336 </p>
339 The aims of this are:
341 <list compact="compact">
342 <item>to allow us to make as much software available as we can</item>
343 <item>to allow us to encourage everyone to write free software,
344 and</item>
345 <item>to allow us to make it easy for people to produce
346 CD-ROMs of our system without violating any licenses,
347 import/export restrictions, or any other laws.</item>
348 </list>
349 </p>
352 The <em>main</em> archive area forms the <em>Debian distribution</em>.
353 </p>
356 Packages in the other archive areas (<tt>contrib</tt>,
357 <tt>non-free</tt>) are not considered to be part of the Debian
358 distribution, although we support their use and provide
359 infrastructure for them (such as our bug-tracking system and
360 mailing lists). This Debian Policy Manual applies to these
361 packages as well.
362 </p>
364 <sect id="dfsg">
365 <heading>The Debian Free Software Guidelines</heading>
367 The Debian Free Software Guidelines (DFSG) form our
368 definition of "free software". These are:
369 <taglist>
370 <tag>1. Free Redistribution
371 </tag>
372 <item>
373 The license of a Debian component may not restrict any
374 party from selling or giving away the software as a
375 component of an aggregate software distribution
376 containing programs from several different
377 sources. The license may not require a royalty or
378 other fee for such sale.
379 </item>
380 <tag>2. Source Code
381 </tag>
382 <item>
383 The program must include source code, and must allow
384 distribution in source code as well as compiled form.
385 </item>
386 <tag>3. Derived Works
387 </tag>
388 <item>
389 The license must allow modifications and derived
390 works, and must allow them to be distributed under the
391 same terms as the license of the original software.
392 </item>
393 <tag>4. Integrity of The Author's Source Code
394 </tag>
395 <item>
396 The license may restrict source-code from being
397 distributed in modified form <em>only</em> if the
398 license allows the distribution of "patch files"
399 with the source code for the purpose of modifying the
400 program at build time. The license must explicitly
401 permit distribution of software built from modified
402 source code. The license may require derived works to
403 carry a different name or version number from the
404 original software. (This is a compromise. The Debian
405 Project encourages all authors to not restrict any
406 files, source or binary, from being modified.)
407 </item>
408 <tag>5. No Discrimination Against Persons or Groups
409 </tag>
410 <item>
411 The license must not discriminate against any person
412 or group of persons.
413 </item>
414 <tag>6. No Discrimination Against Fields of Endeavor
415 </tag>
416 <item>
417 The license must not restrict anyone from making use
418 of the program in a specific field of endeavor. For
419 example, it may not restrict the program from being
420 used in a business, or from being used for genetic
421 research.
422 </item>
423 <tag>7. Distribution of License
424 </tag>
425 <item>
426 The rights attached to the program must apply to all
427 to whom the program is redistributed without the need
428 for execution of an additional license by those
429 parties.
430 </item>
431 <tag>8. License Must Not Be Specific to Debian
432 </tag>
433 <item>
434 The rights attached to the program must not depend on
435 the program's being part of a Debian system. If the
436 program is extracted from Debian and used or
437 distributed without Debian but otherwise within the
438 terms of the program's license, all parties to whom
439 the program is redistributed must have the same
440 rights as those that are granted in conjunction with
441 the Debian system.
442 </item>
443 <tag>9. License Must Not Contaminate Other Software
444 </tag>
445 <item>
446 The license must not place restrictions on other
447 software that is distributed along with the licensed
448 software. For example, the license must not insist
449 that all other programs distributed on the same medium
450 must be free software.
451 </item>
452 <tag>10. Example Licenses
453 </tag>
454 <item>
455 The "GPL," "BSD," and "Artistic" licenses are examples of
456 licenses that we consider <em>free</em>.
457 </item>
458 </taglist>
459 </p>
460 </sect>
462 <sect id="sections">
463 <heading>Archive areas</heading>
465 <sect1 id="main">
466 <heading>The main archive area</heading>
469 The <em>main</em> archive area comprises the Debian
470 distribution. Only the packages in this area are considered
471 part of the distribution. None of the packages in
472 the <em>main</em> archive area require software outside of
473 that area to function. Anyone may use, share, modify and
474 redistribute the packages in this archive area
475 freely<footnote>
476 See <url id="http://www.debian.org/intro/free"
477 name="What Does Free Mean?"> for
478 more about what we mean by free software.
479 </footnote>.
480 </p>
483 Every package in <em>main</em> must comply with the DFSG
484 (Debian Free Software Guidelines).
485 </p>
488 In addition, the packages in <em>main</em>
489 <list compact="compact">
490 <item>
491 must not require a package outside of <em>main</em>
492 for compilation or execution (thus, the package must
493 not declare a "Depends", "Recommends", or
494 "Build-Depends" relationship on a non-<em>main</em>
495 package),
496 </item>
497 <item>
498 must not be so buggy that we refuse to support them,
500 </item>
501 <item>
502 must meet all policy requirements presented in this
503 manual.
504 </item>
505 </list>
506 </p>
508 </sect1>
510 <sect1 id="contrib">
511 <heading>The contrib archive area</heading>
514 The <em>contrib</em> archive area contains supplemental
515 packages intended to work with the Debian distribution, but
516 which require software outside of the distribution to either
517 build or function.
518 </p>
521 Every package in <em>contrib</em> must comply with the DFSG.
522 </p>
525 In addition, the packages in <em>contrib</em>
526 <list compact="compact">
527 <item>
528 must not be so buggy that we refuse to support them,
530 </item>
531 <item>
532 must meet all policy requirements presented in this
533 manual.
534 </item>
535 </list>
536 </p>
539 Examples of packages which would be included in
540 <em>contrib</em> are:
541 <list compact="compact">
542 <item>
543 free packages which require <em>contrib</em>,
544 <em>non-free</em> packages or packages which are not
545 in our archive at all for compilation or execution,
547 </item>
548 <item>
549 wrapper packages or other sorts of free accessories for
550 non-free programs.
551 </item>
552 </list>
553 </p>
554 </sect1>
556 <sect1 id="non-free">
557 <heading>The non-free archive area</heading>
560 The <em>non-free</em> archive area contains supplemental
561 packages intended to work with the Debian distribution that do
562 not comply with the DFSG or have other problems that make
563 their distribution problematic. They may not comply with all
564 of the policy requirements in this manual due to restrictions
565 on modifications or other limitations.
566 </p>
569 Packages must be placed in <em>non-free</em> if they are
570 not compliant with the DFSG or are encumbered by patents
571 or other legal issues that make their distribution
572 problematic.
573 </p>
576 In addition, the packages in <em>non-free</em>
577 <list compact="compact">
578 <item>
579 must not be so buggy that we refuse to support them,
581 </item>
582 <item>
583 must meet all policy requirements presented in this
584 manual that it is possible for them to meet.
585 <footnote>
586 It is possible that there are policy
587 requirements which the package is unable to
588 meet, for example, if the source is
589 unavailable. These situations will need to be
590 handled on a case-by-case basis.
591 </footnote>
592 </item>
593 </list>
594 </p>
595 </sect1>
597 </sect>
599 <sect id="pkgcopyright">
600 <heading>Copyright considerations</heading>
603 Every package must be accompanied by a verbatim copy of its
604 copyright information and distribution license in the file
605 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/copyright</file>
606 (see <ref id="copyrightfile"> for further details).
607 </p>
610 We reserve the right to restrict files from being included
611 anywhere in our archives if
612 <list compact="compact">
613 <item>
614 their use or distribution would break a law,
615 </item>
616 <item>
617 there is an ethical conflict in their distribution or
618 use,
619 </item>
620 <item>
621 we would have to sign a license for them, or
622 </item>
623 <item>
624 their distribution would conflict with other project
625 policies.
626 </item>
627 </list>
628 </p>
631 Programs whose authors encourage the user to make
632 donations are fine for the main distribution, provided
633 that the authors do not claim that not donating is
634 immoral, unethical, illegal or something similar; in such
635 a case they must go in <em>non-free</em>.
636 </p>
639 Packages whose copyright permission notices (or patent
640 problems) do not even allow redistribution of binaries
641 only, and where no special permission has been obtained,
642 must not be placed on the Debian FTP site and its mirrors
643 at all.
644 </p>
647 Note that under international copyright law (this applies
648 in the United States, too), <em>no</em> distribution or
649 modification of a work is allowed without an explicit
650 notice saying so. Therefore a program without a copyright
651 notice <em>is</em> copyrighted and you may not do anything
652 to it without risking being sued! Likewise if a program
653 has a copyright notice but no statement saying what is
654 permitted then nothing is permitted.
655 </p>
658 Many authors are unaware of the problems that restrictive
659 copyrights (or lack of copyright notices) can cause for
660 the users of their supposedly-free software. It is often
661 worthwhile contacting such authors diplomatically to ask
662 them to modify their license terms. However, this can be a
663 politically difficult thing to do and you should ask for
664 advice on the <tt>debian-legal</tt> mailing list first, as
665 explained below.
666 </p>
669 When in doubt about a copyright, send mail to
670 <email>debian-legal@lists.debian.org</email>. Be prepared
671 to provide us with the copyright statement. Software
672 covered by the GPL, public domain software and BSD-like
673 copyrights are safe; be wary of the phrases "commercial
674 use prohibited" and "distribution restricted".
675 </p>
676 </sect>
678 <sect id="subsections">
679 <heading>Sections</heading>
682 The packages in the archive areas <em>main</em>,
683 <em>contrib</em> and <em>non-free</em> are grouped further into
684 <em>sections</em> to simplify handling.
685 </p>
688 The archive area and section for each package should be
689 specified in the package's <tt>Section</tt> control record (see
690 <ref id="f-Section">). However, the maintainer of the Debian
691 archive may override this selection to ensure the consistency of
692 the Debian distribution. The <tt>Section</tt> field should be
693 of the form:
694 <list compact="compact">
695 <item>
696 <em>section</em> if the package is in the
697 <em>main</em> archive area,
698 </item>
699 <item>
700 <em>area/section</em> if the package is in
701 the <em>contrib</em> or <em>non-free</em>
702 archive areas.
703 </item>
704 </list>
705 </p>
708 The Debian archive maintainers provide the authoritative
709 list of sections. At present, they are:
710 <em>admin</em>, <em>cli-mono</em>, <em>comm</em>, <em>database</em>,
711 <em>devel</em>, <em>debug</em>, <em>doc</em>, <em>editors</em>,
712 <em>electronics</em>, <em>embedded</em>, <em>fonts</em>,
713 <em>games</em>, <em>gnome</em>, <em>graphics</em>, <em>gnu-r</em>,
714 <em>gnustep</em>, <em>hamradio</em>, <em>haskell</em>,
715 <em>httpd</em>, <em>interpreters</em>, <em>java</em>, <em>kde</em>,
716 <em>kernel</em>, <em>libs</em>, <em>libdevel</em>, <em>lisp</em>,
717 <em>localization</em>, <em>mail</em>, <em>math</em>, <em>misc</em>,
718 <em>net</em>, <em>news</em>, <em>ocaml</em>, <em>oldlibs</em>,
719 <em>otherosfs</em>, <em>perl</em>, <em>php</em>, <em>python</em>,
720 <em>ruby</em>, <em>science</em>, <em>shells</em>, <em>sound</em>,
721 <em>tex</em>, <em>text</em>, <em>utils</em>, <em>vcs</em>,
722 <em>video</em>, <em>web</em>, <em>x11</em>, <em>xfce</em>,
723 <em>zope</em>. The additional section <em>debian-installer</em>
724 contains special packages used by the installer and is not used
725 for normal Debian packages.
726 </p>
729 For more information about the sections and their definitions,
730 see the <url id="http://packages.debian.org/unstable/"
731 name="list of sections in unstable">.
732 </p>
733 </sect>
735 <sect id="priorities">
736 <heading>Priorities</heading>
739 Each package should have a <em>priority</em> value, which is
740 included in the package's <em>control record</em>
741 (see <ref id="f-Priority">).
742 This information is used by the Debian package management tools to
743 separate high-priority packages from less-important packages.
744 </p>
747 The following <em>priority levels</em> are recognized by the
748 Debian package management tools.
749 <taglist>
750 <tag><tt>required</tt></tag>
751 <item>
752 Packages which are necessary for the proper
753 functioning of the system (usually, this means that
754 dpkg functionality depends on these packages).
755 Removing a <tt>required</tt> package may cause your
756 system to become totally broken and you may not even
757 be able to use <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to put things back,
758 so only do so if you know what you are doing. Systems
759 with only the <tt>required</tt> packages are probably
760 unusable, but they do have enough functionality to
761 allow the sysadmin to boot and install more software.
762 </item>
763 <tag><tt>important</tt></tag>
764 <item>
765 Important programs, including those which one would
766 expect to find on any Unix-like system. If the
767 expectation is that an experienced Unix person who
768 found it missing would say "What on earth is going on,
769 where is <prgn>foo</prgn>?", it must be an
770 <tt>important</tt> package.<footnote>
771 This is an important criterion because we are
772 trying to produce, amongst other things, a free
773 Unix.
774 </footnote>
775 Other packages without which the system will not run
776 well or be usable must also have priority
777 <tt>important</tt>. This does
778 <em>not</em> include Emacs, the X Window System, TeX
779 or any other large applications. The
780 <tt>important</tt> packages are just a bare minimum of
781 commonly-expected and necessary tools.
782 </item>
783 <tag><tt>standard</tt></tag>
784 <item>
785 These packages provide a reasonably small but not too
786 limited character-mode system. This is what will be
787 installed by default if the user doesn't select anything
788 else. It doesn't include many large applications.
789 </item>
790 <tag><tt>optional</tt></tag>
791 <item>
792 (In a sense everything that isn't required is
793 optional, but that's not what is meant here.) This is
794 all the software that you might reasonably want to
795 install if you didn't know what it was and don't have
796 specialized requirements. This is a much larger system
797 and includes the X Window System, a full TeX
798 distribution, and many applications. Note that
799 optional packages should not conflict with each other.
800 </item>
801 <tag><tt>extra</tt></tag>
802 <item>
803 This contains all packages that conflict with others
804 with required, important, standard or optional
805 priorities, or are only likely to be useful if you
806 already know what they are or have specialized
807 requirements (such as packages containing only detached
808 debugging symbols).
809 </item>
810 </taglist>
811 </p>
814 Packages must not depend on packages with lower priority
815 values (excluding build-time dependencies). In order to
816 ensure this, the priorities of one or more packages may need
817 to be adjusted.
818 </p>
819 </sect>
821 </chapt>
824 <chapt id="binary">
825 <heading>Binary packages</heading>
828 The Debian distribution is based on the Debian
829 package management system, called <prgn>dpkg</prgn>. Thus,
830 all packages in the Debian distribution must be provided
831 in the <tt>.deb</tt> file format.
832 </p>
835 A <tt>.deb</tt> package contains two sets of files: a set of files
836 to install on the system when the package is installed, and a set
837 of files that provide additional metadata about the package or
838 which are executed when the package is installed or removed. This
839 second set of files is called <em>control information files</em>.
840 Among those files are the package maintainer scripts
841 and <file>control</file>, the <qref id="binarycontrolfiles">binary
842 package control file</qref> that contains the control fields for
843 the package. Other control information files
844 include <qref id="sharedlibs-shlibdeps">the <file>shlibs</file>
845 file</qref> used to store shared library dependency information
846 and the <file>conffiles</file> file that lists the package's
847 configuration files (described in <ref id="config-files">).
848 </p>
851 There is unfortunately a collision of terminology here between
852 control information files and files in the Debian control file
853 format. Throughout this document, a <em>control file</em> refers
854 to a file in the Debian control file format. These files are
855 documented in <ref id="controlfields">. Only files referred to
856 specifically as <em>control information files</em> are the files
857 included in the control information file member of
858 the <file>.deb</file> file format used by binary packages. Most
859 control information files are not in the Debian control file
860 format.
861 </p>
863 <sect>
864 <heading>The package name</heading>
867 Every package must have a name that's unique within the Debian
868 archive.
869 </p>
872 The package name is included in the control field
873 <tt>Package</tt>, the format of which is described
874 in <ref id="f-Package">.
875 The package name is also included as a part of the file name
876 of the <tt>.deb</tt> file.
877 </p>
878 </sect>
880 <sect id="versions">
881 <heading>The version of a package</heading>
884 Every package has a version number recorded in its
885 <tt>Version</tt> control file field, described in
886 <ref id="f-Version">.
887 </p>
890 The package management system imposes an ordering on version
891 numbers, so that it can tell whether packages are being up- or
892 downgraded and so that package system front end applications
893 can tell whether a package it finds available is newer than
894 the one installed on the system. The version number format
895 has the most significant parts (as far as comparison is
896 concerned) at the beginning.
897 </p>
900 If an upstream package has problematic version numbers they
901 should be converted to a sane form for use in the
902 <tt>Version</tt> field.
903 </p>
905 <sect1>
906 <heading>Version numbers based on dates</heading>
909 In general, Debian packages should use the same version
910 numbers as the upstream sources. However, upstream version
911 numbers based on some date formats (sometimes used for
912 development or "snapshot" releases) will not be ordered
913 correctly by the package management software. For
914 example, <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will consider "96May01" to be
915 greater than "96Dec24".
916 </p>
919 To prevent having to use epochs for every new upstream
920 version, the date-based portion of any upstream version number
921 should be given in a way that sorts correctly: four-digit year
922 first, followed by a two-digit numeric month, followed by a
923 two-digit numeric date, possibly with punctuation between the
924 components.
925 </p>
928 Native Debian packages (i.e., packages which have been written
929 especially for Debian) whose version numbers include dates
930 should also follow these rules. If punctuation is desired
931 between the date components, remember that hyphen (<tt>-</tt>)
932 cannot be used in native package versions. Period
933 (<tt>.</tt>) is normally a good choice.
934 </p>
935 </sect1>
937 </sect>
939 <sect id="maintainer">
940 <heading>The maintainer of a package</heading>
943 Every package must have a maintainer, except for orphaned
944 packages as described below. The maintainer may be one person
945 or a group of people reachable from a common email address, such
946 as a mailing list. The maintainer is responsible for
947 maintaining the Debian packaging files, evaluating and
948 responding appropriately to reported bugs, uploading new
949 versions of the package (either directly or through a sponsor),
950 ensuring that the package is placed in the appropriate archive
951 area and included in Debian releases as appropriate for the
952 stability and utility of the package, and requesting removal of
953 the package from the Debian distribution if it is no longer
954 useful or maintainable.
955 </p>
958 The maintainer must be specified in the <tt>Maintainer</tt>
959 control field with their correct name and a working email
960 address. The email address given in the <tt>Maintainer</tt>
961 control field must accept mail from those role accounts in
962 Debian used to send automated mails regarding the package. This
963 includes non-spam mail from the bug-tracking system, all mail
964 from the Debian archive maintenance software, and other role
965 accounts or automated processes that are commonly agreed on by
966 the project.<footnote>
967 A sample implementation of such a whitelist written for the
968 Mailman mailing list management software is used for mailing
969 lists hosted by alioth.debian.org.
970 </footnote>
971 If one person or team maintains several packages, they should
972 use the same form of their name and email address in
973 the <tt>Maintainer</tt> fields of those packages.
974 </p>
977 The format of the <tt>Maintainer</tt> control field is
978 described in <ref id="f-Maintainer">.
979 </p>
982 If the maintainer of the package is a team of people with a
983 shared email address, the <tt>Uploaders</tt> control field must
984 be present and must contain at least one human with their
985 personal email address. See <ref id="f-Uploaders"> for the
986 syntax of that field.
987 </p>
990 An orphaned package is one with no current maintainer. Orphaned
991 packages should have their <tt>Maintainer</tt> control field set
992 to <tt>Debian QA Group &lt;packages@qa.debian.org&gt;</tt>.
993 These packages are considered maintained by the Debian project
994 as a whole until someone else volunteers to take over
995 maintenance.<footnote>
996 The detailed procedure for gracefully orphaning a package can
997 be found in the Debian Developer's Reference
998 (see <ref id="related">).
999 </footnote>
1000 </p>
1001 </sect>
1003 <sect id="descriptions">
1004 <heading>The description of a package</heading>
1007 Every Debian package must have a <tt>Description</tt> control
1008 field which contains a synopsis and extended description of the
1009 package. Technical information about the format of the
1010 <tt>Description</tt> field is in <ref id="f-Description">.
1011 </p>
1014 The description should describe the package (the program) to a
1015 user (system administrator) who has never met it before so that
1016 they have enough information to decide whether they want to
1017 install it. This description should not just be copied verbatim
1018 from the program's documentation.
1019 </p>
1022 Put important information first, both in the synopsis and
1023 extended description. Sometimes only the first part of the
1024 synopsis or of the description will be displayed. You can
1025 assume that there will usually be a way to see the whole
1026 extended description.
1027 </p>
1030 The description should also give information about the
1031 significant dependencies and conflicts between this package
1032 and others, so that the user knows why these dependencies and
1033 conflicts have been declared.
1034 </p>
1037 Instructions for configuring or using the package should
1038 not be included (that is what installation scripts,
1039 manual pages, info files, etc., are for). Copyright
1040 statements and other administrivia should not be included
1041 either (that is what the copyright file is for).
1042 </p>
1044 <sect1 id="synopsis"><heading>The single line synopsis</heading>
1047 The single line synopsis should be kept brief - certainly
1048 under 80 characters.
1049 </p>
1052 Do not include the package name in the synopsis line. The
1053 display software knows how to display this already, and you
1054 do not need to state it. Remember that in many situations
1055 the user may only see the synopsis line - make it as
1056 informative as you can.
1057 </p>
1059 </sect1>
1061 <sect1 id="extendeddesc"><heading>The extended description</heading>
1064 Do not try to continue the single line synopsis into the
1065 extended description. This will not work correctly when
1066 the full description is displayed, and makes no sense
1067 where only the summary (the single line synopsis) is
1068 available.
1069 </p>
1072 The extended description should describe what the package
1073 does and how it relates to the rest of the system (in terms
1074 of, for example, which subsystem it is which part of).
1075 </p>
1078 The description field needs to make sense to anyone, even
1079 people who have no idea about any of the things the
1080 package deals with.<footnote>
1081 The blurb that comes with a program in its
1082 announcements and/or <prgn>README</prgn> files is
1083 rarely suitable for use in a description. It is
1084 usually aimed at people who are already in the
1085 community where the package is used.
1086 </footnote>
1087 </p>
1089 </sect1>
1091 </sect>
1093 <sect id="dependencies">
1094 <heading>Dependencies</heading>
1097 Every package must specify the dependency information
1098 about other packages that are required for the first to
1099 work correctly.
1100 </p>
1103 For example, a dependency entry must be provided for any
1104 shared libraries required by a dynamically-linked executable
1105 binary in a package.
1106 </p>
1109 Packages are not required to declare any dependencies they
1110 have on other packages which are marked <tt>Essential</tt>
1111 (see below), and should not do so unless they depend on a
1112 particular version of that package.<footnote>
1114 Essential is needed in part to avoid unresolvable dependency
1115 loops on upgrade. If packages add unnecessary dependencies
1116 on packages in this set, the chances that there
1117 <strong>will</strong> be an unresolvable dependency loop
1118 caused by forcing these Essential packages to be configured
1119 first before they need to be is greatly increased. It also
1120 increases the chances that frontends will be unable to
1121 <strong>calculate</strong> an upgrade path, even if one
1122 exists.
1123 </p>
1125 Also, functionality is rarely ever removed from the
1126 Essential set, but <em>packages</em> have been removed from
1127 the Essential set when the functionality moved to a
1128 different package. So depending on these packages <em>just
1129 in case</em> they stop being essential does way more harm
1130 than good.
1131 </p>
1132 </footnote>
1133 </p>
1136 Sometimes, unpacking one package requires that another package
1137 be first unpacked <em>and</em> configured. In this case, the
1138 depending package must specify this dependency in
1139 the <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> control field.
1140 </p>
1143 You should not specify a <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> entry for a
1144 package before this has been discussed on the
1145 <tt>debian-devel</tt> mailing list and a consensus about
1146 doing that has been reached.
1147 </p>
1150 The format of the package interrelationship control fields is
1151 described in <ref id="relationships">.
1152 </p>
1153 </sect>
1155 <sect id="virtual_pkg">
1156 <heading>Virtual packages</heading>
1159 Sometimes, there are several packages which offer
1160 more-or-less the same functionality. In this case, it's
1161 useful to define a <em>virtual package</em> whose name
1162 describes that common functionality. (The virtual
1163 packages only exist logically, not physically; that's why
1164 they are called <em>virtual</em>.) The packages with this
1165 particular function will then <em>provide</em> the virtual
1166 package. Thus, any other package requiring that function
1167 can simply depend on the virtual package without having to
1168 specify all possible packages individually.
1169 </p>
1172 All packages should use virtual package names where
1173 appropriate, and arrange to create new ones if necessary.
1174 They should not use virtual package names (except privately,
1175 amongst a cooperating group of packages) unless they have
1176 been agreed upon and appear in the list of virtual package
1177 names. (See also <ref id="virtual">)
1178 </p>
1181 The latest version of the authoritative list of virtual
1182 package names can be found in the <tt>debian-policy</tt> package.
1183 It is also available from the Debian web mirrors at
1184 <tt><url name="/doc/packaging-manuals/virtual-package-names-list.txt"
1185 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/virtual-package-names-list.txt"></tt>.
1186 </p>
1189 The procedure for updating the list is described in the preface
1190 to the list.
1191 </p>
1193 </sect>
1195 <sect>
1196 <heading>Base system</heading>
1199 The <tt>base system</tt> is a minimum subset of the Debian
1200 system that is installed before everything else
1201 on a new system. Only very few packages are allowed to form
1202 part of the base system, in order to keep the required disk
1203 usage very small.
1204 </p>
1207 The base system consists of all those packages with priority
1208 <tt>required</tt> or <tt>important</tt>. Many of them will
1209 be tagged <tt>essential</tt> (see below).
1210 </p>
1211 </sect>
1213 <sect>
1214 <heading>Essential packages</heading>
1217 Essential is defined as the minimal set of functionality that
1218 must be available and usable on the system at all times, even
1219 when packages are in an unconfigured (but unpacked) state.
1220 Packages are tagged <tt>essential</tt> for a system using the
1221 <tt>Essential</tt> control field. The format of the
1222 <tt>Essential</tt> control field is described in <ref
1223 id="f-Essential">.
1224 </p>
1227 Since these packages cannot be easily removed (one has to
1228 specify an extra <em>force option</em> to
1229 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to do so), this flag must not be used
1230 unless absolutely necessary. A shared library package
1231 must not be tagged <tt>essential</tt>; dependencies will
1232 prevent its premature removal, and we need to be able to
1233 remove it when it has been superseded.
1234 </p>
1237 Since dpkg will not prevent upgrading of other packages
1238 while an <tt>essential</tt> package is in an unconfigured
1239 state, all <tt>essential</tt> packages must supply all of
1240 their core functionality even when unconfigured. If the
1241 package cannot satisfy this requirement it must not be
1242 tagged as essential, and any packages depending on this
1243 package must instead have explicit dependency fields as
1244 appropriate.
1245 </p>
1248 Maintainers should take great care in adding any programs,
1249 interfaces, or functionality to <tt>essential</tt> packages.
1250 Packages may assume that functionality provided by
1251 <tt>essential</tt> packages is always available without
1252 declaring explicit dependencies, which means that removing
1253 functionality from the Essential set is very difficult and is
1254 almost never done. Any capability added to an
1255 <tt>essential</tt> package therefore creates an obligation to
1256 support that capability as part of the Essential set in
1257 perpetuity.
1258 </p>
1261 You must not tag any packages <tt>essential</tt> before
1262 this has been discussed on the <tt>debian-devel</tt>
1263 mailing list and a consensus about doing that has been
1264 reached.
1265 </p>
1266 </sect>
1268 <sect id="maintscripts">
1269 <heading>Maintainer Scripts</heading>
1272 The package installation scripts should avoid producing
1273 output which is unnecessary for the user to see and
1274 should rely on <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to stave off boredom on
1275 the part of a user installing many packages. This means,
1276 amongst other things, using the <tt>--quiet</tt> option on
1277 <prgn>install-info</prgn>.
1278 </p>
1281 Errors which occur during the execution of an installation
1282 script must be checked and the installation must not
1283 continue after an error.
1284 </p>
1287 Note that in general <ref id="scripts"> applies to package
1288 maintainer scripts, too.
1289 </p>
1292 You should not use <prgn>dpkg-divert</prgn> on a file belonging
1293 to another package without consulting the maintainer of that
1294 package first. When adding or removing diversions, package
1295 maintainer scripts must provide the <tt>--package</tt> flag
1296 to <prgn>dpkg-divert</prgn> and must not use <tt>--local</tt>.
1297 </p>
1300 All packages which supply an instance of a common command
1301 name (or, in general, filename) should generally use
1302 <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn>, so that they may be
1303 installed together. If <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn>
1304 is not used, then each package must use
1305 <tt>Conflicts</tt> to ensure that other packages are
1306 de-installed. (In this case, it may be appropriate to
1307 specify a conflict against earlier versions of something
1308 that previously did not use
1309 <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn>; this is an exception to
1310 the usual rule that versioned conflicts should be
1311 avoided.)
1312 </p>
1314 <sect1 id="maintscriptprompt">
1315 <heading>Prompting in maintainer scripts</heading>
1317 Package maintainer scripts may prompt the user if
1318 necessary. Prompting must be done by communicating
1319 through a program, such as <prgn>debconf</prgn>, which
1320 conforms to the Debian Configuration Management
1321 Specification, version 2 or higher.
1322 </p>
1325 Packages which are essential, or which are dependencies of
1326 essential packages, may fall back on another prompting method
1327 if no such interface is available when they are executed.
1328 </p>
1331 The Debian Configuration Management Specification is included
1332 in the <file>debconf_specification</file> files in the
1333 <package>debian-policy</package> package.
1334 It is also available from the Debian web mirrors at
1335 <tt><url name="/doc/packaging-manuals/debconf_specification.html"
1336 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/debconf_specification.html"></tt>.
1337 </p>
1340 Packages which use the Debian Configuration Management
1341 Specification may contain the additional control information
1342 files <file>config</file>
1343 and <file>templates</file>. <file>config</file> is an
1344 additional maintainer script used for package configuration,
1345 and <file>templates</file> contains templates used for user
1346 prompting. The <prgn>config</prgn> script might be run before
1347 the <prgn>preinst</prgn> script and before the package is
1348 unpacked or any of its dependencies or pre-dependencies are
1349 satisfied. Therefore it must work using only the tools
1350 present in <em>essential</em> packages.<footnote>
1351 <package>Debconf</package> or another tool that
1352 implements the Debian Configuration Management
1353 Specification will also be installed, and any
1354 versioned dependencies on it will be satisfied
1355 before preconfiguration begins.
1356 </footnote>
1357 </p>
1360 Packages which use the Debian Configuration Management
1361 Specification must allow for translation of their user-visible
1362 messages by using a gettext-based system such as the one
1363 provided by the <package>po-debconf</package> package.
1364 </p>
1367 Packages should try to minimize the amount of prompting
1368 they need to do, and they should ensure that the user
1369 will only ever be asked each question once. This means
1370 that packages should try to use appropriate shared
1371 configuration files (such as <file>/etc/papersize</file> and
1372 <file>/etc/news/server</file>), and shared
1373 <package>debconf</package> variables rather than each
1374 prompting for their own list of required pieces of
1375 information.
1376 </p>
1379 It also means that an upgrade should not ask the same
1380 questions again, unless the user has used
1381 <tt>dpkg --purge</tt> to remove the package's configuration.
1382 The answers to configuration questions should be stored in an
1383 appropriate place in <file>/etc</file> so that the user can
1384 modify them, and how this has been done should be
1385 documented.
1386 </p>
1389 If a package has a vitally important piece of
1390 information to pass to the user (such as "don't run me
1391 as I am, you must edit the following configuration files
1392 first or you risk your system emitting badly-formatted
1393 messages"), it should display this in the
1394 <prgn>config</prgn> or <prgn>postinst</prgn> script and
1395 prompt the user to hit return to acknowledge the
1396 message. Copyright messages do not count as vitally
1397 important (they belong in
1398 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/copyright</file>);
1399 neither do instructions on how to use a program (these
1400 should be in on-line documentation, where all the users
1401 can see them).
1402 </p>
1405 Any necessary prompting should almost always be confined
1406 to the <prgn>config</prgn> or <prgn>postinst</prgn>
1407 script. If it is done in the <prgn>postinst</prgn>, it
1408 should be protected with a conditional so that
1409 unnecessary prompting doesn't happen if a package's
1410 installation fails and the <prgn>postinst</prgn> is
1411 called with <tt>abort-upgrade</tt>,
1412 <tt>abort-remove</tt> or <tt>abort-deconfigure</tt>.
1413 </p>
1414 </sect1>
1416 </sect>
1418 </chapt>
1421 <chapt id="source">
1422 <heading>Source packages</heading>
1424 <sect id="standardsversion">
1425 <heading>Standards conformance</heading>
1428 Source packages should specify the most recent version number
1429 of this policy document with which your package complied
1430 when it was last updated.
1431 </p>
1434 This information may be used to file bug reports
1435 automatically if your package becomes too much out of date.
1436 </p>
1439 The version is specified in the <tt>Standards-Version</tt>
1440 control field.
1441 The format of the <tt>Standards-Version</tt> field is
1442 described in <ref id="f-Standards-Version">.
1443 </p>
1446 You should regularly, and especially if your package has
1447 become out of date, check for the newest Policy Manual
1448 available and update your package, if necessary. When your
1449 package complies with the new standards you should update the
1450 <tt>Standards-Version</tt> source package field and
1451 release it.<footnote>
1452 See the file <file>upgrading-checklist</file> for
1453 information about policy which has changed between
1454 different versions of this document.
1455 </footnote>
1456 </p>
1458 </sect>
1460 <sect id="pkg-relations">
1461 <heading>Package relationships</heading>
1464 Source packages should specify which binary packages they
1465 require to be installed or not to be installed in order to
1466 build correctly. For example, if building a package
1467 requires a certain compiler, then the compiler should be
1468 specified as a build-time dependency.
1469 </p>
1472 It is not necessary to explicitly specify build-time
1473 relationships on a minimal set of packages that are always
1474 needed to compile, link and put in a Debian package a
1475 standard "Hello World!" program written in C or C++. The
1476 required packages are called <em>build-essential</em>, and
1477 an informational list can be found in
1478 <file>/usr/share/doc/build-essential/list</file> (which is
1479 contained in the <tt>build-essential</tt>
1480 package).<footnote>
1481 Rationale:
1482 <list compact="compact">
1483 <item>
1484 This allows maintaining the list separately
1485 from the policy documents (the list does not
1486 need the kind of control that the policy
1487 documents do).
1488 </item>
1489 <item>
1490 Having a separate package allows one to install
1491 the build-essential packages on a machine, as
1492 well as allowing other packages such as tasks to
1493 require installation of the build-essential
1494 packages using the depends relation.
1495 </item>
1496 <item>
1497 The separate package allows bug reports against
1498 the list to be categorized separately from
1499 the policy management process in the BTS.
1500 </item>
1501 </list>
1502 </footnote>
1503 </p>
1506 When specifying the set of build-time dependencies, one
1507 should list only those packages explicitly required by the
1508 build. It is not necessary to list packages which are
1509 required merely because some other package in the list of
1510 build-time dependencies depends on them.<footnote>
1511 The reason for this is that dependencies change, and
1512 you should list all those packages, and <em>only</em>
1513 those packages that <em>you</em> need directly. What
1514 others need is their business. For example, if you
1515 only link against <file>libimlib</file>, you will need to
1516 build-depend on <package>libimlib2-dev</package> but
1517 not against any <tt>libjpeg*</tt> packages, even
1518 though <tt>libimlib2-dev</tt> currently depends on
1519 them: installation of <package>libimlib2-dev</package>
1520 will automatically ensure that all of its run-time
1521 dependencies are satisfied.
1522 </footnote>
1523 </p>
1526 If build-time dependencies are specified, it must be
1527 possible to build the package and produce working binaries
1528 on a system with only essential and build-essential
1529 packages installed and also those required to satisfy the
1530 build-time relationships (including any implied
1531 relationships). In particular, this means that version
1532 clauses should be used rigorously in build-time
1533 relationships so that one cannot produce bad or
1534 inconsistently configured packages when the relationships
1535 are properly satisfied.
1536 </p>
1539 <ref id="relationships"> explains the technical details.
1540 </p>
1541 </sect>
1543 <sect>
1544 <heading>Changes to the upstream sources</heading>
1547 If changes to the source code are made that are not
1548 specific to the needs of the Debian system, they should be
1549 sent to the upstream authors in whatever form they prefer
1550 so as to be included in the upstream version of the
1551 package.
1552 </p>
1555 If you need to configure the package differently for
1556 Debian or for Linux, and the upstream source doesn't
1557 provide a way to do so, you should add such configuration
1558 facilities (for example, a new <prgn>autoconf</prgn> test
1559 or <tt>#define</tt>) and send the patch to the upstream
1560 authors, with the default set to the way they originally
1561 had it. You can then easily override the default in your
1562 <file>debian/rules</file> or wherever is appropriate.
1563 </p>
1566 You should make sure that the <prgn>configure</prgn> utility
1567 detects the correct architecture specification string
1568 (refer to <ref id="arch-spec"> for details).
1569 </p>
1572 If you need to edit a <prgn>Makefile</prgn> where GNU-style
1573 <prgn>configure</prgn> scripts are used, you should edit the
1574 <file>.in</file> files rather than editing the
1575 <prgn>Makefile</prgn> directly. This allows the user to
1576 reconfigure the package if necessary. You should
1577 <em>not</em> configure the package and edit the generated
1578 <prgn>Makefile</prgn>! This makes it impossible for someone
1579 else to later reconfigure the package without losing the
1580 changes you made.
1581 </p>
1583 </sect>
1585 <sect id="dpkgchangelog">
1586 <heading>Debian changelog: <file>debian/changelog</file></heading>
1589 Changes in the Debian version of the package should be
1590 briefly explained in the Debian changelog file
1591 <file>debian/changelog</file>.<footnote>
1593 Mistakes in changelogs are usually best rectified by
1594 making a new changelog entry rather than "rewriting
1595 history" by editing old changelog entries.
1596 </p>
1597 </footnote>
1598 This includes modifications
1599 made in the Debian package compared to the upstream one
1600 as well as other changes and updates to the package.
1601 <footnote>
1602 Although there is nothing stopping an author who is also
1603 the Debian maintainer from using this changelog for all
1604 their changes, it will have to be renamed if the Debian
1605 and upstream maintainers become different people. In such
1606 a case, however, it might be better to maintain the package
1607 as a non-native package.
1608 </footnote>
1609 </p>
1612 The format of the <file>debian/changelog</file> allows the
1613 package building tools to discover which version of the package
1614 is being built and find out other release-specific information.
1615 </p>
1618 That format is a series of entries like this:
1620 <example compact="compact">
1621 <var>package</var> (<var>version</var>) <var>distribution(s)</var>; urgency=<var>urgency</var>
1622 <var>
1623 [optional blank line(s), stripped]
1624 </var>
1625 * <var>change details</var>
1626 <var>more change details</var>
1627 <var>
1628 [blank line(s), included in output of dpkg-parsechangelog]
1629 </var>
1630 * <var>even more change details</var>
1631 <var>
1632 [optional blank line(s), stripped]
1633 </var>
1634 -- <var>maintainer name</var> &lt;<var>email address</var>&gt;<var>[two spaces]</var> <var>date</var>
1635 </example>
1636 </p>
1639 <var>package</var> and <var>version</var> are the source
1640 package name and version number.
1641 </p>
1644 <var>distribution(s)</var> lists the distributions where
1645 this version should be installed when it is uploaded - it
1646 is copied to the <tt>Distribution</tt> field in the
1647 <file>.changes</file> file. See <ref id="f-Distribution">.
1648 </p>
1651 <var>urgency</var> is the value for the <tt>Urgency</tt>
1652 field in the <file>.changes</file> file for the upload
1653 (see <ref id="f-Urgency">). It is not possible to specify
1654 an urgency containing commas; commas are used to separate
1655 <tt><var>keyword</var>=<var>value</var></tt> settings in the
1656 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> changelog format (though there is
1657 currently only one useful <var>keyword</var>,
1658 <tt>urgency</tt>).
1659 </p>
1662 The change details may in fact be any series of lines
1663 starting with at least two spaces, but conventionally each
1664 change starts with an asterisk and a separating space and
1665 continuation lines are indented so as to bring them in
1666 line with the start of the text above. Blank lines may be
1667 used here to separate groups of changes, if desired.
1668 </p>
1671 If this upload resolves bugs recorded in the Bug Tracking
1672 System (BTS), they may be automatically closed on the
1673 inclusion of this package into the Debian archive by
1674 including the string: <tt>closes: Bug#<var>nnnnn</var></tt>
1675 in the change details.<footnote>
1676 To be precise, the string should match the following
1677 Perl regular expression:
1678 <example>
1679 /closes:\s*(?:bug)?\#?\s?\d+(?:,\s*(?:bug)?\#?\s?\d+)*/i
1680 </example>
1681 Then all of the bug numbers listed will be closed by the
1682 archive maintenance script (<prgn>katie</prgn>) using the
1683 <var>version</var> of the changelog entry.
1684 </footnote>
1685 This information is conveyed via the <tt>Closes</tt> field
1686 in the <tt>.changes</tt> file (see <ref id="f-Closes">).
1687 </p>
1690 The maintainer name and email address used in the changelog
1691 should be the details of the person uploading <em>this</em>
1692 version. They are <em>not</em> necessarily those of the
1693 usual package maintainer.<footnote>
1694 If the developer uploading the package is not one of the usual
1695 maintainers of the package (as listed in
1696 the <qref id="f-Maintainer"><tt>Maintainer</tt></qref>
1697 or <qref id="f-Uploaders"><tt>Uploaders</tt></qref> control
1698 fields of the package), the first line of the changelog is
1699 conventionally used to explain why a non-maintainer is
1700 uploading the package. The Debian Developer's Reference
1701 (see <ref id="related">) documents the conventions
1702 used.</footnote>
1703 The information here will be copied to the <tt>Changed-By</tt>
1704 field in the <tt>.changes</tt> file
1705 (see <ref id="f-Changed-By">), and then later used to send an
1706 acknowledgement when the upload has been installed.
1707 </p>
1710 The <var>date</var> has the following format<footnote>
1711 This is the same as the format generated by <tt>date
1712 -R</tt>.
1713 </footnote> (compatible and with the same semantics of
1714 RFC 2822 and RFC 5322):
1715 <example>day-of-week, dd month yyyy hh:mm:ss +zzzz</example>
1716 where:
1717 <list compact="compact">
1718 <item>
1719 day-of week is one of: Mon, Tue, Wed, Thu, Fri, Sat, Sun
1720 </item>
1721 <item>
1722 dd is a one- or two-digit day of the month (01-31)
1723 </item>
1724 <item>
1725 month is one of: Jan, Feb, Mar, Apr, May, Jun, Jul, Aug,
1726 Sep, Oct, Nov, Dec
1727 </item>
1728 <item>yyyy is the four-digit year (e.g. 2010)</item>
1729 <item>hh is the two-digit hour (00-23)</item>
1730 <item>mm is the two-digit minutes (00-59)</item>
1731 <item>ss is the two-digit seconds (00-60)</item>
1732 <item>
1733 +zzzz or -zzzz is the the time zone offset from Coordinated
1734 Universal Time (UTC). "+" indicates that the time is ahead
1735 of (i.e., east of) UTC and "-" indicates that the time is
1736 behind (i.e., west of) UTC. The first two digits indicate
1737 the hour difference from UTC and the last two digits
1738 indicate the number of additional minutes difference from
1739 UTC. The last two digits must be in the range 00-59.
1740 </item>
1741 </list>
1742 </p>
1745 The first "title" line with the package name must start
1746 at the left hand margin. The "trailer" line with the
1747 maintainer and date details must be preceded by exactly
1748 one space. The maintainer details and the date must be
1749 separated by exactly two spaces.
1750 </p>
1753 The entire changelog must be encoded in UTF-8.
1754 </p>
1757 For more information on placement of the changelog files
1758 within binary packages, please see <ref id="changelogs">.
1759 </p>
1760 </sect>
1762 <sect id="dpkgcopyright">
1763 <heading>Copyright: <file>debian/copyright</file></heading>
1765 Every package must be accompanied by a verbatim copy of its
1766 copyright information and distribution license in the file
1767 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/copyright</file>
1768 (see <ref id="copyrightfile"> for further details). Also see
1769 <ref id="pkgcopyright"> for further considerations related
1770 to copyrights for packages.
1771 </p>
1772 </sect>
1773 <sect>
1774 <heading>Error trapping in makefiles</heading>
1777 When <prgn>make</prgn> invokes a command in a makefile
1778 (including your package's upstream makefiles and
1779 <file>debian/rules</file>), it does so using <prgn>sh</prgn>. This
1780 means that <prgn>sh</prgn>'s usual bad error handling
1781 properties apply: if you include a miniature script as one
1782 of the commands in your makefile you'll find that if you
1783 don't do anything about it then errors are not detected
1784 and <prgn>make</prgn> will blithely continue after
1785 problems.
1786 </p>
1789 Every time you put more than one shell command (this
1790 includes using a loop) in a makefile command you
1791 must make sure that errors are trapped. For
1792 simple compound commands, such as changing directory and
1793 then running a program, using <tt>&amp;&amp;</tt> rather
1794 than semicolon as a command separator is sufficient. For
1795 more complex commands including most loops and
1796 conditionals you should include a separate <tt>set -e</tt>
1797 command at the start of every makefile command that's
1798 actually one of these miniature shell scripts.
1799 </p>
1800 </sect>
1802 <sect id="timestamps">
1803 <heading>Time Stamps</heading>
1805 Maintainers should preserve the modification times of the
1806 upstream source files in a package, as far as is reasonably
1807 possible.<footnote>
1808 The rationale is that there is some information conveyed
1809 by knowing the age of the file, for example, you could
1810 recognize that some documentation is very old by looking
1811 at the modification time, so it would be nice if the
1812 modification time of the upstream source would be
1813 preserved.
1814 </footnote>
1815 </p>
1816 </sect>
1818 <sect id="restrictions">
1819 <heading>Restrictions on objects in source packages</heading>
1822 The source package may not contain any hard links<footnote>
1824 This is not currently detected when building source
1825 packages, but only when extracting
1826 them.
1827 </p>
1829 Hard links may be permitted at some point in the
1830 future, but would require a fair amount of
1831 work.
1832 </p>
1833 </footnote>, device special files, sockets or setuid or
1834 setgid files.<footnote>
1835 Setgid directories are allowed.
1836 </footnote>
1837 </p>
1838 </sect>
1840 <sect id="debianrules">
1841 <heading>Main building script: <file>debian/rules</file></heading>
1844 This file must be an executable makefile, and contains the
1845 package-specific recipes for compiling the package and
1846 building binary package(s) from the source.
1847 </p>
1850 It must start with the line <tt>#!/usr/bin/make -f</tt>,
1851 so that it can be invoked by saying its name rather than
1852 invoking <prgn>make</prgn> explicitly. That is, invoking
1853 either of <tt>make -f debian/rules <em>args...</em></tt>
1854 or <tt>./debian/rules <em>args...</em></tt> must result in
1855 identical behavior.
1856 </p>
1859 The following targets are required and must be implemented
1860 by <file>debian/rules</file>: <tt>clean</tt>, <tt>binary</tt>,
1861 <tt>binary-arch</tt>, <tt>binary-indep</tt>, and <tt>build</tt>.
1862 These are the targets called by <prgn>dpkg-buildpackage</prgn>.
1863 </p>
1866 Since an interactive <file>debian/rules</file> script makes it
1867 impossible to auto-compile that package and also makes it hard
1868 for other people to reproduce the same binary package, all
1869 required targets must be non-interactive. It also follows that
1870 any target that these targets depend on must also be
1871 non-interactive.
1872 </p>
1875 The targets are as follows:
1876 <taglist>
1877 <tag><tt>build</tt> (required)</tag>
1878 <item>
1880 The <tt>build</tt> target should perform all the
1881 configuration and compilation of the package.
1882 If a package has an interactive pre-build
1883 configuration routine, the Debian source package
1884 must either be built after this has taken place (so
1885 that the binary package can be built without rerunning
1886 the configuration) or the configuration routine
1887 modified to become non-interactive. (The latter is
1888 preferable if there are architecture-specific features
1889 detected by the configuration routine.)
1890 </p>
1893 For some packages, notably ones where the same
1894 source tree is compiled in different ways to produce
1895 two binary packages, the <tt>build</tt> target
1896 does not make much sense. For these packages it is
1897 good enough to provide two (or more) targets
1898 (<tt>build-a</tt> and <tt>build-b</tt> or whatever)
1899 for each of the ways of building the package, and a
1900 <tt>build</tt> target that does nothing. The
1901 <tt>binary</tt> target will have to build the
1902 package in each of the possible ways and make the
1903 binary package out of each.
1904 </p>
1907 The <tt>build</tt> target must not do anything
1908 that might require root privilege.
1909 </p>
1912 The <tt>build</tt> target may need to run the
1913 <tt>clean</tt> target first - see below.
1914 </p>
1917 When a package has a configuration and build routine
1918 which takes a long time, or when the makefiles are
1919 poorly designed, or when <tt>build</tt> needs to
1920 run <tt>clean</tt> first, it is a good idea to
1921 <tt>touch build</tt> when the build process is
1922 complete. This will ensure that if <tt>debian/rules
1923 build</tt> is run again it will not rebuild the whole
1924 program.<footnote>
1925 Another common way to do this is for <tt>build</tt>
1926 to depend on <prgn>build-stamp</prgn> and to do
1927 nothing else, and for the <prgn>build-stamp</prgn>
1928 target to do the building and to <tt>touch
1929 build-stamp</tt> on completion. This is
1930 especially useful if the build routine creates a
1931 file or directory called <tt>build</tt>; in such a
1932 case, <tt>build</tt> will need to be listed as
1933 a phony target (i.e., as a dependency of the
1934 <tt>.PHONY</tt> target). See the documentation of
1935 <prgn>make</prgn> for more information on phony
1936 targets.
1937 </footnote>
1938 </p>
1939 </item>
1941 <tag><tt>build-arch</tt> (optional),
1942 <tt>build-indep</tt> (optional)
1943 </tag>
1944 <item>
1946 A package may also provide both of the targets
1947 <tt>build-arch</tt> and <tt>build-indep</tt>.
1948 The <tt>build-arch</tt> target, if provided, should
1949 perform all the configuration and compilation required for
1950 producing all architecture-dependant binary packages
1951 (those packages for which the body of the
1952 <tt>Architecture</tt> field in <tt>debian/control</tt> is
1953 not <tt>all</tt>). Similarly, the <tt>build-indep</tt>
1954 target, if provided, should perform all the configuration
1955 and compilation required for producing all
1956 architecture-independent binary packages (those packages
1957 for which the body of the <tt>Architecture</tt> field
1958 in <tt>debian/control</tt> is <tt>all</tt>).
1959 The <tt>build</tt> target should depend on those of the
1960 targets <tt>build-arch</tt> and <tt>build-indep</tt> that
1961 are provided in the rules file.<footnote>
1962 The intent of this split is so that binary-only builds
1963 need not install the dependencies required for
1964 the <tt>build-indep</tt> target. However, this is not
1965 yet used in practice since <tt>dpkg-buildpackage
1966 -B</tt>, and therefore the autobuilders,
1967 invoke <tt>build</tt> rather than <tt>build-arch</tt>
1968 due to the difficulties in determining whether the
1969 optional <tt>build-arch</tt> target exists.
1970 </footnote>
1971 </p>
1974 If one or both of the targets <tt>build-arch</tt> and
1975 <tt>build-indep</tt> are not provided, then invoking
1976 <file>debian/rules</file> with one of the not-provided
1977 targets as arguments should produce a exit status code
1978 of 2. Usually this is provided automatically by make
1979 if the target is missing.
1980 </p>
1983 The <tt>build-arch</tt> and <tt>build-indep</tt> targets
1984 must not do anything that might require root privilege.
1985 </p>
1986 </item>
1988 <tag><tt>binary</tt> (required), <tt>binary-arch</tt>
1989 (required), <tt>binary-indep</tt> (required)
1990 </tag>
1991 <item>
1993 The <tt>binary</tt> target must be all that is
1994 necessary for the user to build the binary package(s)
1995 produced from this source package. It is
1996 split into two parts: <prgn>binary-arch</prgn> builds
1997 the binary packages which are specific to a particular
1998 architecture, and <tt>binary-indep</tt> builds
1999 those which are not.
2000 </p>
2002 <tt>binary</tt> may be (and commonly is) a target with
2003 no commands which simply depends on
2004 <tt>binary-arch</tt> and <tt>binary-indep</tt>.
2005 </p>
2007 Both <tt>binary-*</tt> targets should depend on the
2008 <tt>build</tt> target, or on the appropriate
2009 <tt>build-arch</tt> or <tt>build-indep</tt> target, if
2010 provided, so that the package is built if it has not
2011 been already. It should then create the relevant
2012 binary package(s), using <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> to
2013 make their control files and <prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn> to
2014 build them and place them in the parent of the top
2015 level directory.
2016 </p>
2019 Both the <tt>binary-arch</tt> and
2020 <tt>binary-indep</tt> targets <em>must</em> exist.
2021 If one of them has nothing to do (which will always be
2022 the case if the source generates only a single binary
2023 package, whether architecture-dependent or not), it
2024 must still exist and must always succeed.
2025 </p>
2028 The <tt>binary</tt> targets must be invoked as
2029 root.<footnote>
2030 The <prgn>fakeroot</prgn> package often allows one
2031 to build a package correctly even without being
2032 root.
2033 </footnote>
2034 </p>
2035 </item>
2037 <tag><tt>clean</tt> (required)</tag>
2038 <item>
2040 This must undo any effects that the <tt>build</tt>
2041 and <tt>binary</tt> targets may have had, except
2042 that it should leave alone any output files created in
2043 the parent directory by a run of a <tt>binary</tt>
2044 target.
2045 </p>
2048 If a <tt>build</tt> file is touched at the end of
2049 the <tt>build</tt> target, as suggested above, it
2050 should be removed as the first action that
2051 <tt>clean</tt> performs, so that running
2052 <tt>build</tt> again after an interrupted
2053 <tt>clean</tt> doesn't think that everything is
2054 already done.
2055 </p>
2058 The <tt>clean</tt> target may need to be
2059 invoked as root if <tt>binary</tt> has been
2060 invoked since the last <tt>clean</tt>, or if
2061 <tt>build</tt> has been invoked as root (since
2062 <tt>build</tt> may create directories, for
2063 example).
2064 </p>
2065 </item>
2067 <tag><tt>get-orig-source</tt> (optional)</tag>
2068 <item>
2070 This target fetches the most recent version of the
2071 original source package from a canonical archive site
2072 (via FTP or WWW, for example), does any necessary
2073 rearrangement to turn it into the original source
2074 tar file format described below, and leaves it in the
2075 current directory.
2076 </p>
2079 This target may be invoked in any directory, and
2080 should take care to clean up any temporary files it
2081 may have left.
2082 </p>
2085 This target is optional, but providing it if
2086 possible is a good idea.
2087 </p>
2088 </item>
2090 <tag><tt>patch</tt> (optional)</tag>
2091 <item>
2093 This target performs whatever additional actions are
2094 required to make the source ready for editing (unpacking
2095 additional upstream archives, applying patches, etc.).
2096 It is recommended to be implemented for any package where
2097 <tt>dpkg-source -x</tt> does not result in source ready
2098 for additional modification. See
2099 <ref id="readmesource">.
2100 </p>
2101 </item>
2102 </taglist>
2105 The <tt>build</tt>, <tt>binary</tt> and
2106 <tt>clean</tt> targets must be invoked with the current
2107 directory being the package's top-level directory.
2108 </p>
2112 Additional targets may exist in <file>debian/rules</file>,
2113 either as published or undocumented interfaces or for the
2114 package's internal use.
2115 </p>
2118 The architectures we build on and build for are determined
2119 by <prgn>make</prgn> variables using the
2120 utility <qref id="pkg-dpkg-architecture"><prgn>dpkg-architecture</prgn></qref>.
2121 You can determine the Debian architecture and the GNU style
2122 architecture specification string for the build architecture as
2123 well as for the host architecture. The build architecture is
2124 the architecture on which <file>debian/rules</file> is run and
2125 the package build is performed. The host architecture is the
2126 architecture on which the resulting package will be installed
2127 and run. These are normally the same, but may be different in
2128 the case of cross-compilation (building packages for one
2129 architecture on machines of a different architecture).
2130 </p>
2133 Here is a list of supported <prgn>make</prgn> variables:
2134 <list compact="compact">
2135 <item>
2136 <tt>DEB_*_ARCH</tt> (the Debian architecture)
2137 </item>
2138 <item>
2139 <tt>DEB_*_ARCH_CPU</tt> (the Debian CPU name)
2140 </item>
2141 <item>
2142 <tt>DEB_*_ARCH_OS</tt> (the Debian System name)
2143 </item>
2144 <item>
2145 <tt>DEB_*_GNU_TYPE</tt> (the GNU style architecture
2146 specification string)
2147 </item>
2148 <item>
2149 <tt>DEB_*_GNU_CPU</tt> (the CPU part of
2150 <tt>DEB_*_GNU_TYPE</tt>)
2151 </item>
2152 <item>
2153 <tt>DEB_*_GNU_SYSTEM</tt> (the System part of
2154 <tt>DEB_*_GNU_TYPE</tt>)
2155 </list>
2156 where <tt>*</tt> is either <tt>BUILD</tt> for specification of
2157 the build architecture or <tt>HOST</tt> for specification of the
2158 host architecture.
2159 </p>
2162 Backward compatibility can be provided in the rules file
2163 by setting the needed variables to suitable default
2164 values; please refer to the documentation of
2165 <prgn>dpkg-architecture</prgn> for details.
2166 </p>
2169 It is important to understand that the <tt>DEB_*_ARCH</tt>
2170 string only determines which Debian architecture we are
2171 building on or for. It should not be used to get the CPU
2172 or system information; the <tt>DEB_*_ARCH_CPU</tt> and
2173 <tt>DEB_*_ARCH_OS</tt> variables should be used for that.
2174 GNU style variables should generally only be used with upstream
2175 build systems.
2176 </p>
2178 <sect1 id="debianrules-options">
2179 <heading><file>debian/rules</file> and
2180 <tt>DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS</tt></heading>
2183 Supporting the standardized environment variable
2184 <tt>DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS</tt> is recommended. This variable can
2185 contain several flags to change how a package is compiled and
2186 built. Each flag must be in the form <var>flag</var> or
2187 <var>flag</var>=<var>options</var>. If multiple flags are
2188 given, they must be separated by whitespace.<footnote>
2189 Some packages support any delimiter, but whitespace is the
2190 easiest to parse inside a makefile and avoids ambiguity with
2191 flag values that contain commas.
2192 </footnote>
2193 <var>flag</var> must start with a lowercase letter
2194 (<tt>a-z</tt>) and consist only of lowercase letters,
2195 numbers (<tt>0-9</tt>), and the characters
2196 <tt>-</tt> and <tt>_</tt> (hyphen and underscore).
2197 <var>options</var> must not contain whitespace. The same
2198 tag should not be given multiple times with conflicting
2199 values. Package maintainers may assume that
2200 <tt>DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS</tt> will not contain conflicting tags.
2201 </p>
2204 The meaning of the following tags has been standardized:
2205 <taglist>
2206 <tag>nocheck</tag>
2207 <item>
2208 This tag says to not run any build-time test suite
2209 provided by the package.
2210 </item>
2211 <tag>noopt</tag>
2212 <item>
2213 The presence of this tag means that the package should
2214 be compiled with a minimum of optimization. For C
2215 programs, it is best to add <tt>-O0</tt> to
2216 <tt>CFLAGS</tt> (although this is usually the default).
2217 Some programs might fail to build or run at this level
2218 of optimization; it may be necessary to use
2219 <tt>-O1</tt>, for example.
2220 </item>
2221 <tag>nostrip</tag>
2222 <item>
2223 This tag means that the debugging symbols should not be
2224 stripped from the binary during installation, so that
2225 debugging information may be included in the package.
2226 </item>
2227 <tag>parallel=n</tag>
2228 <item>
2229 This tag means that the package should be built using up
2230 to <tt>n</tt> parallel processes if the package build
2231 system supports this.<footnote>
2232 Packages built with <tt>make</tt> can often implement
2233 this by passing the <tt>-j</tt><var>n</var> option to
2234 <tt>make</tt>.
2235 </footnote>
2236 If the package build system does not support parallel
2237 builds, this string must be ignored. If the package
2238 build system only supports a lower level of concurrency
2239 than <var>n</var>, the package should be built using as
2240 many parallel processes as the package build system
2241 supports. It is up to the package maintainer to decide
2242 whether the package build times are long enough and the
2243 package build system is robust enough to make supporting
2244 parallel builds worthwhile.
2245 </item>
2246 </taglist>
2247 </p>
2250 Unknown flags must be ignored by <file>debian/rules</file>.
2251 </p>
2254 The following makefile snippet is an example of how one may
2255 implement the build options; you will probably have to
2256 massage this example in order to make it work for your
2257 package.
2258 <example compact="compact">
2259 CFLAGS = -Wall -g
2260 INSTALL = install
2261 INSTALL_FILE = $(INSTALL) -p -o root -g root -m 644
2262 INSTALL_PROGRAM = $(INSTALL) -p -o root -g root -m 755
2263 INSTALL_SCRIPT = $(INSTALL) -p -o root -g root -m 755
2264 INSTALL_DIR = $(INSTALL) -p -d -o root -g root -m 755
2266 ifneq (,$(filter noopt,$(DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS)))
2267 CFLAGS += -O0
2268 else
2269 CFLAGS += -O2
2270 endif
2271 ifeq (,$(filter nostrip,$(DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS)))
2272 INSTALL_PROGRAM += -s
2273 endif
2274 ifneq (,$(filter parallel=%,$(DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS)))
2275 NUMJOBS = $(patsubst parallel=%,%,$(filter parallel=%,$(DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS)))
2276 MAKEFLAGS += -j$(NUMJOBS)
2277 endif
2279 build:
2280 # ...
2281 ifeq (,$(filter nocheck,$(DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS)))
2282 # Code to run the package test suite.
2283 endif
2284 </example>
2285 </p>
2286 </sect1>
2287 </sect>
2289 <!-- FIXME: section pkg-srcsubstvars is the same as substvars -->
2290 <sect id="substvars">
2291 <heading>Variable substitutions: <file>debian/substvars</file></heading>
2294 When <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn>
2295 generates <qref id="binarycontrolfiles">binary package control
2296 files</qref> (<file>DEBIAN/control</file>), it performs variable
2297 substitutions on its output just before writing it. Variable
2298 substitutions have the form <tt>${<var>variable</var>}</tt>.
2299 The optional file <file>debian/substvars</file> contains
2300 variable substitutions to be used; variables can also be set
2301 directly from <file>debian/rules</file> using the <tt>-V</tt>
2302 option to the source packaging commands, and certain predefined
2303 variables are also available.
2304 </p>
2307 The <file>debian/substvars</file> file is usually generated and
2308 modified dynamically by <file>debian/rules</file> targets, in
2309 which case it must be removed by the <tt>clean</tt> target.
2310 </p>
2313 See <manref name="deb-substvars" section="5"> for full
2314 details about source variable substitutions, including the
2315 format of <file>debian/substvars</file>.</p>
2316 </sect>
2318 <sect id="debianwatch">
2319 <heading>Optional upstream source location: <file>debian/watch</file></heading>
2322 This is an optional, recommended configuration file for the
2323 <tt>uscan</tt> utility which defines how to automatically scan
2324 ftp or http sites for newly available updates of the
2325 package. This is used
2326 by <url id="http://dehs.alioth.debian.org/"> and other Debian QA
2327 tools to help with quality control and maintenance of the
2328 distribution as a whole.
2329 </p>
2331 </sect>
2333 <sect id="debianfiles">
2334 <heading>Generated files list: <file>debian/files</file></heading>
2337 This file is not a permanent part of the source tree; it
2338 is used while building packages to record which files are
2339 being generated. <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> uses it
2340 when it generates a <file>.changes</file> file.
2341 </p>
2344 It should not exist in a shipped source package, and so it
2345 (and any backup files or temporary files such as
2346 <file>files.new</file><footnote>
2347 <file>files.new</file> is used as a temporary file by
2348 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> and
2349 <prgn>dpkg-distaddfile</prgn> - they write a new
2350 version of <tt>files</tt> here before renaming it,
2351 to avoid leaving a corrupted copy if an error
2352 occurs.
2353 </footnote>) should be removed by the
2354 <tt>clean</tt> target. It may also be wise to
2355 ensure a fresh start by emptying or removing it at the
2356 start of the <tt>binary</tt> target.
2357 </p>
2360 When <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> is run for a binary
2361 package, it adds an entry to <file>debian/files</file> for the
2362 <file>.deb</file> file that will be created when <tt>dpkg-deb
2363 --build</tt> is run for that binary package. So for most
2364 packages all that needs to be done with this file is to
2365 delete it in the <tt>clean</tt> target.
2366 </p>
2369 If a package upload includes files besides the source
2370 package and any binary packages whose control files were
2371 made with <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> then they should be
2372 placed in the parent of the package's top-level directory
2373 and <prgn>dpkg-distaddfile</prgn> should be called to add
2374 the file to the list in <file>debian/files</file>.</p>
2375 </sect>
2377 <sect id="embeddedfiles">
2378 <heading>Convenience copies of code</heading>
2381 Some software packages include in their distribution convenience
2382 copies of code from other software packages, generally so that
2383 users compiling from source don't have to download multiple
2384 packages. Debian packages should not make use of these
2385 convenience copies unless the included package is explicitly
2386 intended to be used in this way.<footnote>
2387 For example, parts of the GNU build system work like this.
2388 </footnote>
2389 If the included code is already in the Debian archive in the
2390 form of a library, the Debian packaging should ensure that
2391 binary packages reference the libraries already in Debian and
2392 the convenience copy is not used. If the included code is not
2393 already in Debian, it should be packaged separately as a
2394 prerequisite if possible.
2395 <footnote>
2396 Having multiple copies of the same code in Debian is
2397 inefficient, often creates either static linking or shared
2398 library conflicts, and, most importantly, increases the
2399 difficulty of handling security vulnerabilities in the
2400 duplicated code.
2401 </footnote>
2402 </p>
2403 </sect>
2405 <sect id="readmesource">
2406 <heading>Source package handling:
2407 <file>debian/README.source</file></heading>
2410 If running <prgn>dpkg-source -x</prgn> on a source package
2411 doesn't produce the source of the package, ready for editing,
2412 and allow one to make changes and run
2413 <prgn>dpkg-buildpackage</prgn> to produce a modified package
2414 without taking any additional steps, creating a
2415 <file>debian/README.source</file> documentation file is
2416 recommended. This file should explain how to do all of the
2417 following:
2418 <enumlist>
2419 <item>Generate the fully patched source, in a form ready for
2420 editing, that would be built to create Debian
2421 packages. Doing this with a <tt>patch</tt> target in
2422 <file>debian/rules</file> is recommended; see
2423 <ref id="debianrules">.</item>
2424 <item>Modify the source and save those modifications so that
2425 they will be applied when building the package.</item>
2426 <item>Remove source modifications that are currently being
2427 applied when building the package.</item>
2428 <item>Optionally, document what steps are necessary to
2429 upgrade the Debian source package to a new upstream version,
2430 if applicable.</item>
2431 </enumlist>
2432 This explanation should include specific commands and mention
2433 any additional required Debian packages. It should not assume
2434 familiarity with any specific Debian packaging system or patch
2435 management tools.
2436 </p>
2439 This explanation may refer to a documentation file installed by
2440 one of the package's build dependencies provided that the
2441 referenced documentation clearly explains these tasks and is not
2442 a general reference manual.
2443 </p>
2446 <file>debian/README.source</file> may also include any other
2447 information that would be helpful to someone modifying the
2448 source package. Even if the package doesn't fit the above
2449 description, maintainers are encouraged to document in a
2450 <file>debian/README.source</file> file any source package with a
2451 particularly complex or unintuitive source layout or build
2452 system (for example, a package that builds the same source
2453 multiple times to generate different binary packages).
2454 </p>
2455 </sect>
2456 </chapt>
2459 <chapt id="controlfields">
2460 <heading>Control files and their fields</heading>
2463 The package management system manipulates data represented in
2464 a common format, known as <em>control data</em>, stored in
2465 <em>control files</em>.
2466 Control files are used for source packages, binary packages and
2467 the <file>.changes</file> files which control the installation
2468 of uploaded files<footnote>
2469 <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s internal databases are in a similar
2470 format.
2471 </footnote>.
2472 </p>
2474 <sect id="controlsyntax">
2475 <heading>Syntax of control files</heading>
2478 A control file consists of one or more paragraphs of
2479 fields<footnote>
2480 The paragraphs are also sometimes referred to as stanzas.
2481 </footnote>.
2482 The paragraphs are separated by empty lines. Parsers may accept
2483 lines consisting solely of spaces and tabs as paragraph
2484 separators, but control files should use empty lines. Some control
2485 files allow only one paragraph; others allow several, in
2486 which case each paragraph usually refers to a different
2487 package. (For example, in source packages, the first
2488 paragraph refers to the source package, and later paragraphs
2489 refer to binary packages generated from the source.) The
2490 ordering of the paragraphs in control files is significant.
2491 </p>
2494 Each paragraph consists of a series of data fields; each
2495 field consists of the field name, followed by a colon and
2496 then the data/value associated with that field. The field
2497 name is composed of printable ASCII characters (i.e.,
2498 characters that have values between 33 and 126, inclusive)
2499 except colon and must not with a begin with #. The
2500 field ends at the end of the line or at the end of the
2501 last continuation line (see below). Horizontal whitespace
2502 (spaces and tabs) may occur immediately before or after the
2503 value and is ignored there; it is conventional to put a
2504 single space after the colon. For example, a field might
2506 <example compact="compact">
2507 Package: libc6
2508 </example>
2509 the field name is <tt>Package</tt> and the field value
2510 <tt>libc6</tt>.
2511 </p>
2514 A paragraph must not contain more than one instance of a
2515 particular field name.
2516 </p>
2519 There are three types of fields:
2520 <taglist>
2521 <tag>simple</tag>
2522 <item>
2523 The field, including its value, must be a single line. Folding
2524 of the field is not permitted. This is the default field type
2525 if the definition of the field does not specify a different
2526 type.
2527 </item>
2528 <tag>folded</tag>
2529 <item>
2530 The value of a folded field is a logical line that may span
2531 several lines. The lines after the first are called
2532 continuation lines and must start with a space or a tab.
2533 Whitespace, including any newlines, is not significant in the
2534 field values of folded fields.<footnote>
2535 This folding method is similar to RFC 5322, allowing control
2536 files that contain only one paragraph and no multiline fields
2537 to be read by parsers written for RFC 5322.
2538 </footnote>
2539 </item>
2540 <tag>multiline</tag>
2541 <item>
2542 The value of a multiline field may comprise multiple continuation
2543 lines. The first line of the value, the part on the same line as
2544 the field name, often has special significance or may have to be
2545 empty. Other lines are added following the same syntax as the
2546 continuation lines the folded fields. Whitespace, including newlines,
2547 is significant in the values of multiline fields.
2548 </item>
2549 </taglist>
2550 </p>
2553 Whitespace must not appear
2554 inside names (of packages, architectures, files or anything
2555 else) or version numbers, or between the characters of
2556 multi-character version relationships.
2557 </p>
2560 The presence and purpose of a field, and the syntax of its
2561 value may differ between types of control files.
2562 </p>
2565 Field names are not case-sensitive, but it is usual to
2566 capitalize the field names using mixed case as shown below.
2567 Field values are case-sensitive unless the description of the
2568 field says otherwise.
2569 </p>
2572 Paragraph separators (empty lines) and lines consisting only of
2573 spaces and tabs are not allowed within field values or between
2574 fields. Empty lines in field values are usually escaped by
2575 representing them by a space followed by a dot.
2576 </p>
2579 Lines starting with # without any preceding whitespace are comments
2580 lines that are only permitted in source package control files
2581 (<file>debian/control</file>). These comment lines are ignored, even
2582 between two continuation lines. They do not end logical lines.
2583 </p>
2586 All control files must be encoded in UTF-8.
2587 </p>
2588 </sect>
2590 <sect id="sourcecontrolfiles">
2591 <heading>Source package control files -- <file>debian/control</file></heading>
2594 The <file>debian/control</file> file contains the most vital
2595 (and version-independent) information about the source package
2596 and about the binary packages it creates.
2597 </p>
2600 The first paragraph of the control file contains information about
2601 the source package in general. The subsequent sets each describe a
2602 binary package that the source tree builds.
2603 </p>
2606 The fields in the general paragraph (the first one, for the source
2607 package) are:
2609 <list compact="compact">
2610 <item><qref id="f-Source"><tt>Source</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2611 <item><qref id="f-Maintainer"><tt>Maintainer</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2612 <item><qref id="f-Uploaders"><tt>Uploaders</tt></qref></item>
2613 <item><qref id="f-DM-Upload-Allowed"><tt>DM-Upload-Allowed</tt></qref></item>
2614 <item><qref id="f-Section"><tt>Section</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2615 <item><qref id="f-Priority"><tt>Priority</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2616 <item><qref id="sourcebinarydeps"><tt>Build-Depends</tt> et al</qref></item>
2617 <item><qref id="f-Standards-Version"><tt>Standards-Version</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2618 <item><qref id="f-Homepage"><tt>Homepage</tt></qref></item>
2619 </list>
2620 </p>
2623 The fields in the binary package paragraphs are:
2625 <list compact="compact">
2626 <item><qref id="f-Package"><tt>Package</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2627 <item><qref id="f-Architecture"><tt>Architecture</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2628 <item><qref id="f-Section"><tt>Section</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2629 <item><qref id="f-Priority"><tt>Priority</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2630 <item><qref id="f-Essential"><tt>Essential</tt></qref></item>
2631 <item><qref id="binarydeps"><tt>Depends</tt> et al</qref></item>
2632 <item><qref id="f-Description"><tt>Description</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2633 <item><qref id="f-Homepage"><tt>Homepage</tt></qref></item>
2634 </list>
2635 </p>
2638 The syntax and semantics of the fields are described below.
2639 </p>
2642 These fields are used by <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> to
2643 generate control files for binary packages (see below), by
2644 <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> to generate the
2645 <file>.changes</file> file to accompany the upload, and by
2646 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> when it creates the
2647 <file>.dsc</file> source control file as part of a source
2648 archive. Some fields are folded in <file>debian/control</file>,
2649 but not in any other control
2650 file. These tools are responsible for removing the line
2651 breaks from such fields when using fields from
2652 <file>debian/control</file> to generate other control files.
2653 </p>
2656 The fields here may contain variable references - their
2657 values will be substituted by <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn>,
2658 <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> or <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn>
2659 when they generate output control files.
2660 See <ref id="substvars"> for details.
2661 </p>
2662 </sect>
2664 <sect id="binarycontrolfiles">
2665 <heading>Binary package control files -- <file>DEBIAN/control</file></heading>
2668 The <file>DEBIAN/control</file> file contains the most vital
2669 (and version-dependent) information about a binary package. It
2670 consists of a single paragraph.
2671 </p>
2674 The fields in this file are:
2676 <list compact="compact">
2677 <item><qref id="f-Package"><tt>Package</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2678 <item><qref id="f-Source"><tt>Source</tt></qref></item>
2679 <item><qref id="f-Version"><tt>Version</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2680 <item><qref id="f-Section"><tt>Section</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2681 <item><qref id="f-Priority"><tt>Priority</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2682 <item><qref id="f-Architecture"><tt>Architecture</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2683 <item><qref id="f-Essential"><tt>Essential</tt></qref></item>
2684 <item><qref id="binarydeps"><tt>Depends</tt> et al</qref></item>
2685 <item><qref id="f-Installed-Size"><tt>Installed-Size</tt></qref></item>
2686 <item><qref id="f-Maintainer"><tt>Maintainer</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2687 <item><qref id="f-Description"><tt>Description</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2688 <item><qref id="f-Homepage"><tt>Homepage</tt></qref></item>
2689 </list>
2690 </p>
2691 </sect>
2693 <sect id="debiansourcecontrolfiles">
2694 <heading>Debian source control files -- <tt>.dsc</tt></heading>
2697 This file consists of a single paragraph, possibly surrounded by
2698 a PGP signature. The fields of that paragraph are listed below.
2699 Their syntax is described above, in <ref id="pkg-controlfields">.
2701 <list compact="compact">
2702 <item><qref id="f-Format"><tt>Format</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2703 <item><qref id="f-Source"><tt>Source</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2704 <item><qref id="f-Binary"><tt>Binary</tt></qref></item>
2705 <item><qref id="f-Architecture"><tt>Architecture</tt></qref></item>
2706 <item><qref id="f-Version"><tt>Version</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2707 <item><qref id="f-Maintainer"><tt>Maintainer</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2708 <item><qref id="f-Uploaders"><tt>Uploaders</tt></qref></item>
2709 <item><qref id="f-DM-Upload-Allowed"><tt>DM-Upload-Allowed</tt></qref></item>
2710 <item><qref id="f-Homepage"><tt>Homepage</tt></qref></item>
2711 <item><qref id="f-Standards-Version"><tt>Standards-Version</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2712 <item><qref id="sourcebinarydeps"><tt>Build-Depends</tt> et al</qref></item>
2713 <item><qref id="f-Checksums"><tt>Checksums-Sha1</tt>
2714 and <tt>Checksums-Sha256</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2715 <item><qref id="f-Files"><tt>Files</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2716 </list>
2717 </p>
2720 The source package control file is generated by
2721 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> when it builds the source
2722 archive, from other files in the source package,
2723 described above. When unpacking, it is checked against
2724 the files and directories in the other parts of the
2725 source package.
2726 </p>
2728 </sect>
2730 <sect id="debianchangesfiles">
2731 <heading>Debian changes files -- <file>.changes</file></heading>
2734 The <file>.changes</file> files are used by the Debian archive
2735 maintenance software to process updates to packages. They
2736 consist of a single paragraph, possibly surrounded by a PGP
2737 signature. That paragraph contains information from the
2738 <file>debian/control</file> file and other data about the
2739 source package gathered via <file>debian/changelog</file>
2740 and <file>debian/rules</file>.
2741 </p>
2744 <file>.changes</file> files have a format version that is
2745 incremented whenever the documented fields or their meaning
2746 change. This document describes format &changesversion;.
2747 </p>
2750 The fields in this file are:
2752 <list compact="compact">
2753 <item><qref id="f-Format"><tt>Format</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2754 <item><qref id="f-Date"><tt>Date</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2755 <item><qref id="f-Source"><tt>Source</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2756 <item><qref id="f-Binary"><tt>Binary</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2757 <item><qref id="f-Architecture"><tt>Architecture</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2758 <item><qref id="f-Version"><tt>Version</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2759 <item><qref id="f-Distribution"><tt>Distribution</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2760 <item><qref id="f-Urgency"><tt>Urgency</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2761 <item><qref id="f-Maintainer"><tt>Maintainer</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2762 <item><qref id="f-Changed-By"><tt>Changed-By</tt></qref></item>
2763 <item><qref id="f-Description"><tt>Description</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2764 <item><qref id="f-Closes"><tt>Closes</tt></qref></item>
2765 <item><qref id="f-Changes"><tt>Changes</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2766 <item><qref id="f-Checksums"><tt>Checksums-Sha1</tt>
2767 and <tt>Checksums-Sha256</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2768 <item><qref id="f-Files"><tt>Files</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2769 </list>
2770 </p>
2771 </sect>
2773 <sect id="controlfieldslist">
2774 <heading>List of fields</heading>
2776 <sect1 id="f-Source">
2777 <heading><tt>Source</tt></heading>
2780 This field identifies the source package name.
2781 </p>
2784 In <file>debian/control</file> or a <file>.dsc</file> file,
2785 this field must contain only the name of the source package.
2786 </p>
2789 In a binary package control file or a <file>.changes</file>
2790 file, the source package name may be followed by a version
2791 number in parentheses<footnote>
2792 It is customary to leave a space after the package name
2793 if a version number is specified.
2794 </footnote>.
2795 This version number may be omitted (and is, by
2796 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn>) if it has the same value as
2797 the <tt>Version</tt> field of the binary package in
2798 question. The field itself may be omitted from a binary
2799 package control file when the source package has the same
2800 name and version as the binary package.
2801 </p>
2804 Package names (both source and binary,
2805 see <ref id="f-Package">) must consist only of lower case
2806 letters (<tt>a-z</tt>), digits (<tt>0-9</tt>), plus
2807 (<tt>+</tt>) and minus (<tt>-</tt>) signs, and periods
2808 (<tt>.</tt>). They must be at least two characters long and
2809 must start with an alphanumeric character.
2810 </p>
2811 </sect1>
2813 <sect1 id="f-Maintainer">
2814 <heading><tt>Maintainer</tt></heading>
2817 The package maintainer's name and email address. The name
2818 must come first, then the email address inside angle
2819 brackets <tt>&lt;&gt;</tt> (in RFC822 format).
2820 </p>
2823 If the maintainer's name contains a full stop then the
2824 whole field will not work directly as an email address due
2825 to a misfeature in the syntax specified in RFC822; a
2826 program using this field as an address must check for this
2827 and correct the problem if necessary (for example by
2828 putting the name in round brackets and moving it to the
2829 end, and bringing the email address forward).
2830 </p>
2833 See <ref id="maintainer"> for additional requirements and
2834 information about package maintainers.
2835 </p>
2836 </sect1>
2838 <sect1 id="f-Uploaders">
2839 <heading><tt>Uploaders</tt></heading>
2842 List of the names and email addresses of co-maintainers of the
2843 package, if any. If the package has other maintainers besides
2844 the one named in the <qref id="f-Maintainer">Maintainer
2845 field</qref>, their names and email addresses should be listed
2846 here. The format of each entry is the same as that of the
2847 Maintainer field, and multiple entries must be comma
2848 separated.
2849 </p>
2852 This is normally an optional field, but if
2853 the <tt>Maintainer</tt> control field names a group of people
2854 and a shared email address, the <tt>Uploaders</tt> field must
2855 be present and must contain at least one human with their
2856 personal email address.
2857 </p>
2860 The Uploaders field in <file>debian/control</file> can be folded.
2861 </p>
2862 </sect1>
2864 <sect1 id="f-Changed-By">
2865 <heading><tt>Changed-By</tt></heading>
2868 The name and email address of the person who prepared this
2869 version of the package, usually a maintainer. The syntax is
2870 the same as for the <qref id="f-Maintainer">Maintainer
2871 field</qref>.
2872 </p>
2873 </sect1>
2875 <sect1 id="f-Section">
2876 <heading><tt>Section</tt></heading>
2879 This field specifies an application area into which the package
2880 has been classified. See <ref id="subsections">.
2881 </p>
2884 When it appears in the <file>debian/control</file> file,
2885 it gives the value for the subfield of the same name in
2886 the <tt>Files</tt> field of the <file>.changes</file> file.
2887 It also gives the default for the same field in the binary
2888 packages.
2889 </p>
2890 </sect1>
2892 <sect1 id="f-Priority">
2893 <heading><tt>Priority</tt></heading>
2896 This field represents how important it is that the user
2897 have the package installed. See <ref id="priorities">.
2898 </p>
2901 When it appears in the <file>debian/control</file> file,
2902 it gives the value for the subfield of the same name in
2903 the <tt>Files</tt> field of the <file>.changes</file> file.
2904 It also gives the default for the same field in the binary
2905 packages.
2906 </p>
2907 </sect1>
2909 <sect1 id="f-Package">
2910 <heading><tt>Package</tt></heading>
2913 The name of the binary package.
2914 </p>
2917 Binary package names must follow the same syntax and
2918 restrictions as source package names. See <ref id="f-Source">
2919 for the details.
2920 </p>
2921 </sect1>
2923 <sect1 id="f-Architecture">
2924 <heading><tt>Architecture</tt></heading>
2927 Depending on context and the control file used, the
2928 <tt>Architecture</tt> field can include the following sets of
2929 values:
2930 <list>
2931 <item>
2932 A unique single word identifying a Debian machine
2933 architecture as described in <ref id="arch-spec">.
2934 </item>
2935 <item>
2936 An architecture wildcard identifying a set of Debian
2937 machine architectures, see <ref id="arch-wildcard-spec">.
2938 <tt>any</tt> matches all Debian machine architectures
2939 and is the most frequently used.
2940 </item>
2941 <item>
2942 <tt>all</tt>, which indicates an
2943 architecture-independent package.
2944 </item>
2945 <item>
2946 <tt>source</tt>, which indicates a source package.
2947 </item>
2948 </list>
2949 </p>
2952 In the main <file>debian/control</file> file in the source
2953 package, this field may contain the special
2954 value <tt>all</tt>, the special architecture
2955 wildcard <tt>any</tt>, or a list of specific and wildcard
2956 architectures separated by spaces. If <tt>all</tt>
2957 or <tt>any</tt> appears, that value must be the entire
2958 contents of the field. Most packages will use
2959 either <tt>all</tt> or <tt>any</tt>.
2960 </p>
2963 Specifying a specific list of architectures indicates that the
2964 source will build an architecture-dependent package only on
2965 architectures included in the list. Specifying a list of
2966 architecture wildcards indicates that the source will build an
2967 architecture-dependent package on only those architectures
2968 that match any of the specified architecture wildcards.
2969 Specifying a list of architectures or architecture wildcards
2970 other than <tt>any</tt> is for the minority of cases where a
2971 program is not portable or is not useful on some
2972 architectures. Where possible, the program should be made
2973 portable instead.
2974 </p>
2977 In the source package control file <file>.dsc</file>, this
2978 field may contain either the architecture
2979 wildcard <tt>any</tt> or a list of architectures and
2980 architecture wildcards separated by spaces. If a list is
2981 given, it may include (or consist solely of) the special
2982 value <tt>all</tt>. In other words, in <file>.dsc</file>
2983 files unlike the <file>debian/control</file>, <tt>all</tt> may
2984 occur in combination with specific architectures.
2985 The <tt>Architecture</tt> field in the source package control
2986 file <file>.dsc</file> is generally constructed from
2987 the <tt>Architecture</tt> fields in
2988 the <file>debian/control</file> in the source package.
2989 </p>
2992 Specifying <tt>any</tt> indicates that the source package
2993 isn't dependent on any particular architecture and should
2994 compile fine on any one. The produced binary package(s)
2995 will either be specific to whatever the current build
2996 architecture is or will be architecture-independent.
2997 </p>
3000 Specifying only <tt>all</tt> indicates that the source package
3001 will only build architecture-independent packages. If this is
3002 the case, <tt>all</tt> must be used rather than <tt>any</tt>;
3003 <tt>any</tt> implies that the source package will build at
3004 least one architecture-dependent package.
3005 </p>
3008 Specifying a list of architectures or architecture wildcards
3009 indicates that the source will build an architecture-dependent
3010 package, and will only work correctly on the listed or
3011 matching architectures. If the source package also builds at
3012 least one architecture-independent package, <tt>all</tt> will
3013 also be included in the list.
3014 </p>
3017 In a <file>.changes</file> file, the <tt>Architecture</tt>
3018 field lists the architecture(s) of the package(s) currently
3019 being uploaded. This will be a list; if the source for the
3020 package is also being uploaded, the special
3021 entry <tt>source</tt> is also present. <tt>all</tt> will be
3022 present if any architecture-independent packages are being
3023 uploaded. Architecture wildcards such as <tt>any</tt> must
3024 never occur in the <tt>Architecture</tt> field in
3025 the <file>.changes</file> file.
3026 </p>
3029 See <ref id="debianrules"> for information on how to get
3030 the architecture for the build process.
3031 </p>
3032 </sect1>
3034 <sect1 id="f-Essential">
3035 <heading><tt>Essential</tt></heading>
3038 This is a boolean field which may occur only in the
3039 control file of a binary package or in a per-package fields
3040 paragraph of a source package control file.
3041 </p>
3044 If set to <tt>yes</tt> then the package management system
3045 will refuse to remove the package (upgrading and replacing
3046 it is still possible). The other possible value is <tt>no</tt>,
3047 which is the same as not having the field at all.
3048 </p>
3049 </sect1>
3051 <sect1>
3052 <heading>Package interrelationship fields:
3053 <tt>Depends</tt>, <tt>Pre-Depends</tt>,
3054 <tt>Recommends</tt>, <tt>Suggests</tt>,
3055 <tt>Breaks</tt>, <tt>Conflicts</tt>,
3056 <tt>Provides</tt>, <tt>Replaces</tt>, <tt>Enhances</tt>
3057 </heading>
3060 These fields describe the package's relationships with
3061 other packages. Their syntax and semantics are described
3062 in <ref id="relationships">.</p>
3063 </sect1>
3065 <sect1 id="f-Standards-Version">
3066 <heading><tt>Standards-Version</tt></heading>
3069 The most recent version of the standards (the policy
3070 manual and associated texts) with which the package
3071 complies.
3072 </p>
3075 The version number has four components: major and minor
3076 version number and major and minor patch level. When the
3077 standards change in a way that requires every package to
3078 change the major number will be changed. Significant
3079 changes that will require work in many packages will be
3080 signaled by a change to the minor number. The major patch
3081 level will be changed for any change to the meaning of the
3082 standards, however small; the minor patch level will be
3083 changed when only cosmetic, typographical or other edits
3084 are made which neither change the meaning of the document
3085 nor affect the contents of packages.
3086 </p>
3089 Thus only the first three components of the policy version
3090 are significant in the <em>Standards-Version</em> control
3091 field, and so either these three components or all four
3092 components may be specified.<footnote>
3093 In the past, people specified the full version number
3094 in the Standards-Version field, for example "2.3.0.0".
3095 Since minor patch-level changes don't introduce new
3096 policy, it was thought it would be better to relax
3097 policy and only require the first 3 components to be
3098 specified, in this example "2.3.0". All four
3099 components may still be used if someone wishes to do so.
3100 </footnote>
3101 </p>
3103 </sect1>
3105 <sect1 id="f-Version">
3106 <heading><tt>Version</tt></heading>
3109 The version number of a package. The format is:
3110 [<var>epoch</var><tt>:</tt>]<var>upstream_version</var>[<tt>-</tt><var>debian_revision</var>]
3111 </p>
3114 The three components here are:
3115 <taglist>
3116 <tag><var>epoch</var></tag>
3117 <item>
3119 This is a single (generally small) unsigned integer. It
3120 may be omitted, in which case zero is assumed. If it is
3121 omitted then the <var>upstream_version</var> may not
3122 contain any colons.
3123 </p>
3126 It is provided to allow mistakes in the version numbers
3127 of older versions of a package, and also a package's
3128 previous version numbering schemes, to be left behind.
3129 </p>
3130 </item>
3132 <tag><var>upstream_version</var></tag>
3133 <item>
3135 This is the main part of the version number. It is
3136 usually the version number of the original ("upstream")
3137 package from which the <file>.deb</file> file has been made,
3138 if this is applicable. Usually this will be in the same
3139 format as that specified by the upstream author(s);
3140 however, it may need to be reformatted to fit into the
3141 package management system's format and comparison
3142 scheme.
3143 </p>
3146 The comparison behavior of the package management system
3147 with respect to the <var>upstream_version</var> is
3148 described below. The <var>upstream_version</var>
3149 portion of the version number is mandatory.
3150 </p>
3153 The <var>upstream_version</var> may contain only
3154 alphanumerics<footnote>
3155 Alphanumerics are <tt>A-Za-z0-9</tt> only.
3156 </footnote>
3157 and the characters <tt>.</tt> <tt>+</tt> <tt>-</tt>
3158 <tt>:</tt> <tt>~</tt> (full stop, plus, hyphen, colon,
3159 tilde) and should start with a digit. If there is no
3160 <var>debian_revision</var> then hyphens are not allowed;
3161 if there is no <var>epoch</var> then colons are not
3162 allowed.
3163 </p>
3164 </item>
3166 <tag><var>debian_revision</var></tag>
3167 <item>
3169 This part of the version number specifies the version of
3170 the Debian package based on the upstream version. It
3171 may contain only alphanumerics and the characters
3172 <tt>+</tt> <tt>.</tt> <tt>~</tt> (plus, full stop,
3173 tilde) and is compared in the same way as the
3174 <var>upstream_version</var> is.
3175 </p>
3178 It is optional; if it isn't present then the
3179 <var>upstream_version</var> may not contain a hyphen.
3180 This format represents the case where a piece of
3181 software was written specifically to be a Debian
3182 package, where the Debian package source must always
3183 be identical to the pristine source and therefore no
3184 revision indication is required.
3185 </p>
3188 It is conventional to restart the
3189 <var>debian_revision</var> at <tt>1</tt> each time the
3190 <var>upstream_version</var> is increased.
3191 </p>
3194 The package management system will break the version
3195 number apart at the last hyphen in the string (if there
3196 is one) to determine the <var>upstream_version</var> and
3197 <var>debian_revision</var>. The absence of a
3198 <var>debian_revision</var> is equivalent to a
3199 <var>debian_revision</var> of <tt>0</tt>.
3200 </p>
3201 </item>
3202 </taglist>
3203 </p>
3206 When comparing two version numbers, first the <var>epoch</var>
3207 of each are compared, then the <var>upstream_version</var> if
3208 <var>epoch</var> is equal, and then <var>debian_revision</var>
3209 if <var>upstream_version</var> is also equal.
3210 <var>epoch</var> is compared numerically. The
3211 <var>upstream_version</var> and <var>debian_revision</var>
3212 parts are compared by the package management system using the
3213 following algorithm:
3214 </p>
3217 The strings are compared from left to right.
3218 </p>
3221 First the initial part of each string consisting entirely of
3222 non-digit characters is determined. These two parts (one of
3223 which may be empty) are compared lexically. If a difference
3224 is found it is returned. The lexical comparison is a
3225 comparison of ASCII values modified so that all the letters
3226 sort earlier than all the non-letters and so that a tilde
3227 sorts before anything, even the end of a part. For example,
3228 the following parts are in sorted order from earliest to
3229 latest: <tt>~~</tt>, <tt>~~a</tt>, <tt>~</tt>, the empty part,
3230 <tt>a</tt>.<footnote>
3231 One common use of <tt>~</tt> is for upstream pre-releases.
3232 For example, <tt>1.0~beta1~svn1245</tt> sorts earlier than
3233 <tt>1.0~beta1</tt>, which sorts earlier than <tt>1.0</tt>.
3234 </footnote>
3235 </p>
3238 Then the initial part of the remainder of each string which
3239 consists entirely of digit characters is determined. The
3240 numerical values of these two parts are compared, and any
3241 difference found is returned as the result of the comparison.
3242 For these purposes an empty string (which can only occur at
3243 the end of one or both version strings being compared) counts
3244 as zero.
3245 </p>
3248 These two steps (comparing and removing initial non-digit
3249 strings and initial digit strings) are repeated until a
3250 difference is found or both strings are exhausted.
3251 </p>
3254 Note that the purpose of epochs is to allow us to leave behind
3255 mistakes in version numbering, and to cope with situations
3256 where the version numbering scheme changes. It is
3257 <em>not</em> intended to cope with version numbers containing
3258 strings of letters which the package management system cannot
3259 interpret (such as <tt>ALPHA</tt> or <tt>pre-</tt>), or with
3260 silly orderings.<footnote>
3261 The author of this manual has heard of a package whose
3262 versions went <tt>1.1</tt>, <tt>1.2</tt>, <tt>1.3</tt>,
3263 <tt>1</tt>, <tt>2.1</tt>, <tt>2.2</tt>, <tt>2</tt> and so
3264 forth.
3265 </footnote>
3266 </p>
3267 </sect1>
3269 <sect1 id="f-Description">
3270 <heading><tt>Description</tt></heading>
3273 In a source or binary control file, the <tt>Description</tt>
3274 field contains a description of the binary package, consisting
3275 of two parts, the synopsis or the short description, and the
3276 long description. It is a multiline field with the following
3277 format:
3278 </p>
3281 <example>
3282 Description: &lt;single line synopsis&gt;
3283 &lt;extended description over several lines&gt;
3284 </example>
3285 </p>
3288 The lines in the extended description can have these formats:
3289 </p>
3291 <p><list>
3293 <item>
3294 Those starting with a single space are part of a paragraph.
3295 Successive lines of this form will be word-wrapped when
3296 displayed. The leading space will usually be stripped off.
3297 </item>
3299 <item>
3300 Those starting with two or more spaces. These will be
3301 displayed verbatim. If the display cannot be panned
3302 horizontally, the displaying program will line wrap them "hard"
3303 (i.e., without taking account of word breaks). If it can they
3304 will be allowed to trail off to the right. None, one or two
3305 initial spaces may be deleted, but the number of spaces
3306 deleted from each line will be the same (so that you can have
3307 indenting work correctly, for example).
3308 </item>
3310 <item>
3311 Those containing a single space followed by a single full stop
3312 character. These are rendered as blank lines. This is the
3313 <em>only</em> way to get a blank line<footnote>
3314 Completely empty lines will not be rendered as blank lines.
3315 Instead, they will cause the parser to think you're starting
3316 a whole new record in the control file, and will therefore
3317 likely abort with an error.
3318 </footnote>.
3319 </item>
3321 <item>
3322 Those containing a space, a full stop and some more characters.
3323 These are for future expansion. Do not use them.
3324 </item>
3326 </list></p>
3329 Do not use tab characters. Their effect is not predictable.
3330 </p>
3333 See <ref id="descriptions"> for further information on this.
3334 </p>
3337 In a <file>.changes</file> file, the <tt>Description</tt>
3338 field contains a summary of the descriptions for the packages
3339 being uploaded. For this case, the first line of the field
3340 value (the part on the same line as <tt>Description:</tt>) is
3341 always empty. It is a multiline field, with one
3342 line per package. Each line is
3343 indented by one space and contains the name of a binary
3344 package, a space, a hyphen (<tt>-</tt>), a space, and the
3345 short description line from that package.
3346 </p>
3347 </sect1>
3349 <sect1 id="f-Distribution">
3350 <heading><tt>Distribution</tt></heading>
3353 In a <file>.changes</file> file or parsed changelog output
3354 this contains the (space-separated) name(s) of the
3355 distribution(s) where this version of the package should
3356 be installed. Valid distributions are determined by the
3357 archive maintainers.<footnote>
3358 Example distribution names in the Debian archive used in
3359 <file>.changes</file> files are:
3360 <taglist compact="compact">
3361 <tag><em>unstable</em></tag>
3362 <item>
3363 This distribution value refers to the
3364 <em>developmental</em> part of the Debian distribution
3365 tree. Most new packages, new upstream versions of
3366 packages and bug fixes go into the <em>unstable</em>
3367 directory tree.
3368 </item>
3370 <tag><em>experimental</em></tag>
3371 <item>
3372 The packages with this distribution value are deemed
3373 by their maintainers to be high risk. Oftentimes they
3374 represent early beta or developmental packages from
3375 various sources that the maintainers want people to
3376 try, but are not ready to be a part of the other parts
3377 of the Debian distribution tree.
3378 </item>
3379 </taglist>
3382 Others are used for updating stable releases or for
3383 security uploads. More information is available in the
3384 Debian Developer's Reference, section "The Debian
3385 archive".
3386 </p>
3387 </footnote>
3388 The Debian archive software only supports listing a single
3389 distribution. Migration of packages to other distributions is
3390 handled outside of the upload process.
3391 </p>
3392 </sect1>
3394 <sect1 id="f-Date">
3395 <heading><tt>Date</tt></heading>
3398 This field includes the date the package was built or last
3399 edited. It must be in the same format as the <var>date</var>
3400 in a <file>debian/changelog</file> entry.
3401 </p>
3404 The value of this field is usually extracted from the
3405 <file>debian/changelog</file> file - see
3406 <ref id="dpkgchangelog">).
3407 </p>
3408 </sect1>
3410 <sect1 id="f-Format">
3411 <heading><tt>Format</tt></heading>
3414 In <qref id="debianchangesfiles"><file>.changes</file></qref>
3415 files, this field declares the format version of that file.
3416 The syntax of the field value is the same as that of
3417 a <qref id="f-Version">package version number</qref> except
3418 that no epoch or Debian revision is allowed. The format
3419 described in this document is <tt>&changesversion;</tt>.
3420 </p>
3423 In <qref id="debiansourcecontrolfiles"><file>.dsc</file>
3424 Debian source control</qref> files, this field declares the
3425 format of the source package. The field value is used by
3426 programs acting on a source package to interpret the list of
3427 files in the source package and determine how to unpack it.
3428 The syntax of the field value is a numeric major revision, a
3429 period, a numeric minor revision, and then an optional subtype
3430 after whitespace, which if specified is an alphanumeric word
3431 in parentheses. The subtype is optional in the syntax but may
3432 be mandatory for particular source format revisions.
3433 <footnote>
3434 The source formats currently supported by the Debian archive
3435 software are <tt>1.0</tt>, <tt>3.0 (native)</tt>,
3436 and <tt>3.0 (quilt)</tt>.
3437 </footnote>
3438 </p>
3439 </sect1>
3441 <sect1 id="f-Urgency">
3442 <heading><tt>Urgency</tt></heading>
3445 This is a description of how important it is to upgrade to
3446 this version from previous ones. It consists of a single
3447 keyword taking one of the values <tt>low</tt>,
3448 <tt>medium</tt>, <tt>high</tt>, <tt>emergency</tt>, or
3449 <tt>critical</tt><footnote>
3450 Other urgency values are supported with configuration
3451 changes in the archive software but are not used in Debian.
3452 The urgency affects how quickly a package will be considered
3453 for inclusion into the <tt>testing</tt> distribution and
3454 gives an indication of the importance of any fixes included
3455 in the upload. <tt>Emergency</tt> and <tt>critical</tt> are
3456 treated as synonymous.
3457 </footnote> (not case-sensitive) followed by an optional
3458 commentary (separated by a space) which is usually in
3459 parentheses. For example:
3461 <example>
3462 Urgency: low (HIGH for users of diversions)
3463 </example>
3465 </p>
3468 The value of this field is usually extracted from the
3469 <file>debian/changelog</file> file - see
3470 <ref id="dpkgchangelog">.
3471 </p>
3472 </sect1>
3474 <sect1 id="f-Changes">
3475 <heading><tt>Changes</tt></heading>
3478 This multiline field contains the human-readable changes data, describing
3479 the differences between the last version and the current one.
3480 </p>
3483 The first line of the field value (the part on the same line
3484 as <tt>Changes:</tt>) is always empty. The content of the
3485 field is expressed as continuation lines, with each line
3486 indented by at least one space. Blank lines must be
3487 represented by a line consisting only of a space and a full
3488 stop (<tt>.</tt>).
3489 </p>
3492 The value of this field is usually extracted from the
3493 <file>debian/changelog</file> file - see
3494 <ref id="dpkgchangelog">).
3495 </p>
3498 Each version's change information should be preceded by a
3499 "title" line giving at least the version, distribution(s)
3500 and urgency, in a human-readable way.
3501 </p>
3504 If data from several versions is being returned the entry
3505 for the most recent version should be returned first, and
3506 entries should be separated by the representation of a
3507 blank line (the "title" line may also be followed by the
3508 representation of a blank line).
3509 </p>
3510 </sect1>
3512 <sect1 id="f-Binary">
3513 <heading><tt>Binary</tt></heading>
3516 This folded field is a list of binary packages. Its syntax and
3517 meaning varies depending on the control file in which it
3518 appears.
3519 </p>
3522 When it appears in the <file>.dsc</file> file, it lists binary
3523 packages which a source package can produce, separated by
3524 commas<footnote>
3525 A space after each comma is conventional.
3526 </footnote>. The source package
3527 does not necessarily produce all of these binary packages for
3528 every architecture. The source control file doesn't contain
3529 details of which architectures are appropriate for which of
3530 the binary packages.
3531 </p>
3534 When it appears in a <file>.changes</file> file, it lists the
3535 names of the binary packages being uploaded, separated by
3536 whitespace (not commas).
3537 </p>
3538 </sect1>
3540 <sect1 id="f-Installed-Size">
3541 <heading><tt>Installed-Size</tt></heading>
3544 This field appears in the control files of binary packages,
3545 and in the <file>Packages</file> files. It gives an estimate
3546 of the total amount of disk space required to install the
3547 named package. Actual installed size may vary based on block
3548 size, file system properties, or actions taken by package
3549 maintainer scripts.
3550 </p>
3553 The disk space is given as the integer value of the estimated
3554 installed size in bytes, divided by 1024 and rounded up.
3555 </p>
3556 </sect1>
3558 <sect1 id="f-Files">
3559 <heading><tt>Files</tt></heading>
3562 This field contains a list of files with information about
3563 each one. The exact information and syntax varies with
3564 the context.
3565 </p>
3568 In all cases, Files is a multiline field. The first line of
3569 the field value (the part on the same line as <tt>Files:</tt>)
3570 is always empty. The content of the field is expressed as
3571 continuation lines, one line per file. Each line must be
3572 indented by one space and contain a number of sub-fields,
3573 separated by spaces, as described below.
3574 </p>
3577 In the <file>.dsc</file> file, each line contains the MD5
3578 checksum, size and filename of the tar file and (if
3579 applicable) diff file which make up the remainder of the
3580 source package<footnote>
3581 That is, the parts which are not the <tt>.dsc</tt>.
3582 </footnote>. For example:
3583 <example>
3584 Files:
3585 c6f698f19f2a2aa07dbb9bbda90a2754 571925 example_1.2.orig.tar.gz
3586 938512f08422f3509ff36f125f5873ba 6220 example_1.2-1.diff.gz
3587 </example>
3588 The exact forms of the filenames are described
3589 in <ref id="pkg-sourcearchives">.
3590 </p>
3593 In the <file>.changes</file> file this contains one line per
3594 file being uploaded. Each line contains the MD5 checksum,
3595 size, section and priority and the filename. For example:
3596 <example>
3597 Files:
3598 4c31ab7bfc40d3cf49d7811987390357 1428 text extra example_1.2-1.dsc
3599 c6f698f19f2a2aa07dbb9bbda90a2754 571925 text extra example_1.2.orig.tar.gz
3600 938512f08422f3509ff36f125f5873ba 6220 text extra example_1.2-1.diff.gz
3601 7c98fe853b3bbb47a00e5cd129b6cb56 703542 text extra example_1.2-1_i386.deb
3602 </example>
3603 The <qref id="f-Section">section</qref>
3604 and <qref id="f-Priority">priority</qref> are the values of
3605 the corresponding fields in the main source control file. If
3606 no section or priority is specified then <tt>-</tt> should be
3607 used, though section and priority values must be specified for
3608 new packages to be installed properly.
3609 </p>
3612 The special value <tt>byhand</tt> for the section in a
3613 <tt>.changes</tt> file indicates that the file in question
3614 is not an ordinary package file and must by installed by
3615 hand by the distribution maintainers. If the section is
3616 <tt>byhand</tt> the priority should be <tt>-</tt>.
3617 </p>
3620 If a new Debian revision of a package is being shipped and
3621 no new original source archive is being distributed the
3622 <tt>.dsc</tt> must still contain the <tt>Files</tt> field
3623 entry for the original source archive
3624 <file><var>package</var>_<var>upstream-version</var>.orig.tar.gz</file>,
3625 but the <file>.changes</file> file should leave it out. In
3626 this case the original source archive on the distribution
3627 site must match exactly, byte-for-byte, the original
3628 source archive which was used to generate the
3629 <file>.dsc</file> file and diff which are being uploaded.</p>
3630 </sect1>
3632 <sect1 id="f-Closes">
3633 <heading><tt>Closes</tt></heading>
3636 A space-separated list of bug report numbers that the upload
3637 governed by the .changes file closes.
3638 </p>
3639 </sect1>
3641 <sect1 id="f-Homepage">
3642 <heading><tt>Homepage</tt></heading>
3645 The URL of the web site for this package, preferably (when
3646 applicable) the site from which the original source can be
3647 obtained and any additional upstream documentation or
3648 information may be found. The content of this field is a
3649 simple URL without any surrounding characters such as
3650 <tt>&lt;&gt;</tt>.
3651 </p>
3652 </sect1>
3654 <sect1 id="f-Checksums">
3655 <heading><tt>Checksums-Sha1</tt>
3656 and <tt>Checksums-Sha256</tt></heading>
3659 These multiline fields contain a list of files with a checksum and size
3660 for each one. Both <tt>Checksums-Sha1</tt>
3661 and <tt>Checksums-Sha256</tt> have the same syntax and differ
3662 only in the checksum algorithm used: SHA-1
3663 for <tt>Checksums-Sha1</tt> and SHA-256
3664 for <tt>Checksums-Sha256</tt>.
3665 </p>
3668 <tt>Checksums-Sha1</tt> and <tt>Checksums-Sha256</tt> are
3669 multiline fields. The first line of the field value (the part
3670 on the same line as <tt>Checksums-Sha1:</tt>
3671 or <tt>Checksums-Sha256:</tt>) is always empty. The content
3672 of the field is expressed as continuation lines, one line per
3673 file. Each line consists of the checksum, a space, the file
3674 size, a space, and the file name. For example (from
3675 a <file>.changes</file> file):
3676 <example>
3677 Checksums-Sha1:
3678 1f418afaa01464e63cc1ee8a66a05f0848bd155c 1276 example_1.0-1.dsc
3679 a0ed1456fad61116f868b1855530dbe948e20f06 171602 example_1.0.orig.tar.gz
3680 5e86ecf0671e113b63388dac81dd8d00e00ef298 6137 example_1.0-1.debian.tar.gz
3681 71a0ff7da0faaf608481195f9cf30974b142c183 548402 example_1.0-1_i386.deb
3682 Checksums-Sha256:
3683 ac9d57254f7e835bed299926fd51bf6f534597cc3fcc52db01c4bffedae81272 1276 example_1.0-1.dsc
3684 0d123be7f51e61c4bf15e5c492b484054be7e90f3081608a5517007bfb1fd128 171602 example_1.0.orig.tar.gz
3685 f54ae966a5f580571ae7d9ef5e1df0bd42d63e27cb505b27957351a495bc6288 6137 example_1.0-1.debian.tar.gz
3686 3bec05c03974fdecd11d020fc2e8250de8404867a8a2ce865160c250eb723664 548402 example_1.0-1_i386.deb
3687 </example>
3688 </p>
3691 In the <file>.dsc</file> file, these fields should list all
3692 files that make up the source package. In
3693 the <file>.changes</file> file, these fields should list all
3694 files being uploaded. The list of files in these fields
3695 must match the list of files in the <tt>Files</tt> field.
3696 </p>
3697 </sect1>
3699 <sect1 id="f-DM-Upload-Allowed">
3700 <heading><tt>DM-Upload-Allowed</tt></heading>
3703 The most recent version of a package uploaded to unstable or
3704 experimental must include the field <tt>DM-Upload-Allowed:
3705 yes</tt> in the source section of its source control file for
3706 the Debian archive to accept uploads signed with a key in the
3707 Debian Maintainer keyring. See the General
3708 Resolution <url id="http://www.debian.org/vote/2007/vote_003"
3709 name="Endorse the concept of Debian Maintainers"> for more
3710 details.
3711 </p>
3712 </sect1>
3713 </sect>
3715 <sect>
3716 <heading>User-defined fields</heading>
3719 Additional user-defined fields may be added to the
3720 source package control file. Such fields will be
3721 ignored, and not copied to (for example) binary or
3722 source package control files or upload control files.
3723 </p>
3726 If you wish to add additional unsupported fields to
3727 these output files you should use the mechanism
3728 described here.
3729 </p>
3732 Fields in the main source control information file with
3733 names starting <tt>X</tt>, followed by one or more of
3734 the letters <tt>BCS</tt> and a hyphen <tt>-</tt>, will
3735 be copied to the output files. Only the part of the
3736 field name after the hyphen will be used in the output
3737 file. Where the letter <tt>B</tt> is used the field
3738 will appear in binary package control files, where the
3739 letter <tt>S</tt> is used in source package control
3740 files and where <tt>C</tt> is used in upload control
3741 (<tt>.changes</tt>) files.
3742 </p>
3745 For example, if the main source information control file
3746 contains the field
3747 <example>
3748 XBS-Comment: I stand between the candle and the star.
3749 </example>
3750 then the binary and source package control files will contain the
3751 field
3752 <example>
3753 Comment: I stand between the candle and the star.
3754 </example>
3755 </p>
3757 </sect>
3759 </chapt>
3762 <chapt id="maintainerscripts">
3763 <heading>Package maintainer scripts and installation procedure</heading>
3765 <sect>
3766 <heading>Introduction to package maintainer scripts</heading>
3769 It is possible to supply scripts as part of a package which
3770 the package management system will run for you when your
3771 package is installed, upgraded or removed.
3772 </p>
3775 These scripts are the control information
3776 files <prgn>preinst</prgn>, <prgn>postinst</prgn>, <prgn>prerm</prgn>
3777 and <prgn>postrm</prgn>. They must be proper executable files;
3778 if they are scripts (which is recommended), they must start with
3779 the usual <tt>#!</tt> convention. They should be readable and
3780 executable by anyone, and must not be world-writable.
3781 </p>
3784 The package management system looks at the exit status from
3785 these scripts. It is important that they exit with a
3786 non-zero status if there is an error, so that the package
3787 management system can stop its processing. For shell
3788 scripts this means that you <em>almost always</em> need to
3789 use <tt>set -e</tt> (this is usually true when writing shell
3790 scripts, in fact). It is also important, of course, that
3791 they exit with a zero status if everything went well.
3792 </p>
3795 Additionally, packages interacting with users
3796 using <prgn>debconf</prgn> in the <prgn>postinst</prgn> script
3797 should install a <prgn>config</prgn> script as a control
3798 information file. See <ref id="maintscriptprompt"> for details.
3799 </p>
3802 When a package is upgraded a combination of the scripts from
3803 the old and new packages is called during the upgrade
3804 procedure. If your scripts are going to be at all
3805 complicated you need to be aware of this, and may need to
3806 check the arguments to your scripts.
3807 </p>
3810 Broadly speaking the <prgn>preinst</prgn> is called before
3811 (a particular version of) a package is unpacked, and the
3812 <prgn>postinst</prgn> afterwards; the <prgn>prerm</prgn>
3813 before (a version of) a package is removed and the
3814 <prgn>postrm</prgn> afterwards.
3815 </p>
3818 Programs called from maintainer scripts should not normally
3819 have a path prepended to them. Before installation is
3820 started, the package management system checks to see if the
3821 programs <prgn>ldconfig</prgn>,
3822 <prgn>start-stop-daemon</prgn>, <prgn>install-info</prgn>,
3823 and <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> can be found via the
3824 <tt>PATH</tt> environment variable. Those programs, and any
3825 other program that one would expect to be in the
3826 <tt>PATH</tt>, should thus be invoked without an absolute
3827 pathname. Maintainer scripts should also not reset the
3828 <tt>PATH</tt>, though they might choose to modify it by
3829 prepending or appending package-specific directories. These
3830 considerations really apply to all shell scripts.</p>
3831 </sect>
3833 <sect id="idempotency">
3834 <heading>Maintainer scripts idempotency</heading>
3837 It is necessary for the error recovery procedures that the
3838 scripts be idempotent. This means that if it is run
3839 successfully, and then it is called again, it doesn't bomb
3840 out or cause any harm, but just ensures that everything is
3841 the way it ought to be. If the first call failed, or
3842 aborted half way through for some reason, the second call
3843 should merely do the things that were left undone the first
3844 time, if any, and exit with a success status if everything
3845 is OK.<footnote>
3846 This is so that if an error occurs, the user interrupts
3847 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> or some other unforeseen circumstance
3848 happens you don't leave the user with a badly-broken
3849 package when <prgn>dpkg</prgn> attempts to repeat the
3850 action.
3851 </footnote>
3852 </p>
3853 </sect>
3855 <sect id="controllingterminal">
3856 <heading>Controlling terminal for maintainer scripts</heading>
3859 Maintainer scripts are not guaranteed to run with a controlling
3860 terminal and may not be able to interact with the user. They
3861 must be able to fall back to noninteractive behavior if no
3862 controlling terminal is available. Maintainer scripts that
3863 prompt via a program conforming to the Debian Configuration
3864 Management Specification (see <ref id="maintscriptprompt">) may
3865 assume that program will handle falling back to noninteractive
3866 behavior.
3867 </p>
3870 For high-priority prompts without a reasonable default answer,
3871 maintainer scripts may abort if there is no controlling
3872 terminal. However, this situation should be avoided if at all
3873 possible, since it prevents automated or unattended installs.
3874 In most cases, users will consider this to be a bug in the
3875 package.
3876 </p>
3877 </sect>
3879 <sect id="exitstatus">
3880 <heading>Exit status</heading>
3883 Each script must return a zero exit status for
3884 success, or a nonzero one for failure, since the package
3885 management system looks for the exit status of these scripts
3886 and determines what action to take next based on that datum.
3887 </p>
3888 </sect>
3890 <sect id="mscriptsinstact"><heading>Summary of ways maintainer
3891 scripts are called
3892 </heading>
3895 What follows is a summary of all the ways in which maintainer
3896 scripts may be called along with what facilities those scripts
3897 may rely on being available at that time. Script names preceded
3898 by <var>new-</var> are the scripts from the new version of a
3899 package being installed, upgraded to, or downgraded to. Script
3900 names preceded by <var>old-</var> are the scripts from the old
3901 version of a package that is being upgraded from or downgraded
3902 from.
3903 </p>
3906 The <prgn>preinst</prgn> script may be called in the following
3907 ways:
3908 <taglist>
3909 <tag><var>new-preinst</var> <tt>install</tt></tag>
3910 <tag><var>new-preinst</var> <tt>install</tt>
3911 <var>old-version</var></tag>
3912 <tag><var>new-preinst</var> <tt>upgrade</tt>
3913 <var>old-version</var></tag>
3914 <item>
3915 The package will not yet be unpacked, so
3916 the <prgn>preinst</prgn> script cannot rely on any files
3917 included in its package. Only essential packages and
3918 pre-dependencies (<tt>Pre-Depends</tt>) may be assumed to be
3919 available. Pre-dependencies will have been configured at
3920 least once, but at the time the <prgn>preinst</prgn> is
3921 called they may only be in an unpacked or "Half-Configured"
3922 state if a previous version of the pre-dependency was
3923 completely configured and has not been removed since then.
3924 </item>
3926 <tag><var>old-preinst</var> <tt>abort-upgrade</tt>
3927 <var>new-version</var></tag>
3928 <item>
3929 Called during error handling of an upgrade that failed after
3930 unpacking the new package because the <tt>postrm
3931 upgrade</tt> action failed. The unpacked files may be
3932 partly from the new version or partly missing, so the script
3933 cannot rely on files included in the package. Package
3934 dependencies may not be available. Pre-dependencies will be
3935 at least unpacked following the same rules as above, except
3936 they may be only "Half-Installed" if an upgrade of the
3937 pre-dependency failed.<footnote>
3938 This can happen if the new version of the package no
3939 longer pre-depends on a package that had been partially
3940 upgraded.
3941 </footnote>
3942 </item>
3943 </taglist>
3944 </p>
3947 The <prgn>postinst</prgn> script may be called in the following
3948 ways:
3949 <taglist>
3950 <tag><var>postinst</var> <tt>configure</tt>
3951 <var>most-recently-configured-version</var></tag>
3952 <item>
3953 The files contained in the package will be unpacked. All
3954 package dependencies will at least be unpacked. If there
3955 are no circular dependencies involved, all package
3956 dependencies will be configured. For behavior in the case
3957 of circular dependencies, see the discussion
3958 in <ref id="binarydeps">.
3959 </item>
3961 <tag><var>old-postinst</var> <tt>abort-upgrade</tt>
3962 <var>new-version</var></tag>
3963 <tag><var>conflictor's-postinst</var> <tt>abort-remove</tt>
3964 <tt>in-favour</tt> <var>package</var>
3965 <var>new-version</var></tag>
3966 <tag><var>postinst</var> <tt>abort-remove</tt></tag>
3967 <tag><var>deconfigured's-postinst</var>
3968 <tt>abort-deconfigure</tt> <tt>in-favour</tt>
3969 <var>failed-install-package</var> <var>version</var>
3970 [<tt>removing</tt> <var>conflicting-package</var>
3971 <var>version</var>]</tag>
3972 <item>
3973 The files contained in the package will be unpacked. All
3974 package dependencies will at least be "Half-Installed" and
3975 will have previously been configured and not removed.
3976 However, dependencies may not be configured or even fully
3977 unpacked in some error situations.<footnote>
3978 For example, suppose packages foo and bar are installed
3979 with foo depending on bar. If an upgrade of bar were
3980 started and then aborted, and then an attempt to remove
3981 foo failed because its <prgn>prerm</prgn> script failed,
3982 foo's <tt>postinst abort-remove</tt> would be called with
3983 bar only "Half-Installed".
3984 </footnote>
3985 The <prgn>postinst</prgn> should still attempt any actions
3986 for which its dependencies are required, since they will
3987 normally be available, but consider the correct error
3988 handling approach if those actions fail. Aborting
3989 the <prgn>postinst</prgn> action if commands or facilities
3990 from the package dependencies are not available is often the
3991 best approach.
3992 </item>
3993 </taglist>
3994 </p>
3997 The <prgn>prerm</prgn> script may be called in the following
3998 ways:
3999 <taglist>
4000 <tag><var>prerm</var> <tt>remove</tt></tag>
4001 <tag><var>old-prerm</var>
4002 <tt>upgrade</tt><var>new-version</var></tag>
4003 <tag><var>conflictor's-prerm</var> <tt>remove</tt>
4004 <tt>in-favour</tt> <var>package</var>
4005 <var>new-version</var></tag>
4006 <tag><var>deconfigured's-prerm</var> <tt>deconfigure</tt>
4007 <tt>in-favour</tt> <var>package-being-installed</var>
4008 <var>version</var> [<tt>removing</tt>
4009 <var>conflicting-package</var> <var>version</var>]</tag>
4010 <item>
4011 The package whose <prgn>prerm</prgn> is being called will be
4012 at least "Half-Installed". All package dependencies will at
4013 least be "Half-Installed" and will have previously been
4014 configured and not removed. If there was no error, all
4015 dependencies will at least be unpacked, but these actions
4016 may be called in various error states where dependencies are
4017 only "Half-Installed" due to a partial upgrade.
4018 </item>
4020 <tag><var>new-prerm</var> <tt>failed-upgrade</tt>
4021 <var>old-version</var></tag>
4022 <item>
4023 Called during error handling when <tt>prerm upgrade</tt>
4024 fails. The new package will not yet be unpacked, and all
4025 the same constraints as for <tt>preinst upgrade</tt> apply.
4026 </item>
4027 </taglist>
4028 </p>
4031 The <prgn>postrm</prgn> script may be called in the following
4032 ways:
4033 <taglist>
4034 <tag><var>postrm</var> <tt>remove</tt></tag>
4035 <tag><var>postrm</var> <tt>purge</tt></tag>
4036 <tag><var>old-postrm</var> <tt>upgrade</tt>
4037 <var>new-version</var></tag>
4038 <tag><var>disappearer's-postrm</var> <tt>disappear</tt>
4039 <var>overwriter</var> <var>overwriter-version</var></tag>
4040 <item>
4041 The <prgn>postrm</prgn> script is called after the package's
4042 files have been removed or replaced. The package
4043 whose <prgn>postrm</prgn> is being called may have
4044 previously been deconfigured and only be unpacked, at which
4045 point subsequent package changes do not consider its
4046 dependencies. Therefore, all <prgn>postrm</prgn> actions
4047 may only rely on essential packages and must gracefully skip
4048 any actions that require the package's dependencies if those
4049 dependencies are unavailable.<footnote>
4050 This is often done by checking whether the command or
4051 facility the <prgn>postrm</prgn> intends to call is
4052 available before calling it. For example:
4053 <example>
4054 if [ "$1" = purge ] && [ -e /usr/share/debconf/confmodule ]; then
4055 . /usr/share/debconf/confmodule
4056 db_purge
4058 </example>
4059 in <prgn>postrm</prgn> purges the <prgn>debconf</prgn>
4060 configuration for the package
4061 if <package>debconf</package> is installed.
4062 </footnote>
4063 </item>
4065 <tag><var>new-postrm</var> <tt>failed-upgrade</tt>
4066 <var>old-version</var></tag>
4067 <item>
4068 Called when the old <tt>postrm upgrade</tt> action fails.
4069 The new package will be unpacked, but only essential
4070 packages and pre-dependencies can be relied on.
4071 Pre-dependencies will either be configured or will be
4072 "Unpacked" or "Half-Configured" but previously had been
4073 configured and was never removed.
4074 </item>
4076 <tag><var>new-postrm</var> <tt>abort-install</tt></tag>
4077 <tag><var>new-postrm</var> <tt>abort-install</tt>
4078 <var>old-version</var></tag>
4079 <tag><var>new-postrm</var> <tt>abort-upgrade</tt>
4080 <var>old-version</var></tag>
4081 <item>
4082 Called before unpacking the new package as part of the
4083 error handling of <prgn>preinst</prgn> failures. May assume
4084 the same state as <prgn>preinst</prgn> can assume.
4085 </item>
4086 </taglist>
4087 </p>
4088 </sect>
4090 <sect id="unpackphase">
4091 <heading>Details of unpack phase of installation or upgrade</heading>
4094 The procedure on installation/upgrade/overwrite/disappear
4095 (i.e., when running <tt>dpkg --unpack</tt>, or the unpack
4096 stage of <tt>dpkg --install</tt>) is as follows. In each
4097 case, if a major error occurs (unless listed below) the
4098 actions are, in general, run backwards - this means that the
4099 maintainer scripts are run with different arguments in
4100 reverse order. These are the "error unwind" calls listed
4101 below.
4103 <enumlist>
4104 <item>
4105 <enumlist>
4106 <item>
4107 If a version of the package is already installed, call
4108 <example compact="compact">
4109 <var>old-prerm</var> upgrade <var>new-version</var>
4110 </example>
4111 </item>
4112 <item>
4113 If the script runs but exits with a non-zero
4114 exit status, <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will attempt:
4115 <example compact="compact">
4116 <var>new-prerm</var> failed-upgrade <var>old-version</var>
4117 </example>
4118 If this works, the upgrade continues. If this
4119 does not work, the error unwind:
4120 <example compact="compact">
4121 <var>old-postinst</var> abort-upgrade <var>new-version</var>
4122 </example>
4123 If this works, then the old-version is
4124 "Installed", if not, the old version is in a
4125 "Half-Configured" state.
4126 </item>
4127 </enumlist>
4128 </item>
4130 <item>
4131 If a "conflicting" package is being removed at the same time,
4132 or if any package will be broken (due to <tt>Breaks</tt>):
4133 <enumlist>
4134 <item>
4135 If <tt>--auto-deconfigure</tt> is
4136 specified, call, for each package to be deconfigured
4137 due to <tt>Breaks</tt>:
4138 <example compact="compact">
4139 <var>deconfigured's-prerm</var> deconfigure \
4140 in-favour <var>package-being-installed</var> <var>version</var>
4141 </example>
4142 Error unwind:
4143 <example compact="compact">
4144 <var>deconfigured's-postinst</var> abort-deconfigure \
4145 in-favour <var>package-being-installed-but-failed</var> <var>version</var>
4146 </example>
4147 The deconfigured packages are marked as
4148 requiring configuration, so that if
4149 <tt>--install</tt> is used they will be
4150 configured again if possible.
4151 </item>
4152 <item>
4153 If any packages depended on a conflicting
4154 package being removed and <tt>--auto-deconfigure</tt> is
4155 specified, call, for each such package:
4156 <example compact="compact">
4157 <var>deconfigured's-prerm</var> deconfigure \
4158 in-favour <var>package-being-installed</var> <var>version</var> \
4159 removing <var>conflicting-package</var> <var>version</var>
4160 </example>
4161 Error unwind:
4162 <example compact="compact">
4163 <var>deconfigured's-postinst</var> abort-deconfigure \
4164 in-favour <var>package-being-installed-but-failed</var> <var>version</var> \
4165 removing <var>conflicting-package</var> <var>version</var>
4166 </example>
4167 The deconfigured packages are marked as
4168 requiring configuration, so that if
4169 <tt>--install</tt> is used they will be
4170 configured again if possible.
4171 </item>
4172 <item>
4173 To prepare for removal of each conflicting package, call:
4174 <example compact="compact">
4175 <var>conflictor's-prerm</var> remove \
4176 in-favour <var>package</var> <var>new-version</var>
4177 </example>
4178 Error unwind:
4179 <example compact="compact">
4180 <var>conflictor's-postinst</var> abort-remove \
4181 in-favour <var>package</var> <var>new-version</var>
4182 </example>
4183 </item>
4184 </enumlist>
4185 </item>
4187 <item>
4188 <enumlist>
4189 <item>
4190 If the package is being upgraded, call:
4191 <example compact="compact">
4192 <var>new-preinst</var> upgrade <var>old-version</var>
4193 </example>
4194 If this fails, we call:
4195 <example>
4196 <var>new-postrm</var> abort-upgrade <var>old-version</var>
4197 </example>
4198 <enumlist>
4199 <item>
4201 If that works, then
4202 <example>
4203 <var>old-postinst</var> abort-upgrade <var>new-version</var>
4204 </example>
4205 is called. If this works, then the old version
4206 is in an "Installed" state, or else it is left
4207 in an "Unpacked" state.
4208 </p>
4209 </item>
4210 <item>
4212 If it fails, then the old version is left
4213 in an "Half-Installed" state.
4214 </p>
4215 </item>
4216 </enumlist>
4218 </item>
4219 <item>
4220 Otherwise, if the package had some configuration
4221 files from a previous version installed (i.e., it
4222 is in the "configuration files only" state):
4223 <example compact="compact">
4224 <var>new-preinst</var> install <var>old-version</var>
4225 </example>
4226 Error unwind:
4227 <example>
4228 <var>new-postrm</var> abort-install <var>old-version</var>
4229 </example>
4230 If this fails, the package is left in a
4231 "Half-Installed" state, which requires a
4232 reinstall. If it works, the packages is left in
4233 a "Config-Files" state.
4234 </item>
4235 <item>
4236 Otherwise (i.e., the package was completely purged):
4237 <example compact="compact">
4238 <var>new-preinst</var> install
4239 </example>
4240 Error unwind:
4241 <example compact="compact">
4242 <var>new-postrm</var> abort-install
4243 </example>
4244 If the error-unwind fails, the package is in a
4245 "Half-Installed" phase, and requires a
4246 reinstall. If the error unwind works, the
4247 package is in a not installed state.
4248 </item>
4249 </enumlist>
4250 </item>
4252 <item>
4254 The new package's files are unpacked, overwriting any
4255 that may be on the system already, for example any
4256 from the old version of the same package or from
4257 another package. Backups of the old files are kept
4258 temporarily, and if anything goes wrong the package
4259 management system will attempt to put them back as
4260 part of the error unwind.
4261 </p>
4264 It is an error for a package to contain files which
4265 are on the system in another package, unless
4266 <tt>Replaces</tt> is used (see <ref id="replaces">).
4267 <!--
4268 The following paragraph is not currently the case:
4269 Currently the <tt>- - force-overwrite</tt> flag is
4270 enabled, downgrading it to a warning, but this may not
4271 always be the case.
4273 </p>
4276 It is a more serious error for a package to contain a
4277 plain file or other kind of non-directory where another
4278 package has a directory (again, unless
4279 <tt>Replaces</tt> is used). This error can be
4280 overridden if desired using
4281 <tt>--force-overwrite-dir</tt>, but this is not
4282 advisable.
4283 </p>
4286 Packages which overwrite each other's files produce
4287 behavior which, though deterministic, is hard for the
4288 system administrator to understand. It can easily
4289 lead to "missing" programs if, for example, a package
4290 is unpacked which overwrites a file from another
4291 package, and is then removed again.<footnote>
4292 Part of the problem is due to what is arguably a
4293 bug in <prgn>dpkg</prgn>.
4294 </footnote>
4295 </p>
4298 A directory will never be replaced by a symbolic link
4299 to a directory or vice versa; instead, the existing
4300 state (symlink or not) will be left alone and
4301 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will follow the symlink if there is
4302 one.
4303 </p>
4304 </item>
4306 <item>
4308 <enumlist>
4309 <item>
4310 If the package is being upgraded, call
4311 <example compact="compact">
4312 <var>old-postrm</var> upgrade <var>new-version</var>
4313 </example>
4314 </item>
4315 <item>
4316 If this fails, <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will attempt:
4317 <example compact="compact">
4318 <var>new-postrm</var> failed-upgrade <var>old-version</var>
4319 </example>
4320 If this works, installation continues. If not,
4321 Error unwind:
4322 <example compact="compact">
4323 <var>old-preinst</var> abort-upgrade <var>new-version</var>
4324 </example>
4325 If this fails, the old version is left in a
4326 "Half-Installed" state. If it works, dpkg now
4327 calls:
4328 <example compact="compact">
4329 <var>new-postrm</var> abort-upgrade <var>old-version</var>
4330 </example>
4331 If this fails, the old version is left in a
4332 "Half-Installed" state. If it works, dpkg now
4333 calls:
4334 <example compact="compact">
4335 <var>old-postinst</var> abort-upgrade <var>new-version</var>
4336 </example>
4337 If this fails, the old version is in an
4338 "Unpacked" state.
4339 </item>
4340 </enumlist>
4341 </p>
4344 This is the point of no return - if
4345 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> gets this far, it won't back off
4346 past this point if an error occurs. This will
4347 leave the package in a fairly bad state, which
4348 will require a successful re-installation to clear
4349 up, but it's when <prgn>dpkg</prgn> starts doing
4350 things that are irreversible.
4351 </p>
4352 </item>
4354 <item>
4355 Any files which were in the old version of the package
4356 but not in the new are removed.
4357 </item>
4359 <item>
4360 The new file list replaces the old.
4361 </item>
4363 <item>
4364 The new maintainer scripts replace the old.
4365 </item>
4367 <item>
4368 Any packages all of whose files have been overwritten
4369 during the installation, and which aren't required for
4370 dependencies, are considered to have been removed.
4371 For each such package
4372 <enumlist>
4373 <item>
4374 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> calls:
4375 <example compact="compact">
4376 <var>disappearer's-postrm</var> disappear \
4377 <var>overwriter</var> <var>overwriter-version</var>
4378 </example>
4379 </item>
4380 <item>
4381 The package's maintainer scripts are removed.
4382 </item>
4383 <item>
4384 It is noted in the status database as being in a
4385 sane state, namely not installed (any conffiles
4386 it may have are ignored, rather than being
4387 removed by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>). Note that
4388 disappearing packages do not have their prerm
4389 called, because <prgn>dpkg</prgn> doesn't know
4390 in advance that the package is going to
4391 vanish.
4392 </item>
4393 </enumlist>
4394 </item>
4396 <item>
4397 Any files in the package we're unpacking that are also
4398 listed in the file lists of other packages are removed
4399 from those lists. (This will lobotomize the file list
4400 of the "conflicting" package if there is one.)
4401 </item>
4403 <item>
4404 The backup files made during installation, above, are
4405 deleted.
4406 </item>
4408 <item>
4410 The new package's status is now sane, and recorded as
4411 "unpacked".
4412 </p>
4415 Here is another point of no return - if the
4416 conflicting package's removal fails we do not unwind
4417 the rest of the installation; the conflicting package
4418 is left in a half-removed limbo.
4419 </p>
4420 </item>
4422 <item>
4423 If there was a conflicting package we go and do the
4424 removal actions (described below), starting with the
4425 removal of the conflicting package's files (any that
4426 are also in the package being unpacked have already
4427 been removed from the conflicting package's file list,
4428 and so do not get removed now).
4429 </item>
4430 </enumlist>
4431 </p>
4432 </sect>
4434 <sect id="configdetails"><heading>Details of configuration</heading>
4437 When we configure a package (this happens with <tt>dpkg
4438 --install</tt> and <tt>dpkg --configure</tt>), we first
4439 update any <tt>conffile</tt>s and then call:
4440 <example compact="compact">
4441 <var>postinst</var> configure <var>most-recently-configured-version</var>
4442 </example>
4443 </p>
4446 No attempt is made to unwind after errors during
4447 configuration. If the configuration fails, the package is in
4448 a "Failed Config" state, and an error message is generated.
4449 </p>
4452 If there is no most recently configured version
4453 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will pass a null argument.
4454 <footnote>
4456 Historical note: Truly ancient (pre-1997) versions of
4457 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> passed <tt>&lt;unknown&gt;</tt>
4458 (including the angle brackets) in this case. Even older
4459 ones did not pass a second argument at all, under any
4460 circumstance. Note that upgrades using such an old dpkg
4461 version are unlikely to work for other reasons, even if
4462 this old argument behavior is handled by your postinst script.
4463 </p>
4464 </footnote>
4465 </p>
4466 </sect>
4468 <sect id="removedetails"><heading>Details of removal and/or
4469 configuration purging</heading>
4472 <enumlist>
4473 <item>
4475 <example compact="compact">
4476 <var>prerm</var> remove
4477 </example>
4478 </p>
4480 If prerm fails during replacement due to conflict
4481 <example>
4482 <var>conflictor's-postinst</var> abort-remove \
4483 in-favour <var>package</var> <var>new-version</var>
4484 </example>
4485 Or else we call:
4486 <example>
4487 <var>postinst</var> abort-remove
4488 </example>
4489 </p>
4491 If this fails, the package is in a "Half-Configured"
4492 state, or else it remains "Installed".
4493 </p>
4494 </item>
4495 <item>
4496 The package's files are removed (except <tt>conffile</tt>s).
4497 </item>
4498 <item>
4499 <example compact="compact">
4500 <var>postrm</var> remove
4501 </example>
4504 If it fails, there's no error unwind, and the package is in
4505 an "Half-Installed" state.
4506 </p>
4507 </item>
4508 <item>
4510 All the maintainer scripts except the <prgn>postrm</prgn>
4511 are removed.
4512 </p>
4515 If we aren't purging the package we stop here. Note
4516 that packages which have no <prgn>postrm</prgn> and no
4517 <tt>conffile</tt>s are automatically purged when
4518 removed, as there is no difference except for the
4519 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> status.
4520 </p>
4521 </item>
4522 <item>
4523 The <tt>conffile</tt>s and any backup files
4524 (<tt>~</tt>-files, <tt>#*#</tt> files,
4525 <tt>%</tt>-files, <tt>.dpkg-{old,new,tmp}</tt>, etc.)
4526 are removed.
4527 </item>
4528 <item>
4530 <example compact="compact">
4531 <var>postrm</var> purge
4532 </example>
4533 </p>
4535 If this fails, the package remains in a "Config-Files"
4536 state.
4537 </p>
4538 </item>
4539 <item>
4540 The package's file list is removed.
4541 </item>
4542 </enumlist>
4544 </p>
4545 </sect>
4546 </chapt>
4549 <chapt id="relationships">
4550 <heading>Declaring relationships between packages</heading>
4552 <sect id="depsyntax">
4553 <heading>Syntax of relationship fields</heading>
4556 These fields all have a uniform syntax. They are a list of
4557 package names separated by commas.
4558 </p>
4561 In the <tt>Depends</tt>, <tt>Recommends</tt>,
4562 <tt>Suggests</tt>, <tt>Pre-Depends</tt>,
4563 <tt>Build-Depends</tt> and <tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt>
4564 control fields of the package, which declare
4565 dependencies on other packages, the package names listed may
4566 also include lists of alternative package names, separated
4567 by vertical bar (pipe) symbols <tt>|</tt>. In such a case,
4568 if any one of the alternative packages is installed, that
4569 part of the dependency is considered to be satisfied.
4570 </p>
4573 All of the fields except for <tt>Provides</tt> may restrict
4574 their applicability to particular versions of each named
4575 package. This is done in parentheses after each individual
4576 package name; the parentheses should contain a relation from
4577 the list below followed by a version number, in the format
4578 described in <ref id="f-Version">.
4579 </p>
4582 The relations allowed are <tt>&lt;&lt;</tt>, <tt>&lt;=</tt>,
4583 <tt>=</tt>, <tt>&gt;=</tt> and <tt>&gt;&gt;</tt> for
4584 strictly earlier, earlier or equal, exactly equal, later or
4585 equal and strictly later, respectively. The deprecated
4586 forms <tt>&lt;</tt> and <tt>&gt;</tt> were used to mean
4587 earlier/later or equal, rather than strictly earlier/later,
4588 so they should not appear in new packages (though
4589 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> still supports them).
4590 </p>
4593 Whitespace may appear at any point in the version
4594 specification subject to the rules in <ref
4595 id="controlsyntax">, and must appear where it's necessary to
4596 disambiguate; it is not otherwise significant. All of the
4597 relationship fields can only be folded in source package control files. For
4598 consistency and in case of future changes to
4599 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> it is recommended that a single space be
4600 used after a version relationship and before a version
4601 number; it is also conventional to put a single space after
4602 each comma, on either side of each vertical bar, and before
4603 each open parenthesis. When opening a continuation line in a relationship field, it
4604 is conventional to do so after a comma and before the space
4605 following that comma.
4606 </p>
4609 For example, a list of dependencies might appear as:
4610 <example compact="compact">
4611 Package: mutt
4612 Version: 1.3.17-1
4613 Depends: libc6 (>= 2.2.1), exim | mail-transport-agent
4614 </example>
4615 </p>
4618 Relationships may be restricted to a certain set of
4619 architectures. This is indicated in brackets after each
4620 individual package name and the optional version specification.
4621 The brackets enclose a list of Debian architecture names
4622 separated by whitespace. Exclamation marks may be prepended to
4623 each of the names. (It is not permitted for some names to be
4624 prepended with exclamation marks while others aren't.)
4625 </p>
4628 For build relationship fields
4629 (<tt>Build-Depends</tt>, <tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt>,
4630 <tt>Build-Conflicts</tt> and <tt>Build-Conflicts-Indep</tt>), if
4631 the current Debian host architecture is not in this list and
4632 there are no exclamation marks in the list, or it is in the list
4633 with a prepended exclamation mark, the package name and the
4634 associated version specification are ignored completely for the
4635 purposes of defining the relationships.
4636 </p>
4639 For example:
4640 <example compact="compact">
4641 Source: glibc
4642 Build-Depends-Indep: texinfo
4643 Build-Depends: kernel-headers-2.2.10 [!hurd-i386],
4644 hurd-dev [hurd-i386], gnumach-dev [hurd-i386]
4645 </example>
4646 requires <tt>kernel-headers-2.2.10</tt> on all architectures
4647 other than hurd-i386 and requires <tt>hurd-dev</tt> and
4648 <tt>gnumach-dev</tt> only on hurd-i386.
4649 </p>
4652 For binary relationship fields, the architecture restriction
4653 syntax is only supported in the source package control
4654 file <file>debian/control</file>. When the corresponding binary
4655 package control file is generated, the relationship will either
4656 be omitted or included without the architecture restriction
4657 based on the architecture of the binary package. This means
4658 that architecture restrictions must not be used in binary
4659 relationship fields for architecture-independent packages
4660 (<tt>Architecture: all</tt>).
4661 </p>
4664 For example:
4665 <example compact="compact">
4666 Depends: foo [i386], bar [amd64]
4667 </example>
4668 becomes <tt>Depends: foo</tt> when the package is built on
4669 the <tt>i386</tt> architecture, <tt>Depends: bar</tt> when the
4670 package is built on the <tt>amd64</tt> architecture, and omitted
4671 entirely in binary packages built on all other architectures.
4672 </p>
4675 If the architecture-restricted dependency is part of a set of
4676 alternatives using <tt>|</tt>, that alternative is ignored
4677 completely on architectures that do not match the restriction.
4678 For example:
4679 <example compact="compact">
4680 Build-Depends: foo [!i386] | bar [!amd64]
4681 </example>
4682 is equivalent to <tt>bar</tt> on the i386 architecture, to
4683 <tt>foo</tt> on the amd64 architecture, and to <tt>foo |
4684 bar</tt> on all other architectures.
4685 </p>
4688 Relationships may also be restricted to a certain set of
4689 architectures using architecture wildcards. The syntax for
4690 declaring such restrictions is the same as declaring
4691 restrictions using a certain set of architectures without
4692 architecture wildcards. For example:
4693 <example compact="compact">
4694 Build-Depends: foo [linux-any], bar [any-i386], baz [!linux-any]
4695 </example>
4696 is equivalent to <tt>foo</tt> on architectures using the Linux
4697 kernel and any cpu, <tt>bar</tt> on architectures using any
4698 kernel and an i386 cpu, and <tt>baz</tt> on any architecture
4699 using a kernel other than Linux.
4700 </p>
4703 Note that the binary package relationship fields such as
4704 <tt>Depends</tt> appear in one of the binary package
4705 sections of the control file, whereas the build-time
4706 relationships such as <tt>Build-Depends</tt> appear in the
4707 source package section of the control file (which is the
4708 first section).
4709 </p>
4710 </sect>
4712 <sect id="binarydeps">
4713 <heading>Binary Dependencies - <tt>Depends</tt>,
4714 <tt>Recommends</tt>, <tt>Suggests</tt>, <tt>Enhances</tt>,
4715 <tt>Pre-Depends</tt>
4716 </heading>
4719 Packages can declare in their control file that they have
4720 certain relationships to other packages - for example, that
4721 they may not be installed at the same time as certain other
4722 packages, and/or that they depend on the presence of others.
4723 </p>
4726 This is done using the <tt>Depends</tt>, <tt>Pre-Depends</tt>,
4727 <tt>Recommends</tt>, <tt>Suggests</tt>, <tt>Enhances</tt>,
4728 <tt>Breaks</tt> and <tt>Conflicts</tt> control fields.
4729 <tt>Breaks</tt> is described in <ref id="breaks">, and
4730 <tt>Conflicts</tt> is described in <ref id="conflicts">. The
4731 rest are described below.
4732 </p>
4735 These seven fields are used to declare a dependency
4736 relationship by one package on another. Except for
4737 <tt>Enhances</tt> and <tt>Breaks</tt>, they appear in the
4738 depending (binary) package's control file.
4739 (<tt>Enhances</tt> appears in the recommending package's
4740 control file, and <tt>Breaks</tt> appears in the version of
4741 depended-on package which causes the named package to
4742 break).
4743 </p>
4746 A <tt>Depends</tt> field takes effect <em>only</em> when a
4747 package is to be configured. It does not prevent a package
4748 being on the system in an unconfigured state while its
4749 dependencies are unsatisfied, and it is possible to replace
4750 a package whose dependencies are satisfied and which is
4751 properly installed with a different version whose
4752 dependencies are not and cannot be satisfied; when this is
4753 done the depending package will be left unconfigured (since
4754 attempts to configure it will give errors) and will not
4755 function properly. If it is necessary, a
4756 <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> field can be used, which has a partial
4757 effect even when a package is being unpacked, as explained
4758 in detail below. (The other three dependency fields,
4759 <tt>Recommends</tt>, <tt>Suggests</tt> and
4760 <tt>Enhances</tt>, are only used by the various front-ends
4761 to <prgn>dpkg</prgn> such as <prgn>apt-get</prgn>,
4762 <prgn>aptitude</prgn>, and <prgn>dselect</prgn>.)
4763 </p>
4766 Since <tt>Depends</tt> only places requirements on the order in
4767 which packages are configured, packages in an installation run
4768 are usually all unpacked first and all configured later.
4769 <footnote>
4770 This approach makes dependency resolution easier. If two
4771 packages A and B are being upgraded, the installed package A
4772 depends on exactly the installed package B, and the new
4773 package A depends on exactly the new package B (a common
4774 situation when upgrading shared libraries and their
4775 corresponding development packages), satisfying the
4776 dependencies at every stage of the upgrade would be
4777 impossible. This relaxed restriction means that both new
4778 packages can be unpacked together and then configured in their
4779 dependency order.
4780 </footnote>
4781 </p>
4784 If there is a circular dependency among packages being installed
4785 or removed, installation or removal order honoring the
4786 dependency order is impossible, requiring the dependency loop be
4787 broken at some point and the dependency requirements violated
4788 for at least one package. Packages involved in circular
4789 dependencies may not be able to rely on their dependencies being
4790 configured before they themselves are configured, depending on
4791 which side of the break of the circular dependency loop they
4792 happen to be on. If one of the packages in the loop has
4793 no <prgn>postinst</prgn> script, then the cycle will be broken
4794 at that package; this ensures that all <prgn>postinst</prgn>
4795 scripts are run with their dependencies properly configured if
4796 this is possible. Otherwise the breaking point is arbitrary.
4797 Packages should therefore avoid circular dependencies where
4798 possible, particularly if they have <prgn>postinst</prgn>
4799 scripts.
4800 </p>
4803 The meaning of the five dependency fields is as follows:
4804 <taglist>
4805 <tag><tt>Depends</tt></tag>
4806 <item>
4808 This declares an absolute dependency. A package will
4809 not be configured unless all of the packages listed in
4810 its <tt>Depends</tt> field have been correctly
4811 configured (unless there is a circular dependency as
4812 described above).
4813 </p>
4816 The <tt>Depends</tt> field should be used if the
4817 depended-on package is required for the depending
4818 package to provide a significant amount of
4819 functionality.
4820 </p>
4823 The <tt>Depends</tt> field should also be used if the
4824 <prgn>postinst</prgn> or <prgn>prerm</prgn> scripts
4825 require the depended-on package to be unpacked or
4826 configured in order to run. In the case of <tt>postinst
4827 configure</tt>, the depended-on packages will be unpacked
4828 and configured first. (If both packages are involved in a
4829 dependency loop, this might not work as expected; see the
4830 explanation a few paragraphs back.) In the case
4831 of <prgn>prerm</prgn> or other <prgn>postinst</prgn>
4832 actions, the package dependencies will normally be at
4833 least unpacked, but they may be only "Half-Installed" if a
4834 previous upgrade of the dependency failed.
4835 </p>
4838 Finally, the <tt>Depends</tt> field should be used if the
4839 depended-on package is needed by the <prgn>postrm</prgn>
4840 script to fully clean up after the package removal. There
4841 is no guarantee that package dependencies will be
4842 available when <prgn>postrm</prgn> is run, but the
4843 depended-on package is more likely to be available if the
4844 package declares a dependency (particularly in the case
4845 of <tt>postrm remove</tt>). The <prgn>postrm</prgn>
4846 script must gracefully skip actions that require a
4847 dependency if that dependency isn't available.
4848 </p>
4849 </item>
4851 <tag><tt>Recommends</tt></tag>
4852 <item>
4854 This declares a strong, but not absolute, dependency.
4855 </p>
4858 The <tt>Recommends</tt> field should list packages
4859 that would be found together with this one in all but
4860 unusual installations.
4861 </p>
4862 </item>
4864 <tag><tt>Suggests</tt></tag>
4865 <item>
4866 This is used to declare that one package may be more
4867 useful with one or more others. Using this field
4868 tells the packaging system and the user that the
4869 listed packages are related to this one and can
4870 perhaps enhance its usefulness, but that installing
4871 this one without them is perfectly reasonable.
4872 </item>
4874 <tag><tt>Enhances</tt></tag>
4875 <item>
4876 This field is similar to Suggests but works in the
4877 opposite direction. It is used to declare that a
4878 package can enhance the functionality of another
4879 package.
4880 </item>
4882 <tag><tt>Pre-Depends</tt></tag>
4883 <item>
4885 This field is like <tt>Depends</tt>, except that it
4886 also forces <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to complete installation
4887 of the packages named before even starting the
4888 installation of the package which declares the
4889 pre-dependency, as follows:
4890 </p>
4893 When a package declaring a pre-dependency is about to
4894 be <em>unpacked</em> the pre-dependency can be
4895 satisfied if the depended-on package is either fully
4896 configured, <em>or even if</em> the depended-on
4897 package(s) are only unpacked or in the "Half-Configured"
4898 state, provided that they have been configured
4899 correctly at some point in the past (and not removed
4900 or partially removed since). In this case, both the
4901 previously-configured and currently unpacked or
4902 "Half-Configured" versions must satisfy any version
4903 clause in the <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> field.
4904 </p>
4907 When the package declaring a pre-dependency is about to
4908 be <em>configured</em>, the pre-dependency will be treated
4909 as a normal <tt>Depends</tt>. It will be considered
4910 satisfied only if the depended-on package has been
4911 correctly configured. However, unlike
4912 with <tt>Depends</tt>, <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> does not
4913 permit circular dependencies to be broken. If a circular
4914 dependency is encountered while attempting to honor
4915 <tt>Pre-Depends</tt>, the installation will be aborted.
4916 </p>
4919 <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> are also required if the
4920 <prgn>preinst</prgn> script depends on the named package.
4921 It is best to avoid this situation if possible.
4922 </p>
4925 <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> should be used sparingly,
4926 preferably only by packages whose premature upgrade or
4927 installation would hamper the ability of the system to
4928 continue with any upgrade that might be in progress.
4929 </p>
4932 You should not specify a <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> entry for a
4933 package before this has been discussed on the
4934 <tt>debian-devel</tt> mailing list and a consensus about
4935 doing that has been reached. See <ref id="dependencies">.
4936 </p>
4937 </item>
4938 </taglist>
4939 </p>
4942 When selecting which level of dependency to use you should
4943 consider how important the depended-on package is to the
4944 functionality of the one declaring the dependency. Some
4945 packages are composed of components of varying degrees of
4946 importance. Such a package should list using
4947 <tt>Depends</tt> the package(s) which are required by the
4948 more important components. The other components'
4949 requirements may be mentioned as Suggestions or
4950 Recommendations, as appropriate to the components' relative
4951 importance.
4952 </p>
4953 </sect>
4955 <sect id="breaks">
4956 <heading>Packages which break other packages - <tt>Breaks</tt></heading>
4959 When one binary package declares that it breaks another,
4960 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will refuse to allow the package which
4961 declares <tt>Breaks</tt> to be unpacked unless the broken
4962 package is deconfigured first, and it will refuse to
4963 allow the broken package to be reconfigured.
4964 </p>
4967 A package will not be regarded as causing breakage merely
4968 because its configuration files are still installed; it must
4969 be at least "Half-Installed".
4970 </p>
4973 A special exception is made for packages which declare that
4974 they break their own package name or a virtual package which
4975 they provide (see below): this does not count as a real
4976 breakage.
4977 </p>
4980 Normally a <tt>Breaks</tt> entry will have an "earlier than"
4981 version clause; such a <tt>Breaks</tt> is introduced in the
4982 version of an (implicit or explicit) dependency which violates
4983 an assumption or reveals a bug in earlier versions of the broken
4984 package, or which takes over a file from earlier versions of the
4985 package named in <tt>Breaks</tt>. This use of <tt>Breaks</tt>
4986 will inform higher-level package management tools that the
4987 broken package must be upgraded before the new one.
4988 </p>
4991 If the breaking package also overwrites some files from the
4992 older package, it should use <tt>Replaces</tt> to ensure this
4993 goes smoothly. See <ref id="replaces"> for a full discussion
4994 of taking over files from other packages, including how to
4995 use <tt>Breaks</tt> in those cases.
4996 </p>
4999 Many of the cases where <tt>Breaks</tt> should be used were
5000 previously handled with <tt>Conflicts</tt>
5001 because <tt>Breaks</tt> did not yet exist.
5002 Many <tt>Conflicts</tt> fields should now be <tt>Breaks</tt>.
5003 See <ref id="conflicts"> for more information about the
5004 differences.
5005 </p>
5006 </sect>
5008 <sect id="conflicts">
5009 <heading>Conflicting binary packages - <tt>Conflicts</tt></heading>
5012 When one binary package declares a conflict with another using
5013 a <tt>Conflicts</tt> field, <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will refuse to
5014 allow them to be unpacked on the system at the same time. This
5015 is a stronger restriction than <tt>Breaks</tt>, which prevents
5016 the broken package from being configured while the breaking
5017 package is in the "Unpacked" state but allows both packages to
5018 be unpacked at the same time.
5019 </p>
5022 If one package is to be unpacked, the other must be removed
5023 first. If the package being unpacked is marked as replacing
5024 (see <ref id="replaces">, but note that <tt>Breaks</tt> should
5025 normally be used in this case) the one on the system, or the one
5026 on the system is marked as deselected, or both packages are
5027 marked <tt>Essential</tt>, then <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will
5028 automatically remove the package which is causing the conflict.
5029 Otherwise, it will halt the installation of the new package with
5030 an error. This mechanism is specifically designed to produce an
5031 error when the installed package is <tt>Essential</tt>, but the
5032 new package is not.
5033 </p>
5036 A package will not cause a conflict merely because its
5037 configuration files are still installed; it must be at least
5038 "Half-Installed".
5039 </p>
5042 A special exception is made for packages which declare a
5043 conflict with their own package name, or with a virtual
5044 package which they provide (see below): this does not
5045 prevent their installation, and allows a package to conflict
5046 with others providing a replacement for it. You use this
5047 feature when you want the package in question to be the only
5048 package providing some feature.
5049 </p>
5052 Normally, <tt>Breaks</tt> should be used instead
5053 of <tt>Conflicts</tt> since <tt>Conflicts</tt> imposes a
5054 stronger restriction on the ordering of package installation or
5055 upgrade and can make it more difficult for the package manager
5056 to find a correct solution to an upgrade or installation
5057 problem. <tt>Breaks</tt> should be used
5058 <list>
5059 <item>when moving a file from one package to another (see
5060 <ref id="replaces">),</item>
5061 <item>when splitting a package (a special case of the previous
5062 one), or</item>
5063 <item>when the breaking package exposes a bug in or interacts
5064 badly with particular versions of the broken
5065 package.</item>
5066 </list>
5067 <tt>Conflicts</tt> should be used
5068 <list>
5069 <item>when two packages provide the same file and will
5070 continue to do so,</item>
5071 <item>in conjunction with <tt>Provides</tt> when only one
5072 package providing a given virtual facility may be unpacked
5073 at a time (see <ref id="virtual">),</item>
5074 <item>in other cases where one must prevent simultaneous
5075 installation of two packages for reasons that are ongoing
5076 (not fixed in a later version of one of the packages) or
5077 that must prevent both packages from being unpacked at the
5078 same time, not just configured.</item>
5079 </list>
5080 Be aware that adding <tt>Conflicts</tt> is normally not the best
5081 solution when two packages provide the same files. Depending on
5082 the reason for that conflict, using alternatives or renaming the
5083 files is often a better approach. See, for
5084 example, <ref id="binaries">.
5085 </p>
5088 Neither <tt>Breaks</tt> nor <tt>Conflicts</tt> should be used
5089 unless two packages cannot be installed at the same time or
5090 installing them both causes one of them to be broken or
5091 unusable. Having similar functionality or performing the same
5092 tasks as another package is not sufficient reason to
5093 declare <tt>Breaks</tt> or <tt>Conflicts</tt> with that package.
5094 </p>
5097 A <tt>Conflicts</tt> entry may have an "earlier than" version
5098 clause if the reason for the conflict is corrected in a later
5099 version of one of the packages. However, normally the presence
5100 of an "earlier than" version clause is a sign
5101 that <tt>Breaks</tt> should have been used instead. An "earlier
5102 than" version clause in <tt>Conflicts</tt>
5103 prevents <prgn>dpkg</prgn> from upgrading or installing the
5104 package which declares such a conflict until the upgrade or
5105 removal of the conflicted-with package has been completed, which
5106 is a strong restriction.
5107 </p>
5108 </sect>
5110 <sect id="virtual"><heading>Virtual packages - <tt>Provides</tt>
5111 </heading>
5114 As well as the names of actual ("concrete") packages, the
5115 package relationship fields <tt>Depends</tt>,
5116 <tt>Recommends</tt>, <tt>Suggests</tt>, <tt>Enhances</tt>,
5117 <tt>Pre-Depends</tt>, <tt>Breaks</tt>, <tt>Conflicts</tt>,
5118 <tt>Build-Depends</tt>, <tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt>,
5119 <tt>Build-Conflicts</tt> and <tt>Build-Conflicts-Indep</tt>
5120 may mention "virtual packages".
5121 </p>
5124 A <em>virtual package</em> is one which appears in the
5125 <tt>Provides</tt> control field of another package. The effect
5126 is as if the package(s) which provide a particular virtual
5127 package name had been listed by name everywhere the virtual
5128 package name appears. (See also <ref id="virtual_pkg">)
5129 </p>
5132 If there are both concrete and virtual packages of the same
5133 name, then the dependency may be satisfied (or the conflict
5134 caused) by either the concrete package with the name in
5135 question or any other concrete package which provides the
5136 virtual package with the name in question. This is so that,
5137 for example, supposing we have
5138 <example compact="compact">
5139 Package: foo
5140 Depends: bar
5141 </example> and someone else releases an enhanced version of
5142 the <tt>bar</tt> package they can say:
5143 <example compact="compact">
5144 Package: bar-plus
5145 Provides: bar
5146 </example>
5147 and the <tt>bar-plus</tt> package will now also satisfy the
5148 dependency for the <tt>foo</tt> package.
5149 </p>
5152 If a relationship field has a version number attached, only real
5153 packages will be considered to see whether the relationship is
5154 satisfied (or the prohibition violated, for a conflict or
5155 breakage). In other words, if a version number is specified,
5156 this is a request to ignore all <tt>Provides</tt> for that
5157 package name and consider only real packages. The package
5158 manager will assume that a package providing that virtual
5159 package is not of the "right" version. A <tt>Provides</tt>
5160 field may not contain version numbers, and the version number of
5161 the concrete package which provides a particular virtual package
5162 will not be considered when considering a dependency on or
5163 conflict with the virtual package name.<footnote>
5164 It is possible that a future release of <prgn>dpkg</prgn> may
5165 add the ability to specify a version number for each virtual
5166 package it provides. This feature is not yet present,
5167 however, and is expected to be used only infrequently.
5168 </footnote>
5169 </p>
5172 To specify which of a set of real packages should be the default
5173 to satisfy a particular dependency on a virtual package, list
5174 the real package as an alternative before the virtual one.
5175 </p>
5178 If the virtual package represents a facility that can only be
5179 provided by one real package at a time, such as
5180 the <package>mail-transport-agent</package> virtual package that
5181 requires installation of a binary that would conflict with all
5182 other providers of that virtual package (see
5183 <ref id="mail-transport-agents">), all packages providing that
5184 virtual package should also declare a conflict with it
5185 using <tt>Conflicts</tt>. This will ensure that at most one
5186 provider of that virtual package is unpacked or installed at a
5187 time.
5188 </p>
5189 </sect>
5191 <sect id="replaces"><heading>Overwriting files and replacing
5192 packages - <tt>Replaces</tt></heading>
5195 Packages can declare in their control file that they should
5196 overwrite files in certain other packages, or completely replace
5197 other packages. The <tt>Replaces</tt> control field has these
5198 two distinct purposes.
5199 </p>
5201 <sect1><heading>Overwriting files in other packages</heading>
5204 It is usually an error for a package to contain files which
5205 are on the system in another package. However, if the
5206 overwriting package declares that it <tt>Replaces</tt> the one
5207 containing the file being overwritten, then <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
5208 will replace the file from the old package with that from the
5209 new. The file will no longer be listed as "owned" by the old
5210 package and will be taken over by the new package.
5211 Normally, <tt>Breaks</tt> should be used in conjunction
5212 with <tt>Replaces</tt>.<footnote>
5213 To see why <tt>Breaks</tt> is normally needed in addition
5214 to <tt>Replaces</tt>, consider the case of a file in the
5215 package <package>foo</package> being taken over by the
5216 package <package>foo-data</package>.
5217 <tt>Replaces</tt> will allow <package>foo-data</package> to
5218 be installed and take over that file. However,
5219 without <tt>Breaks</tt>, nothing
5220 requires <package>foo</package> to be upgraded to a newer
5221 version that knows it does not include that file and instead
5222 depends on <package>foo-data</package>. Nothing would
5223 prevent the new <package>foo-data</package> package from
5224 being installed and then removed, removing the file that it
5225 took over from <package>foo</package>. After that
5226 operation, the package manager would think the system was in
5227 a consistent state, but the <package>foo</package> package
5228 would be missing one of its files.
5229 </footnote>
5230 </p>
5233 For example, if a package <package>foo</package> is split
5234 into <package>foo</package> and <package>foo-data</package>
5235 starting at version 1.2-3, <package>foo-data</package> would
5236 have the fields
5237 <example compact="compact">
5238 Replaces: foo (&lt;&lt; 1.2-3)
5239 Breaks: foo (&lt;&lt; 1.2-3)
5240 </example>
5241 in its control file. The new version of the
5242 package <package>foo</package> would normally have the field
5243 <example compact="compact">
5244 Depends: foo-data (&gt;= 1.2-3)
5245 </example>
5246 (or possibly <tt>Recommends</tt> or even <tt>Suggests</tt> if
5247 the files moved into <package>foo-data</package> are not
5248 required for normal operation).
5249 </p>
5252 If a package is completely replaced in this way, so that
5253 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> does not know of any files it still
5254 contains, it is considered to have "disappeared". It will
5255 be marked as not wanted on the system (selected for
5256 removal) and not installed. Any <tt>conffile</tt>s
5257 details noted for the package will be ignored, as they
5258 will have been taken over by the overwriting package. The
5259 package's <prgn>postrm</prgn> script will be run with a
5260 special argument to allow the package to do any final
5261 cleanup required. See <ref id="mscriptsinstact">.
5262 <footnote>
5263 Replaces is a one way relationship. You have to install
5264 the replacing package after the replaced package.
5265 </footnote>
5266 </p>
5269 For this usage of <tt>Replaces</tt>, virtual packages (see
5270 <ref id="virtual">) are not considered when looking at a
5271 <tt>Replaces</tt> field. The packages declared as being
5272 replaced must be mentioned by their real names.
5273 </p>
5276 This usage of <tt>Replaces</tt> only takes effect when both
5277 packages are at least partially on the system at once. It is
5278 not relevant if the packages conflict unless the conflict has
5279 been overridden.
5280 </p>
5281 </sect1>
5283 <sect1><heading>Replacing whole packages, forcing their
5284 removal</heading>
5287 Second, <tt>Replaces</tt> allows the packaging system to
5288 resolve which package should be removed when there is a
5289 conflict (see <ref id="conflicts">). This usage only takes
5290 effect when the two packages <em>do</em> conflict, so that the
5291 two usages of this field do not interfere with each other.
5292 </p>
5295 In this situation, the package declared as being replaced
5296 can be a virtual package, so for example, all mail
5297 transport agents (MTAs) would have the following fields in
5298 their control files:
5299 <example compact="compact">
5300 Provides: mail-transport-agent
5301 Conflicts: mail-transport-agent
5302 Replaces: mail-transport-agent
5303 </example>
5304 ensuring that only one MTA can be unpacked at any one
5305 time. See <ref id="virtual"> for more information about this
5306 example.
5307 </sect1>
5308 </sect>
5310 <sect id="sourcebinarydeps">
5311 <heading>Relationships between source and binary packages -
5312 <tt>Build-Depends</tt>, <tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt>,
5313 <tt>Build-Conflicts</tt>, <tt>Build-Conflicts-Indep</tt>
5314 </heading>
5317 Source packages that require certain binary packages to be
5318 installed or absent at the time of building the package
5319 can declare relationships to those binary packages.
5320 </p>
5323 This is done using the <tt>Build-Depends</tt>,
5324 <tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt>, <tt>Build-Conflicts</tt> and
5325 <tt>Build-Conflicts-Indep</tt> control fields.
5326 </p>
5329 Build-dependencies on "build-essential" binary packages can be
5330 omitted. Please see <ref id="pkg-relations"> for more information.
5331 </p>
5334 The dependencies and conflicts they define must be satisfied
5335 (as defined earlier for binary packages) in order to invoke
5336 the targets in <tt>debian/rules</tt>, as follows:<footnote>
5338 There is no Build-Depends-Arch; this role is essentially
5339 met with Build-Depends. Anyone building the
5340 <tt>build-indep</tt> and <tt>binary-indep</tt> targets is
5341 assumed to be building the whole package, and therefore
5342 installation of all build dependencies is required.
5343 </p>
5345 The autobuilders use <tt>dpkg-buildpackage -B</tt>, which
5346 calls <tt>build</tt>, not <tt>build-arch</tt> since it does
5347 not yet know how to check for its existence, and
5348 <tt>binary-arch</tt>. The purpose of the original split
5349 between <tt>Build-Depends</tt> and
5350 <tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt> was so that the autobuilders
5351 wouldn't need to install extra packages needed only for the
5352 binary-indep targets. But without a build-arch/build-indep
5353 split, this didn't work, since most of the work is done in
5354 the build target, not in the binary target.
5355 </p>
5356 </footnote>
5357 <taglist>
5358 <tag><tt>clean</tt>, <tt>build-arch</tt>, and
5359 <tt>binary-arch</tt></tag>
5360 <item>
5361 Only the <tt>Build-Depends</tt> and <tt>Build-Conflicts</tt>
5362 fields must be satisfied when these targets are invoked.
5363 </item>
5364 <tag><tt>build</tt>, <tt>build-indep</tt>, <tt>binary</tt>,
5365 and <tt>binary-indep</tt></tag>
5366 <item>
5367 The <tt>Build-Depends</tt>, <tt>Build-Conflicts</tt>,
5368 <tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt>, and
5369 <tt>Build-Conflicts-Indep</tt> fields must be satisfied when
5370 these targets are invoked.
5371 </item>
5372 </taglist>
5373 </p>
5374 </sect>
5375 </chapt>
5378 <chapt id="sharedlibs"><heading>Shared libraries</heading>
5381 Packages containing shared libraries must be constructed with
5382 a little care to make sure that the shared library is always
5383 available. This is especially important for packages whose
5384 shared libraries are vitally important, such as the C library
5385 (currently <tt>libc6</tt>).
5386 </p>
5389 This section deals only with public shared libraries: shared
5390 libraries that are placed in directories searched by the dynamic
5391 linker by default or which are intended to be linked against
5392 normally and possibly used by other, independent packages. Shared
5393 libraries that are internal to a particular package or that are
5394 only loaded as dynamic modules are not covered by this section and
5395 are not subject to its requirements.
5396 </p>
5399 A shared library is identified by the <tt>SONAME</tt> attribute
5400 stored in its dynamic section. When a binary is linked against a
5401 shared library, the <tt>SONAME</tt> of the shared library is
5402 recorded in the binary's <tt>NEEDED</tt> section so that the
5403 dynamic linker knows that library must be loaded at runtime. The
5404 shared library file's full name (which usually contains additional
5405 version information not needed in the <tt>SONAME</tt>) is
5406 therefore normally not referenced directly. Instead, the shared
5407 library is loaded by its <tt>SONAME</tt>, which exists on the file
5408 system as a symlink pointing to the full name of the shared
5409 library. This symlink must be provided by the
5410 package. <ref id="sharedlibs-runtime"> describes how to do this.
5411 <footnote>
5412 This is a convention of shared library versioning, but not a
5413 requirement. Some libraries use the <tt>SONAME</tt> as the full
5414 library file name instead and therefore do not need a symlink.
5415 Most, however, encode additional information about
5416 backwards-compatible revisions as a minor version number in the
5417 file name. The <tt>SONAME</tt> itself only changes when
5418 binaries linked with the earlier version of the shared library
5419 may no longer work, but the filename may change with each
5420 release of the library. See <ref id="sharedlibs-runtime"> for
5421 more information.
5422 </footnote>
5423 </p>
5426 When linking a binary or another shared library against a shared
5427 library, the <tt>SONAME</tt> for that shared library is not yet
5428 known. Instead, the shared library is found by looking for a file
5429 matching the library name with <tt>.so</tt> appended. This file
5430 exists on the file system as a symlink pointing to the shared
5431 library.
5432 </p>
5435 Shared libraries are normally split into several binary packages.
5436 The <tt>SONAME</tt> symlink is installed by the runtime shared
5437 library package, and the bare <tt>.so</tt> symlink is installed in
5438 the development package since it's only used when linking binaries
5439 or shared libraries. However, there are some exceptions for
5440 unusual shared libraries or for shared libraries that are also
5441 loaded as dynamic modules by other programs.
5442 </p>
5445 This section is primarily concerned with how the separation of
5446 shared libraries into multiple packages should be done and how
5447 dependencies on and between shared library binary packages are
5448 managed in Debian. <ref id="libraries"> should be read in
5449 conjunction with this section and contains additional rules for
5450 the files contained in the shared library packages.
5451 </p>
5453 <sect id="sharedlibs-runtime">
5454 <heading>Run-time shared libraries</heading>
5457 The run-time shared library must be placed in a package
5458 whose name changes whenever the <tt>SONAME</tt> of the shared
5459 library changes. This allows several versions of the shared
5460 library to be installed at the same time, allowing installation
5461 of the new version of the shared library without immediately
5462 breaking binaries that depend on the old version. Normally, the
5463 run-time shared library and its <tt>SONAME</tt> symlink should
5464 be placed in a package named
5465 <package><var>libraryname</var><var>soversion</var></package>,
5466 where <var>soversion</var> is the version number in
5467 the <tt>SONAME</tt> of the shared library.
5468 See <ref id="shlibs"> for detailed information on how to
5469 determine this version. Alternatively, if it would be confusing
5470 to directly append <var>soversion</var>
5471 to <var>libraryname</var> (if, for example, <var>libraryname</var>
5472 itself ends in a number), you should use
5473 <package><var>libraryname</var>-<var>soversion</var></package>
5474 instead.
5475 </p>
5478 If you have several shared libraries built from the same source
5479 tree, you may lump them all together into a single shared
5480 library package provided that all of their <tt>SONAME</tt>s will
5481 always change together. Be aware that this is not normally the
5482 case, and if the <tt>SONAME</tt>s do not change together,
5483 upgrading such a merged shared library package will be
5484 unnecessarily difficult because of file conflicts with the old
5485 version of the package. When in doubt, always split shared
5486 library packages so that each binary package installs a single
5487 shared library.
5488 </p>
5491 Every time the shared library ABI changes in a way that may
5492 break binaries linked against older versions of the shared
5493 library, the <tt>SONAME</tt> of the library and the
5494 corresponding name for the binary package containing the runtime
5495 shared library should change. Normally, this means
5496 the <tt>SONAME</tt> should change any time an interface is
5497 removed from the shared library or the signature of an interface
5498 (the number of parameters or the types of parameters that it
5499 takes, for example) is changed. This practice is vital to
5500 allowing clean upgrades from older versions of the package and
5501 clean transitions between the old ABI and new ABI without having
5502 to upgrade every affected package simultaneously.
5503 </p>
5506 The <tt>SONAME</tt> and binary package name need not, and indeed
5507 normally should not, change if new interfaces are added but none
5508 are removed or changed, since this will not break binaries
5509 linked against the old shared library. Correct versioning of
5510 dependencies on the newer shared library by binaries that use
5511 the new interfaces is handled via
5512 the <qref id="sharedlibs-shlibdeps"><tt>shlibs</tt>
5513 system</qref> or via symbols files (see
5514 <manref name="deb-symbols" section="5">).
5515 </p>
5518 The package should install the shared libraries under
5519 their normal names. For example, the <package>libgdbm3</package>
5520 package should install <file>libgdbm.so.3.0.0</file> as
5521 <file>/usr/lib/libgdbm.so.3.0.0</file>. The files should not be
5522 renamed or re-linked by any <prgn>prerm</prgn> or
5523 <prgn>postrm</prgn> scripts; <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will take care
5524 of renaming things safely without affecting running programs,
5525 and attempts to interfere with this are likely to lead to
5526 problems.
5527 </p>
5530 Shared libraries should not be installed executable, since
5531 the dynamic linker does not require this and trying to
5532 execute a shared library usually results in a core dump.
5533 </p>
5536 The run-time library package should include the symbolic link for
5537 the <tt>SONAME</tt> that <prgn>ldconfig</prgn> would create for
5538 the shared libraries. For example,
5539 the <package>libgdbm3</package> package should include a symbolic
5540 link from <file>/usr/lib/libgdbm.so.3</file> to
5541 <file>libgdbm.so.3.0.0</file>. This is needed so that the dynamic
5542 linker (for example <prgn>ld.so</prgn> or
5543 <prgn>ld-linux.so.*</prgn>) can find the library between the
5544 time that <prgn>dpkg</prgn> installs it and the time that
5545 <prgn>ldconfig</prgn> is run in the <prgn>postinst</prgn>
5546 script.<footnote>
5547 The package management system requires the library to be
5548 placed before the symbolic link pointing to it in the
5549 <file>.deb</file> file. This is so that when
5550 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> comes to install the symlink
5551 (overwriting the previous symlink pointing at an older
5552 version of the library), the new shared library is already
5553 in place. In the past, this was achieved by creating the
5554 library in the temporary packaging directory before
5555 creating the symlink. Unfortunately, this was not always
5556 effective, since the building of the tar file in the
5557 <file>.deb</file> depended on the behavior of the underlying
5558 file system. Some file systems (such as reiserfs) reorder
5559 the files so that the order of creation is forgotten.
5560 Since version 1.7.0, <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
5561 reorders the files itself as necessary when building a
5562 package. Thus it is no longer important to concern
5563 oneself with the order of file creation.
5564 </footnote>
5565 </p>
5567 <sect1 id="ldconfig">
5568 <heading><tt>ldconfig</tt></heading>
5571 Any package installing shared libraries in one of the default
5572 library directories of the dynamic linker (which are currently
5573 <file>/usr/lib</file> and <file>/lib</file>) or a directory that is
5574 listed in <file>/etc/ld.so.conf</file><footnote>
5575 These are currently <file>/usr/local/lib</file> plus
5576 directories under <file>/lib</file> and <file>/usr/lib</file>
5577 matching the multiarch triplet for the system architecture.
5578 </footnote>
5579 must use <prgn>ldconfig</prgn> to update the shared library
5580 system.
5581 </p>
5584 The package maintainer scripts must only call
5585 <prgn>ldconfig</prgn> under these circumstances:
5586 <list compact="compact">
5587 <item>When the <prgn>postinst</prgn> script is run with a
5588 first argument of <tt>configure</tt>, the script must call
5589 <prgn>ldconfig</prgn>, and may optionally invoke
5590 <prgn>ldconfig</prgn> at other times.
5591 </item>
5592 <item>When the <prgn>postrm</prgn> script is run with a
5593 first argument of <tt>remove</tt>, the script should call
5594 <prgn>ldconfig</prgn>.
5595 </item>
5596 </list>
5597 <footnote>
5599 During install or upgrade, the preinst is called before
5600 the new files are unpacked, so calling "ldconfig" is
5601 pointless. The preinst of an existing package can also be
5602 called if an upgrade fails. However, this happens during
5603 the critical time when a shared libs may exist on-disk
5604 under a temporary name. Thus, it is dangerous and
5605 forbidden by current policy to call "ldconfig" at this
5606 time.
5607 </p>
5610 When a package is installed or upgraded, "postinst
5611 configure" runs after the new files are safely on-disk.
5612 Since it is perfectly safe to invoke ldconfig
5613 unconditionally in a postinst, it is OK for a package to
5614 simply put ldconfig in its postinst without checking the
5615 argument. The postinst can also be called to recover from
5616 a failed upgrade. This happens before any new files are
5617 unpacked, so there is no reason to call "ldconfig" at this
5618 point.
5619 </p>
5622 For a package that is being removed, prerm is
5623 called with all the files intact, so calling ldconfig is
5624 useless. The other calls to "prerm" happen in the case of
5625 upgrade at a time when all the files of the old package
5626 are on-disk, so again calling "ldconfig" is pointless.
5627 </p>
5630 postrm, on the other hand, is called with the "remove"
5631 argument just after the files are removed, so this is
5632 the proper time to call "ldconfig" to notify the system
5633 of the fact that the shared libraries from the package
5634 are removed. The postrm can be called at several other
5635 times. At the time of "postrm purge", "postrm
5636 abort-install", or "postrm abort-upgrade", calling
5637 "ldconfig" is useless because the shared lib files are
5638 not on-disk. However, when "postrm" is invoked with
5639 arguments "upgrade", "failed-upgrade", or "disappear", a
5640 shared lib may exist on-disk under a temporary filename.
5641 </p>
5642 </footnote>
5643 </p>
5644 </sect1>
5646 </sect>
5648 <sect id="sharedlibs-support-files">
5649 <heading>Shared library support files</heading>
5652 If your package contains files whose names do not change with
5653 each change in the library shared object version, you must not
5654 put them in the shared library package. Otherwise, several
5655 versions of the shared library cannot be installed at the same
5656 time without filename clashes, making upgrades and transitions
5657 unnecessarily difficult.
5658 </p>
5661 It is recommended that supporting files and run-time support
5662 programs that do not need to be invoked manually by users, but
5663 are nevertheless required for the package to function, be placed
5664 (if they are binary) in a subdirectory of <file>/usr/lib</file>,
5665 preferably under <file>/usr/lib/</file><var>package-name</var>.
5666 If the program or file is architecture independent, the
5667 recommendation is for it to be placed in a subdirectory of
5668 <file>/usr/share</file> instead, preferably under
5669 <file>/usr/share/</file><var>package-name</var>. Following the
5670 <var>package-name</var> naming convention ensures that the file
5671 names change when the shared object version changes.
5672 </p>
5675 Run-time support programs that use the shared library but are
5676 not required for the library to function or files used by the
5677 shared library that can be used by any version of the shared
5678 library package should instead be put in a separate package.
5679 This package might typically be named
5680 <package><var>libraryname</var>-tools</package>; note the
5681 absence of the <var>soversion</var> in the package name.
5682 </p>
5685 Files and support programs only useful when compiling software
5686 against the library should be included in the development
5687 package for the library.<footnote>
5688 For example, a <file><var>package-name</var>-config</file>
5689 script or <package>pkg-config</package> configuration files.
5690 </footnote>
5691 </p>
5692 </sect>
5694 <sect id="sharedlibs-static">
5695 <heading>Static libraries</heading>
5698 The static library (<file><var>libraryname.a</var></file>)
5699 is usually provided in addition to the shared version.
5700 It is placed into the development package (see below).
5701 </p>
5704 In some cases, it is acceptable for a library to be
5705 available in static form only; these cases include:
5706 <list>
5707 <item>libraries for languages whose shared library support
5708 is immature or unstable</item>
5709 <item>libraries whose interfaces are in flux or under
5710 development (commonly the case when the library's
5711 major version number is zero, or where the ABI breaks
5712 across patchlevels)</item>
5713 <item>libraries which are explicitly intended to be
5714 available only in static form by their upstream
5715 author(s)</item>
5716 </list>
5717 </p>
5719 <sect id="sharedlibs-dev">
5720 <heading>Development files</heading>
5723 If there are development files associated with a shared library,
5724 the source package needs to generate a binary development package
5725 named <package><var>libraryname</var><var>soversion</var>-dev</package>,
5726 or if you prefer only to support one development version at a
5727 time, <package><var>libraryname</var>-dev</package>. Installing
5728 the development package must result in installation of all the
5729 development files necessary for compiling programs against that
5730 shared library.<footnote>
5731 This wording allows the development files to be split into
5732 several packages, such as a separate architecture-independent
5733 <package><var>libraryname</var>-headers</package>, provided that
5734 the development package depends on all the required additional
5735 packages.
5736 </footnote>
5737 </p>
5740 In case several development versions of a library exist, you may
5741 need to use <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s Conflicts mechanism (see
5742 <ref id="conflicts">) to ensure that the user only installs one
5743 development version at a time (as different development versions are
5744 likely to have the same header files in them, which would cause a
5745 filename clash if both were unpacked).
5746 </p>
5749 The development package should contain a symlink for the associated
5750 shared library without a version number. For example, the
5751 <package>libgdbm-dev</package> package should include a symlink
5752 from <file>/usr/lib/libgdbm.so</file> to
5753 <file>libgdbm.so.3.0.0</file>. This symlink is needed by the linker
5754 (<prgn>ld</prgn>) when compiling packages, as it will only look for
5755 <file>libgdbm.so</file> when compiling dynamically.
5756 </p>
5759 If the package provides Ada Library Information
5760 (<file>*.ali</file>) files for use with GNAT, these files must be
5761 installed read-only (mode 0444) so that GNAT will not attempt to
5762 recompile them. This overrides the normal file mode requirements
5763 given in <ref id="permissions-owners">.
5764 </p>
5765 </sect>
5767 <sect id="sharedlibs-intradeps">
5768 <heading>Dependencies between the packages of the same library</heading>
5771 Typically the development version should have an exact
5772 version dependency on the runtime library, to make sure that
5773 compilation and linking happens correctly. The
5774 <tt>${binary:Version}</tt> substitution variable can be
5775 useful for this purpose.
5776 <footnote>
5777 Previously, <tt>${Source-Version}</tt> was used, but its name
5778 was confusing and it has been deprecated since dpkg 1.13.19.
5779 </footnote>
5780 </p>
5781 </sect>
5783 <sect id="sharedlibs-shlibdeps">
5784 <heading>Dependencies between the library and other packages -
5785 the <tt>shlibs</tt> system</heading>
5788 If a package contains a binary or library which links to a
5789 shared library, we must ensure that when the package is
5790 installed on the system, all of the libraries needed are
5791 also installed. This requirement led to the creation of the
5792 <tt>shlibs</tt> system, which is very simple in its design:
5793 any package which <em>provides</em> a shared library also
5794 provides information on the package dependencies required to
5795 ensure the presence of this library, and any package which
5796 <em>uses</em> a shared library uses this information to
5797 determine the dependencies it requires. The files which
5798 contain the mapping from shared libraries to the necessary
5799 dependency information are called <file>shlibs</file> files.
5800 </p>
5803 When a package is built which contains any shared libraries, it
5804 must provide a <file>shlibs</file> file for other packages to
5805 use. When a package is built which contains any shared
5806 libraries or compiled binaries, it must run
5807 <qref id="pkg-dpkg-shlibdeps"><prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn></qref>
5808 on these to determine the libraries used and hence the
5809 dependencies needed by this package.<footnote>
5811 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> will use a program
5812 like <prgn>objdump</prgn> or <prgn>readelf</prgn> to find
5813 the libraries directly needed by the binaries or shared
5814 libraries in the package.
5815 </p>
5818 We say that a binary <tt>foo</tt> <em>directly</em> uses
5819 a library <tt>libbar</tt> if it is explicitly linked
5820 with that library (that is, the library is listed in the ELF
5821 <tt>NEEDED</tt> attribute, caused by adding <tt>-lbar</tt>
5822 to the link line when the binary is created). Other
5823 libraries that are needed by <tt>libbar</tt> are linked
5824 <em>indirectly</em> to <tt>foo</tt>, and the dynamic
5825 linker will load them automatically when it loads
5826 <tt>libbar</tt>. A package should depend on the libraries
5827 it directly uses, but not the libraries it indirectly uses.
5828 The dependencies for those libraries will automatically pull
5829 in the other libraries.
5830 </p>
5833 A good example of where this helps is the following. We
5834 could update <tt>libimlib</tt> with a new version that
5835 supports a new graphics format called dgf (but retaining the
5836 same major version number) and depends on <tt>libdgf</tt>.
5837 If we used <prgn>ldd</prgn> to add dependencies for every
5838 library directly or indirectly linked with a binary, every
5839 package that uses <tt>libimlib</tt> would need to be
5840 recompiled so it would also depend on <tt>libdgf</tt> or it
5841 wouldn't run due to missing symbols. Since dependencies are
5842 only added based on ELF <tt>NEEDED</tt> attribute, packages
5843 using <tt>libimlib</tt> can rely on <tt>libimlib</tt> itself
5844 having the dependency on <tt>libdgf</tt> and so they would
5845 not need rebuilding.
5846 </p>
5847 </footnote>
5848 </p>
5851 In the following sections, we will first describe where the
5852 various <tt>shlibs</tt> files are to be found, then how to
5853 use <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn>, and finally the <tt>shlibs</tt>
5854 file format and how to create them if your package contains a
5855 shared library.
5856 </p>
5858 <sect1>
5859 <heading>The <tt>shlibs</tt> files present on the system</heading>
5862 There are several places where <tt>shlibs</tt> files are
5863 found. The following list gives them in the order in which
5864 they are read by
5865 <qref id="pkg-dpkg-shlibdeps"><prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn></qref>.
5866 (The first one which gives the required information is used.)
5867 </p>
5870 <list>
5871 <item>
5872 <p><file>debian/shlibs.local</file></p>
5875 This lists overrides for this package. This file should
5876 normally not be used, but may be needed temporarily in
5877 unusual situations to work around bugs in other packages,
5878 or in unusual cases where the normally declared dependency
5879 information in the installed <file>shlibs</file> file for
5880 a library cannot be used. This file overrides information
5881 obtained from any other source.
5882 </p>
5883 </item>
5885 <item>
5886 <p><file>/etc/dpkg/shlibs.override</file></p>
5889 This lists global overrides. This list is normally
5890 empty. It is maintained by the local system
5891 administrator.
5892 </p>
5893 </item>
5895 <item>
5896 <p><file>DEBIAN/shlibs</file> files in the "build directory"</p>
5899 When packages are being built,
5900 any <file>debian/shlibs</file> files are copied into the
5901 control information file area of the temporary build
5902 directory and given the name <file>shlibs</file>. These
5903 files give details of any shared libraries included in the
5904 same package.<footnote>
5905 An example may help here. Let us say that the source
5906 package <tt>foo</tt> generates two binary
5907 packages, <tt>libfoo2</tt> and <tt>foo-runtime</tt>.
5908 When building the binary packages, the two packages are
5909 created in the directories <file>debian/libfoo2</file>
5910 and <file>debian/foo-runtime</file> respectively.
5911 (<file>debian/tmp</file> could be used instead of one of
5912 these.) Since <tt>libfoo2</tt> provides the
5913 <tt>libfoo</tt> shared library, it will require a
5914 <tt>shlibs</tt> file, which will be installed in
5915 <file>debian/libfoo2/DEBIAN/shlibs</file>, eventually to
5916 become <file>/var/lib/dpkg/info/libfoo2.shlibs</file>.
5917 When <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> is run on the
5918 executable <file>debian/foo-runtime/usr/bin/foo-prog</file>,
5919 it will examine
5920 the <file>debian/libfoo2/DEBIAN/shlibs</file> file to
5921 determine whether <tt>foo-prog</tt>'s library
5922 dependencies are satisfied by any of the libraries
5923 provided by <tt>libfoo2</tt>. For this reason,
5924 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> must only be run once all of
5925 the individual binary packages' <tt>shlibs</tt> files
5926 have been installed into the build directory.
5927 </footnote>
5928 </p>
5929 </item>
5931 <item>
5932 <p><file>/var/lib/dpkg/info/*.shlibs</file></p>
5935 These are the <file>shlibs</file> files corresponding to
5936 all of the packages installed on the system, and are
5937 maintained by the relevant package maintainers.
5938 </p>
5939 </item>
5941 <item>
5942 <p><file>/etc/dpkg/shlibs.default</file></p>
5945 This file lists any shared libraries whose packages
5946 have failed to provide correct <file>shlibs</file> files.
5947 It was used when the <file>shlibs</file> setup was first
5948 introduced, but it is now normally empty. It is
5949 maintained by the <tt>dpkg</tt> maintainer.
5950 </p>
5951 </item>
5952 </list>
5953 </p>
5954 </sect1>
5956 <sect1>
5957 <heading>How to use <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> and the
5958 <file>shlibs</file> files</heading>
5961 Put a call to
5962 <qref id="pkg-dpkg-shlibdeps"><prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn></qref>
5963 into your <file>debian/rules</file> file. If your package
5964 contains only compiled binaries and libraries (but no scripts),
5965 you can use a command such as:
5966 <example compact="compact">
5967 dpkg-shlibdeps debian/tmp/usr/bin/* debian/tmp/usr/sbin/* \
5968 debian/tmp/usr/lib/*
5969 </example>
5970 Otherwise, you will need to explicitly list the compiled
5971 binaries and libraries.<footnote>
5972 If you are using <tt>debhelper</tt>, the
5973 <prgn>dh_shlibdeps</prgn> program will do this work for you.
5974 It will also correctly handle multi-binary packages.
5975 </footnote>
5976 </p>
5979 This command puts the dependency information into the
5980 <file>debian/substvars</file> file, which is then used by
5981 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn>. You will need to place a
5982 <tt>${shlibs:Depends}</tt> variable in the <tt>Depends</tt>
5983 field in the control file for this to work.
5984 </p>
5987 If you have multiple binary packages, you will need to call
5988 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> on each one which contains
5989 compiled libraries or binaries. In such a case, you will
5990 need to use the <tt>-T</tt> option to the <tt>dpkg</tt>
5991 utilities to specify a different <file>substvars</file> file.
5992 </p>
5995 If you are creating a udeb for use in the Debian Installer,
5996 you will need to specify that <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn>
5997 should use the dependency line of type <tt>udeb</tt> by
5998 adding the <tt>-tudeb</tt> option<footnote>
5999 <prgn>dh_shlibdeps</prgn> from the <tt>debhelper</tt> suite
6000 will automatically add this option if it knows it is
6001 processing a udeb.
6002 </footnote>. If there is no dependency line of
6003 type <tt>udeb</tt> in the <file>shlibs</file>
6004 file, <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> will fall back to the regular
6005 dependency line.
6006 </p>
6009 For more details on <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn>, please see
6010 <ref id="pkg-dpkg-shlibdeps"> and
6011 <manref name="dpkg-shlibdeps" section="1">.
6012 </p>
6013 </sect1>
6015 <sect1 id="shlibs">
6016 <heading>The <file>shlibs</file> File Format</heading>
6019 Each <file>shlibs</file> file has the same format. Lines
6020 beginning with <tt>#</tt> are considered to be comments and
6021 are ignored. Each line is of the form:
6022 <example compact="compact">
6023 [<var>type</var>: ]<var>library-name</var> <var>soname-version</var> <var>dependencies ...</var>
6024 </example>
6025 </p>
6028 We will explain this by reference to the example of the
6029 <tt>zlib1g</tt> package, which (at the time of writing)
6030 installs the shared library <file>/usr/lib/libz.so.1.1.3</file>.
6031 </p>
6034 <var>type</var> is an optional element that indicates the type
6035 of package for which the line is valid. The only type currently
6036 in use is <tt>udeb</tt>. The colon and space after the type are
6037 required.
6038 </p>
6041 <var>library-name</var> is the name of the shared library,
6042 in this case <tt>libz</tt>. (This must match the name part
6043 of the soname, see below.)
6044 </p>
6047 <var>soname-version</var> is the version part of the soname of
6048 the library. The soname is the thing that must exactly match
6049 for the library to be recognized by the dynamic linker, and is
6050 usually of the form
6051 <tt><var>name</var>.so.<var>major-version</var></tt>, in our
6052 example, <tt>libz.so.1</tt>.<footnote>
6053 This can be determined using the command
6054 <example compact="compact">
6055 objdump -p /usr/lib/libz.so.1.1.3 | grep SONAME
6056 </example>
6057 </footnote>
6058 The version part is the part which comes after
6059 <tt>.so.</tt>, so in our case, it is <tt>1</tt>. The soname may
6060 instead be of the form
6061 <tt><var>name</var>-<var>major-version</var>.so</tt>, such
6062 as <tt>libdb-4.8.so</tt>, in which case the name would
6063 be <tt>libdb</tt> and the version would be <tt>4.8</tt>.
6064 </p>
6067 <var>dependencies</var> has the same syntax as a dependency
6068 field in a binary package control file. It should give
6069 details of which packages are required to satisfy a binary
6070 built against the version of the library contained in the
6071 package. See <ref id="depsyntax"> for details.
6072 </p>
6075 In our example, if the first version of the <tt>zlib1g</tt>
6076 package which contained a minor number of at least
6077 <tt>1.3</tt> was <var>1:1.1.3-1</var>, then the
6078 <tt>shlibs</tt> entry for this library could say:
6079 <example compact="compact">
6080 libz 1 zlib1g (>= 1:1.1.3)
6081 </example>
6082 The version-specific dependency is to avoid warnings from
6083 the dynamic linker about using older shared libraries with
6084 newer binaries.
6085 </p>
6088 As zlib1g also provides a udeb containing the shared library,
6089 there would also be a second line:
6090 <example compact="compact">
6091 udeb: libz 1 zlib1g-udeb (>= 1:1.1.3)
6092 </example>
6093 </p>
6094 </sect1>
6096 <sect1>
6097 <heading>Providing a <file>shlibs</file> file</heading>
6100 If your package provides a shared library, you need to create
6101 a <file>shlibs</file> file following the format described above.
6102 It is usual to call this file <file>debian/shlibs</file> (but if
6103 you have multiple binary packages, you might want to call it
6104 <file>debian/shlibs.<var>package</var></file> instead). Then
6105 let <file>debian/rules</file> install it in the control
6106 information file area:
6107 <example compact="compact">
6108 install -m644 debian/shlibs debian/tmp/DEBIAN
6109 </example>
6110 or, in the case of a multi-binary package:
6111 <example compact="compact">
6112 install -m644 debian/shlibs.<var>package</var> debian/<var>package</var>/DEBIAN/shlibs
6113 </example>
6114 An alternative way of doing this is to create the
6115 <file>shlibs</file> file in the control information file area
6116 directly from <file>debian/rules</file> without using
6117 a <file>debian/shlibs</file> file at all,<footnote>
6118 This is what <prgn>dh_makeshlibs</prgn> in
6119 the <package>debhelper</package> suite does. If your package
6120 also has a udeb that provides a shared
6121 library, <prgn>dh_makeshlibs</prgn> can automatically generate
6122 the <tt>udeb:</tt> lines if you specify the name of the udeb
6123 with the <tt>--add-udeb</tt> option.
6124 </footnote>
6125 since the <file>debian/shlibs</file> file itself is ignored by
6126 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn>.
6127 </p>
6130 As <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> reads the
6131 <file>DEBIAN/shlibs</file> files in all of the binary packages
6132 being built from this source package, all of the
6133 <file>DEBIAN/shlibs</file> files should be installed before
6134 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> is called on any of the binary
6135 packages.
6136 </p>
6137 </sect1>
6138 </sect>
6139 </chapt>
6142 <chapt id="opersys"><heading>The Operating System</heading>
6144 <sect>
6145 <heading>File system hierarchy</heading>
6148 <sect1 id="fhs">
6149 <heading>File System Structure</heading>
6152 The location of all installed files and directories must
6153 comply with the Filesystem Hierarchy Standard (FHS),
6154 version 2.3, with the exceptions noted below, and except
6155 where doing so would violate other terms of Debian
6156 Policy. The following exceptions to the FHS apply:
6158 <enumlist>
6159 <item>
6161 The optional rules related to user specific
6162 configuration files for applications are stored in
6163 the user's home directory are relaxed. It is
6164 recommended that such files start with the
6165 '<tt>.</tt>' character (a "dot file"), and if an
6166 application needs to create more than one dot file
6167 then the preferred placement is in a subdirectory
6168 with a name starting with a '.' character, (a "dot
6169 directory"). In this case it is recommended the
6170 configuration files not start with the '.'
6171 character.
6172 </p>
6173 </item>
6174 <item>
6176 The requirement for amd64 to use <file>/lib64</file>
6177 for 64 bit binaries is removed.
6178 </p>
6179 </item>
6180 <item>
6182 The requirement for object files, internal binaries, and
6183 libraries, including <file>libc.so.*</file>, to be located
6184 directly under <file>/lib{,32}</file> and
6185 <file>/usr/lib{,32}</file> is amended, permitting files
6186 to instead be installed to
6187 <file>/lib/<var>triplet</var></file> and
6188 <file>/usr/lib/<var>triplet</var></file>, where
6189 <tt><var>triplet</var></tt> is the value returned by
6190 <tt>dpkg-architecture -qDEB_HOST_MULTIARCH</tt> for the
6191 architecture of the package. Packages may <em>not</em>
6192 install files to any <var>triplet</var> path other
6193 than the one matching the architecture of that package;
6194 for instance, an <tt>Architecture: amd64</tt> package
6195 containing 32-bit x86 libraries may not install these
6196 libraries to <file>/usr/lib/i386-linux-gnu</file>.
6197 <footnote>
6198 This is necessary in order to reserve the directories for
6199 use in cross-installation of library packages from other
6200 architectures, as part of the planned deployment of
6201 <tt>multiarch</tt>.
6202 </footnote>
6203 </p>
6205 Applications may also use a single subdirectory under
6206 <file>/usr/lib/<var>triplet</var></file>.
6207 </p>
6209 The execution time linker/loader, ld*, must still be made
6210 available in the existing location under /lib or /lib64
6211 since this is part of the ELF ABI for the architecture.
6212 </p>
6213 </item>
6214 <item>
6216 The requirement that
6217 <file>/usr/local/share/man</file> be "synonymous"
6218 with <file>/usr/local/man</file> is relaxed to a
6219 recommendation</p>
6220 </item>
6221 <item>
6223 The requirement that windowmanagers with a single
6224 configuration file call it <file>system.*wmrc</file>
6225 is removed, as is the restriction that the window
6226 manager subdirectory be named identically to the
6227 window manager name itself.
6228 </p>
6229 </item>
6230 <item>
6232 The requirement that boot manager configuration
6233 files live in <file>/etc</file>, or at least are
6234 symlinked there, is relaxed to a recommendation.
6235 </p>
6236 </item>
6237 <item>
6239 The following directories in the root filesystem are
6240 additionally allowed: <file>/sys</file> and
6241 <file>/selinux</file>. <footnote>These directories
6242 are used as mount points to mount virtual filesystems
6243 to get access to kernel information.</footnote>
6244 </p>
6245 </item>
6246 <item>
6248 On GNU/Hurd systems, the following additional
6249 directories are allowed in the root
6250 filesystem: <file>/hurd</file>
6251 and <file>/servers</file>.<footnote>
6252 These directories are used to store translators and as
6253 a set of standard names for mount points,
6254 respectively.
6255 </footnote>
6256 </p>
6257 </item>
6258 </enumlist>
6259 </p>
6262 The version of this document referred here can be
6263 found in the <tt>debian-policy</tt> package or on <url
6264 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/fhs/"
6265 name="FHS (Debian copy)"> alongside this manual (or, if
6266 you have the <package>debian-policy</package> installed,
6267 you can try <url
6268 id="file:///usr/share/doc/debian-policy/fhs/" name="FHS
6269 (local copy)">). The
6270 latest version, which may be a more recent version, may
6271 be found on
6272 <url id="http://www.pathname.com/fhs/" name="FHS (upstream)">.
6273 Specific questions about following the standard may be
6274 asked on the <tt>debian-devel</tt> mailing list, or
6275 referred to the FHS mailing list (see the
6276 <url id="http://www.pathname.com/fhs/" name="FHS web site"> for
6277 more information).
6278 </p>
6279 </sect1>
6281 <sect1>
6282 <heading>Site-specific programs</heading>
6285 As mandated by the FHS, packages must not place any
6286 files in <file>/usr/local</file>, either by putting them in
6287 the file system archive to be unpacked by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
6288 or by manipulating them in their maintainer scripts.
6289 </p>
6292 However, the package may create empty directories below
6293 <file>/usr/local</file> so that the system administrator knows
6294 where to place site-specific files. These are not
6295 directories <em>in</em> <file>/usr/local</file>, but are
6296 children of directories in <file>/usr/local</file>. These
6297 directories (<file>/usr/local/*/dir/</file>)
6298 should be removed on package removal if they are
6299 empty.
6300 </p>
6303 Note that this applies only to
6304 directories <em>below</em> <file>/usr/local</file>,
6305 not <em>in</em> <file>/usr/local</file>. Packages must
6306 not create sub-directories in the
6307 directory <file>/usr/local</file> itself, except those
6308 listed in FHS, section 4.5. However, you may create
6309 directories below them as you wish. You must not remove
6310 any of the directories listed in 4.5, even if you created
6311 them.
6312 </p>
6315 Since <file>/usr/local</file> can be mounted read-only from a
6316 remote server, these directories must be created and
6317 removed by the <prgn>postinst</prgn> and <prgn>prerm</prgn>
6318 maintainer scripts and not be included in the
6319 <file>.deb</file> archive. These scripts must not fail if
6320 either of these operations fail.
6321 </p>
6324 For example, the <tt>emacsen-common</tt> package could
6325 contain something like
6326 <example compact="compact">
6327 if [ ! -e /usr/local/share/emacs ]
6328 then
6329 if mkdir /usr/local/share/emacs 2>/dev/null
6330 then
6331 chown root:staff /usr/local/share/emacs
6332 chmod 2775 /usr/local/share/emacs
6335 </example>
6336 in its <prgn>postinst</prgn> script, and
6337 <example compact="compact">
6338 rmdir /usr/local/share/emacs/site-lisp 2>/dev/null || true
6339 rmdir /usr/local/share/emacs 2>/dev/null || true
6340 </example>
6341 in the <prgn>prerm</prgn> script. (Note that this form is
6342 used to ensure that if the script is interrupted, the
6343 directory <file>/usr/local/share/emacs</file> will still be
6344 removed.)
6345 </p>
6348 If you do create a directory in <file>/usr/local</file> for
6349 local additions to a package, you should ensure that
6350 settings in <file>/usr/local</file> take precedence over the
6351 equivalents in <file>/usr</file>.
6352 </p>
6355 However, because <file>/usr/local</file> and its contents are
6356 for exclusive use of the local administrator, a package
6357 must not rely on the presence or absence of files or
6358 directories in <file>/usr/local</file> for normal operation.
6359 </p>
6362 The <file>/usr/local</file> directory itself and all the
6363 subdirectories created by the package should (by default) have
6364 permissions 2775 (group-writable and set-group-id) and be
6365 owned by <tt>root:staff</tt>.
6366 </p>
6367 </sect1>
6369 <sect1>
6370 <heading>The system-wide mail directory</heading>
6372 The system-wide mail directory
6373 is <file>/var/mail</file>. This directory is part of the
6374 base system and should not be owned by any particular mail
6375 agents. The use of the old
6376 location <file>/var/spool/mail</file> is deprecated, even
6377 though the spool may still be physically located there.
6378 </p>
6379 </sect1>
6380 </sect>
6382 <sect>
6383 <heading>Users and groups</heading>
6385 <sect1>
6386 <heading>Introduction</heading>
6388 The Debian system can be configured to use either plain or
6389 shadow passwords.
6390 </p>
6393 Some user ids (UIDs) and group ids (GIDs) are reserved
6394 globally for use by certain packages. Because some
6395 packages need to include files which are owned by these
6396 users or groups, or need the ids compiled into binaries,
6397 these ids must be used on any Debian system only for the
6398 purpose for which they are allocated. This is a serious
6399 restriction, and we should avoid getting in the way of
6400 local administration policies. In particular, many sites
6401 allocate users and/or local system groups starting at 100.
6402 </p>
6405 Apart from this we should have dynamically allocated ids,
6406 which should by default be arranged in some sensible
6407 order, but the behavior should be configurable.
6408 </p>
6411 Packages other than <tt>base-passwd</tt> must not modify
6412 <file>/etc/passwd</file>, <file>/etc/shadow</file>,
6413 <file>/etc/group</file> or <file>/etc/gshadow</file>.
6414 </p>
6415 </sect1>
6417 <sect1>
6418 <heading>UID and GID classes</heading>
6420 The UID and GID numbers are divided into classes as
6421 follows:
6422 <taglist>
6423 <tag>0-99:</tag>
6424 <item>
6426 Globally allocated by the Debian project, the same
6427 on every Debian system. These ids will appear in
6428 the <file>passwd</file> and <file>group</file> files of all
6429 Debian systems, new ids in this range being added
6430 automatically as the <tt>base-passwd</tt> package is
6431 updated.
6432 </p>
6435 Packages which need a single statically allocated
6436 uid or gid should use one of these; their
6437 maintainers should ask the <tt>base-passwd</tt>
6438 maintainer for ids.
6439 </p>
6440 </item>
6442 <tag>100-999:</tag>
6443 <item>
6445 Dynamically allocated system users and groups.
6446 Packages which need a user or group, but can have
6447 this user or group allocated dynamically and
6448 differently on each system, should use <tt>adduser
6449 --system</tt> to create the group and/or user.
6450 <prgn>adduser</prgn> will check for the existence of
6451 the user or group, and if necessary choose an unused
6452 id based on the ranges specified in
6453 <file>adduser.conf</file>.
6454 </p>
6455 </item>
6457 <tag>1000-59999:</tag>
6458 <item>
6460 Dynamically allocated user accounts. By default
6461 <prgn>adduser</prgn> will choose UIDs and GIDs for
6462 user accounts in this range, though
6463 <file>adduser.conf</file> may be used to modify this
6464 behavior.
6465 </p>
6466 </item>
6468 <tag>60000-64999:</tag>
6469 <item>
6471 Globally allocated by the Debian project, but only
6472 created on demand. The ids are allocated centrally
6473 and statically, but the actual accounts are only
6474 created on users' systems on demand.
6475 </p>
6478 These ids are for packages which are obscure or
6479 which require many statically-allocated ids. These
6480 packages should check for and create the accounts in
6481 <file>/etc/passwd</file> or <file>/etc/group</file> (using
6482 <prgn>adduser</prgn> if it has this facility) if
6483 necessary. Packages which are likely to require
6484 further allocations should have a "hole" left after
6485 them in the allocation, to give them room to
6486 grow.
6487 </p>
6488 </item>
6490 <tag>65000-65533:</tag>
6491 <item>
6492 <p>Reserved.</p>
6493 </item>
6495 <tag>65534:</tag>
6496 <item>
6498 User <tt>nobody</tt>. The corresponding gid refers
6499 to the group <tt>nogroup</tt>.
6500 </p>
6501 </item>
6503 <tag>65535:</tag>
6504 <item>
6506 <tt>(uid_t)(-1) == (gid_t)(-1)</tt> <em>must
6507 not</em> be used, because it is the error return
6508 sentinel value.
6509 </p>
6510 </item>
6511 </taglist>
6512 </p>
6513 </sect1>
6514 </sect>
6516 <sect id="sysvinit">
6517 <heading>System run levels and <file>init.d</file> scripts</heading>
6519 <sect1 id="/etc/init.d">
6520 <heading>Introduction</heading>
6523 The <file>/etc/init.d</file> directory contains the scripts
6524 executed by <prgn>init</prgn> at boot time and when the
6525 init state (or "runlevel") is changed (see <manref
6526 name="init" section="8">).
6527 </p>
6530 There are at least two different, yet functionally
6531 equivalent, ways of handling these scripts. For the sake
6532 of simplicity, this document describes only the symbolic
6533 link method. However, it must not be assumed by maintainer
6534 scripts that this method is being used, and any automated
6535 manipulation of the various runlevel behaviors by
6536 maintainer scripts must be performed using
6537 <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> as described below and not by
6538 manually installing or removing symlinks. For information
6539 on the implementation details of the other method,
6540 implemented in the <tt>file-rc</tt> package, please refer
6541 to the documentation of that package.
6542 </p>
6545 These scripts are referenced by symbolic links in the
6546 <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file> directories. When changing
6547 runlevels, <prgn>init</prgn> looks in the directory
6548 <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file> for the scripts it should
6549 execute, where <tt><var>n</var></tt> is the runlevel that
6550 is being changed to, or <tt>S</tt> for the boot-up
6551 scripts.
6552 </p>
6555 The names of the links all have the form
6556 <file>S<var>mm</var><var>script</var></file> or
6557 <file>K<var>mm</var><var>script</var></file> where
6558 <var>mm</var> is a two-digit number and <var>script</var>
6559 is the name of the script (this should be the same as the
6560 name of the actual script in <file>/etc/init.d</file>).
6561 </p>
6564 When <prgn>init</prgn> changes runlevel first the targets
6565 of the links whose names start with a <tt>K</tt> are
6566 executed, each with the single argument <tt>stop</tt>,
6567 followed by the scripts prefixed with an <tt>S</tt>, each
6568 with the single argument <tt>start</tt>. (The links are
6569 those in the <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file> directory
6570 corresponding to the new runlevel.) The <tt>K</tt> links
6571 are responsible for killing services and the <tt>S</tt>
6572 link for starting services upon entering the runlevel.
6573 </p>
6576 For example, if we are changing from runlevel 2 to
6577 runlevel 3, init will first execute all of the <tt>K</tt>
6578 prefixed scripts it finds in <file>/etc/rc3.d</file>, and then
6579 all of the <tt>S</tt> prefixed scripts in that directory.
6580 The links starting with <tt>K</tt> will cause the
6581 referred-to file to be executed with an argument of
6582 <tt>stop</tt>, and the <tt>S</tt> links with an argument
6583 of <tt>start</tt>.
6584 </p>
6587 The two-digit number <var>mm</var> is used to determine
6588 the order in which to run the scripts: low-numbered links
6589 have their scripts run first. For example, the
6590 <tt>K20</tt> scripts will be executed before the
6591 <tt>K30</tt> scripts. This is used when a certain service
6592 must be started before another. For example, the name
6593 server <prgn>bind</prgn> might need to be started before
6594 the news server <prgn>inn</prgn> so that <prgn>inn</prgn>
6595 can set up its access lists. In this case, the script
6596 that starts <prgn>bind</prgn> would have a lower number
6597 than the script that starts <prgn>inn</prgn> so that it
6598 runs first:
6599 <example compact="compact">
6600 /etc/rc2.d/S17bind
6601 /etc/rc2.d/S70inn
6602 </example>
6603 </p>
6606 The two runlevels 0 (halt) and 6 (reboot) are slightly
6607 different. In these runlevels, the links with an
6608 <tt>S</tt> prefix are still called after those with a
6609 <tt>K</tt> prefix, but they too are called with the single
6610 argument <tt>stop</tt>.
6611 </p>
6612 </sect1>
6614 <sect1 id="writing-init">
6615 <heading>Writing the scripts</heading>
6618 Packages that include daemons for system services should
6619 place scripts in <file>/etc/init.d</file> to start or stop
6620 services at boot time or during a change of runlevel.
6621 These scripts should be named
6622 <file>/etc/init.d/<var>package</var></file>, and they should
6623 accept one argument, saying what to do:
6625 <taglist>
6626 <tag><tt>start</tt></tag>
6627 <item>start the service,</item>
6629 <tag><tt>stop</tt></tag>
6630 <item>stop the service,</item>
6632 <tag><tt>restart</tt></tag>
6633 <item>stop and restart the service if it's already running,
6634 otherwise start the service</item>
6636 <tag><tt>reload</tt></tag>
6637 <item><p>cause the configuration of the service to be
6638 reloaded without actually stopping and restarting
6639 the service,</item>
6641 <tag><tt>force-reload</tt></tag>
6642 <item>cause the configuration to be reloaded if the
6643 service supports this, otherwise restart the
6644 service.</item>
6645 </taglist>
6647 The <tt>start</tt>, <tt>stop</tt>, <tt>restart</tt>, and
6648 <tt>force-reload</tt> options should be supported by all
6649 scripts in <file>/etc/init.d</file>, the <tt>reload</tt>
6650 option is optional.
6651 </p>
6654 The <file>init.d</file> scripts must ensure that they will
6655 behave sensibly (i.e., returning success and not starting
6656 multiple copies of a service) if invoked with <tt>start</tt>
6657 when the service is already running, or with <tt>stop</tt>
6658 when it isn't, and that they don't kill unfortunately-named
6659 user processes. The best way to achieve this is usually to
6660 use <prgn>start-stop-daemon</prgn> with the <tt>--oknodo</tt>
6661 option.
6662 </p>
6665 Be careful of using <tt>set -e</tt> in <file>init.d</file>
6666 scripts. Writing correct <file>init.d</file> scripts requires
6667 accepting various error exit statuses when daemons are already
6668 running or already stopped without aborting
6669 the <file>init.d</file> script, and common <file>init.d</file>
6670 function libraries are not safe to call with <tt>set -e</tt>
6671 in effect<footnote>
6672 <tt>/lib/lsb/init-functions</tt>, which assists in writing
6673 LSB-compliant init scripts, may fail if <tt>set -e</tt> is
6674 in effect and echoing status messages to the console fails,
6675 for example.
6676 </footnote>. For <tt>init.d</tt> scripts, it's often easier
6677 to not use <tt>set -e</tt> and instead check the result of
6678 each command separately.
6679 </p>
6682 If a service reloads its configuration automatically (as
6683 in the case of <prgn>cron</prgn>, for example), the
6684 <tt>reload</tt> option of the <file>init.d</file> script
6685 should behave as if the configuration has been reloaded
6686 successfully.
6687 </p>
6690 The <file>/etc/init.d</file> scripts must be treated as
6691 configuration files, either (if they are present in the
6692 package, that is, in the .deb file) by marking them as
6693 <tt>conffile</tt>s, or, (if they do not exist in the .deb)
6694 by managing them correctly in the maintainer scripts (see
6695 <ref id="config-files">). This is important since we want
6696 to give the local system administrator the chance to adapt
6697 the scripts to the local system, e.g., to disable a
6698 service without de-installing the package, or to specify
6699 some special command line options when starting a service,
6700 while making sure their changes aren't lost during the next
6701 package upgrade.
6702 </p>
6705 These scripts should not fail obscurely when the
6706 configuration files remain but the package has been
6707 removed, as configuration files remain on the system after
6708 the package has been removed. Only when <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
6709 is executed with the <tt>--purge</tt> option will
6710 configuration files be removed. In particular, as the
6711 <file>/etc/init.d/<var>package</var></file> script itself is
6712 usually a <tt>conffile</tt>, it will remain on the system
6713 if the package is removed but not purged. Therefore, you
6714 should include a <tt>test</tt> statement at the top of the
6715 script, like this:
6716 <example compact="compact">
6717 test -f <var>program-executed-later-in-script</var> || exit 0
6718 </example>
6719 </p>
6722 Often there are some variables in the <file>init.d</file>
6723 scripts whose values control the behavior of the scripts,
6724 and which a system administrator is likely to want to
6725 change. As the scripts themselves are frequently
6726 <tt>conffile</tt>s, modifying them requires that the
6727 administrator merge in their changes each time the package
6728 is upgraded and the <tt>conffile</tt> changes. To ease
6729 the burden on the system administrator, such configurable
6730 values should not be placed directly in the script.
6731 Instead, they should be placed in a file in
6732 <file>/etc/default</file>, which typically will have the same
6733 base name as the <file>init.d</file> script. This extra file
6734 should be sourced by the script when the script runs. It
6735 must contain only variable settings and comments in SUSv3
6736 <prgn>sh</prgn> format. It may either be a
6737 <tt>conffile</tt> or a configuration file maintained by
6738 the package maintainer scripts. See <ref id="config-files">
6739 for more details.
6740 </p>
6743 To ensure that vital configurable values are always
6744 available, the <file>init.d</file> script should set default
6745 values for each of the shell variables it uses, either
6746 before sourcing the <file>/etc/default/</file> file or
6747 afterwards using something like the <tt>:
6748 ${VAR:=default}</tt> syntax. Also, the <file>init.d</file>
6749 script must behave sensibly and not fail if the
6750 <file>/etc/default</file> file is deleted.
6751 </p>
6754 <file>/var/run</file> and <file>/var/lock</file> may be mounted
6755 as temporary filesystems<footnote>
6756 For example, using the <tt>RAMRUN</tt> and <tt>RAMLOCK</tt>
6757 options in <file>/etc/default/rcS</file>.
6758 </footnote>, so the <file>init.d</file> scripts must handle this
6759 correctly. This will typically amount to creating any required
6760 subdirectories dynamically when the <file>init.d</file> script
6761 is run, rather than including them in the package and relying on
6762 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to create them.
6763 </p>
6764 </sect1>
6766 <sect1>
6767 <heading>Interfacing with the initscript system</heading>
6770 Maintainers should use the abstraction layer provided by
6771 the <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> and <prgn>invoke-rc.d</prgn>
6772 programs to deal with initscripts in their packages'
6773 scripts such as <prgn>postinst</prgn>, <prgn>prerm</prgn>
6774 and <prgn>postrm</prgn>.
6775 </p>
6778 Directly managing the /etc/rc?.d links and directly
6779 invoking the <file>/etc/init.d/</file> initscripts should
6780 be done only by packages providing the initscript
6781 subsystem (such as <prgn>sysv-rc</prgn> and
6782 <prgn>file-rc</prgn>).
6783 </p>
6785 <sect2>
6786 <heading>Managing the links</heading>
6789 The program <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> is provided for
6790 package maintainers to arrange for the proper creation and
6791 removal of <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file> symbolic links,
6792 or their functional equivalent if another method is being
6793 used. This may be used by maintainers in their packages'
6794 <prgn>postinst</prgn> and <prgn>postrm</prgn> scripts.
6795 </p>
6798 You must not include any <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file>
6799 symbolic links in the actual archive or manually create or
6800 remove the symbolic links in maintainer scripts; you must
6801 use the <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> program instead. (The
6802 former will fail if an alternative method of maintaining
6803 runlevel information is being used.) You must not include
6804 the <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file> directories themselves
6805 in the archive either. (Only the <tt>sysvinit</tt>
6806 package may do so.)
6807 </p>
6810 By default <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> will start services in
6811 each of the multi-user state runlevels (2, 3, 4, and 5)
6812 and stop them in the halt runlevel (0), the single-user
6813 runlevel (1) and the reboot runlevel (6). The system
6814 administrator will have the opportunity to customize
6815 runlevels by simply adding, moving, or removing the
6816 symbolic links in <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file> if
6817 symbolic links are being used, or by modifying
6818 <file>/etc/runlevel.conf</file> if the <tt>file-rc</tt> method
6819 is being used.
6820 </p>
6823 To get the default behavior for your package, put in your
6824 <prgn>postinst</prgn> script
6825 <example compact="compact">
6826 update-rc.d <var>package</var> defaults
6827 </example>
6828 and in your <prgn>postrm</prgn>
6829 <example compact="compact">
6830 if [ "$1" = purge ]; then
6831 update-rc.d <var>package</var> remove
6833 </example>. Note that if your package changes runlevels
6834 or priority, you may have to remove and recreate the links,
6835 since otherwise the old links may persist. Refer to the
6836 documentation of <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn>.
6837 </p>
6840 This will use a default sequence number of 20. If it does
6841 not matter when or in which order the <file>init.d</file>
6842 script is run, use this default. If it does, then you
6843 should talk to the maintainer of the <prgn>sysvinit</prgn>
6844 package or post to <tt>debian-devel</tt>, and they will
6845 help you choose a number.
6846 </p>
6849 For more information about using <tt>update-rc.d</tt>,
6850 please consult its man page <manref name="update-rc.d"
6851 section="8">.
6852 </p>
6853 </sect2>
6855 <sect2>
6856 <heading>Running initscripts</heading>
6858 The program <prgn>invoke-rc.d</prgn> is provided to make
6859 it easier for package maintainers to properly invoke an
6860 initscript, obeying runlevel and other locally-defined
6861 constraints that might limit a package's right to start,
6862 stop and otherwise manage services. This program may be
6863 used by maintainers in their packages' scripts.
6864 </p>
6867 The package maintainer scripts must use
6868 <prgn>invoke-rc.d</prgn> to invoke the
6869 <file>/etc/init.d/*</file> initscripts, instead of
6870 calling them directly.
6871 </p>
6874 By default, <prgn>invoke-rc.d</prgn> will pass any
6875 action requests (start, stop, reload, restart...) to the
6876 <file>/etc/init.d</file> script, filtering out requests
6877 to start or restart a service out of its intended
6878 runlevels.
6879 </p>
6882 Most packages will simply need to change:
6883 <example compact="compact">/etc/init.d/&lt;package&gt;
6884 &lt;action&gt;</example> in their <prgn>postinst</prgn>
6885 and <prgn>prerm</prgn> scripts to:
6886 <example compact="compact">
6887 if which invoke-rc.d >/dev/null 2>&1; then
6888 invoke-rc.d <var>package</var> &lt;action&gt;
6889 else
6890 /etc/init.d/<var>package</var> &lt;action&gt;
6892 </example>
6893 </p>
6896 A package should register its initscript services using
6897 <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> before it tries to invoke them
6898 using <prgn>invoke-rc.d</prgn>. Invocation of
6899 unregistered services may fail.
6900 </p>
6903 For more information about using
6904 <prgn>invoke-rc.d</prgn>, please consult its man page
6905 <manref name="invoke-rc.d" section="8">.
6906 </p>
6907 </sect2>
6908 </sect1>
6910 <sect1>
6911 <heading>Boot-time initialization</heading>
6914 There used to be another directory, <file>/etc/rc.boot</file>,
6915 which contained scripts which were run once per machine
6916 boot. This has been deprecated in favour of links from
6917 <file>/etc/rcS.d</file> to files in <file>/etc/init.d</file> as
6918 described in <ref id="/etc/init.d">. Packages must not
6919 place files in <file>/etc/rc.boot</file>.
6920 </p>
6921 </sect1>
6923 <sect1>
6924 <heading>Example</heading>
6927 An example on which you can base your
6928 <file>/etc/init.d</file> scripts is found in
6929 <file>/etc/init.d/skeleton</file>.
6930 </p>
6932 </sect1>
6933 </sect>
6935 <sect>
6936 <heading>Console messages from <file>init.d</file> scripts</heading>
6939 This section describes the formats to be used for messages
6940 written to standard output by the <file>/etc/init.d</file>
6941 scripts. The intent is to improve the consistency of
6942 Debian's startup and shutdown look and feel. For this
6943 reason, please look very carefully at the details. We want
6944 the messages to have the same format in terms of wording,
6945 spaces, punctuation and case of letters.
6946 </p>
6949 Here is a list of overall rules that should be used for
6950 messages generated by <file>/etc/init.d</file> scripts.
6951 </p>
6954 <list>
6955 <item>
6956 The message should fit in one line (fewer than 80
6957 characters), start with a capital letter and end with
6958 a period (<tt>.</tt>) and line feed (<tt>"\n"</tt>).
6959 </item>
6961 <item>
6962 If the script is performing some time consuming task in
6963 the background (not merely starting or stopping a
6964 program, for instance), an ellipsis (three dots:
6965 <tt>...</tt>) should be output to the screen, with no
6966 leading or tailing whitespace or line feeds.
6967 </item>
6969 <item>
6970 The messages should appear as if the computer is telling
6971 the user what it is doing (politely :-), but should not
6972 mention "it" directly. For example, instead of:
6973 <example compact="compact">
6974 I'm starting network daemons: nfsd mountd.
6975 </example>
6976 the message should say
6977 <example compact="compact">
6978 Starting network daemons: nfsd mountd.
6979 </example>
6980 </item>
6981 </list>
6982 </p>
6985 <tt>init.d</tt> script should use the following standard
6986 message formats for the situations enumerated below.
6987 </p>
6990 <list>
6991 <item>
6992 <p>When daemons are started</p>
6995 If the script starts one or more daemons, the output
6996 should look like this (a single line, no leading
6997 spaces):
6998 <example compact="compact">
6999 Starting <var>description</var>: <var>daemon-1</var> ... <var>daemon-n</var>.
7000 </example>
7001 The <var>description</var> should describe the
7002 subsystem the daemon or set of daemons are part of,
7003 while <var>daemon-1</var> up to <var>daemon-n</var>
7004 denote each daemon's name (typically the file name of
7005 the program).
7006 </p>
7009 For example, the output of <file>/etc/init.d/lpd</file>
7010 would look like:
7011 <example compact="compact">
7012 Starting printer spooler: lpd.
7013 </example>
7014 </p>
7017 This can be achieved by saying
7018 <example compact="compact">
7019 echo -n "Starting printer spooler: lpd"
7020 start-stop-daemon --start --quiet --exec /usr/sbin/lpd
7021 echo "."
7022 </example>
7023 in the script. If there are more than one daemon to
7024 start, the output should look like this:
7025 <example compact="compact">
7026 echo -n "Starting remote file system services:"
7027 echo -n " nfsd"; start-stop-daemon --start --quiet nfsd
7028 echo -n " mountd"; start-stop-daemon --start --quiet mountd
7029 echo -n " ugidd"; start-stop-daemon --start --quiet ugidd
7030 echo "."
7031 </example>
7032 This makes it possible for the user to see what is
7033 happening and when the final daemon has been started.
7034 Care should be taken in the placement of white spaces:
7035 in the example above the system administrators can
7036 easily comment out a line if they don't want to start
7037 a specific daemon, while the displayed message still
7038 looks good.
7039 </p>
7040 </item>
7042 <item>
7043 <p>When a system parameter is being set</p>
7046 If you have to set up different system parameters
7047 during the system boot, you should use this format:
7048 <example compact="compact">
7049 Setting <var>parameter</var> to "<var>value</var>".
7050 </example>
7051 </p>
7054 You can use a statement such as the following to get
7055 the quotes right:
7056 <example compact="compact">
7057 echo "Setting DNS domainname to \"$domainname\"."
7058 </example>
7059 </p>
7062 Note that the same symbol (<tt>"</tt>) <!-- " --> is used
7063 for the left and right quotation marks. A grave accent
7064 (<tt>`</tt>) is not a quote character; neither is an
7065 apostrophe (<tt>'</tt>).
7066 </p>
7067 </item>
7069 <item>
7070 <p>When a daemon is stopped or restarted</p>
7073 When you stop or restart a daemon, you should issue a
7074 message identical to the startup message, except that
7075 <tt>Starting</tt> is replaced with <tt>Stopping</tt>
7076 or <tt>Restarting</tt> respectively.
7077 </p>
7080 For example, stopping the printer daemon will look like
7081 this:
7082 <example compact="compact">
7083 Stopping printer spooler: lpd.
7084 </example>
7085 </p>
7086 </item>
7088 <item>
7089 <p>When something is executed</p>
7092 There are several examples where you have to run a
7093 program at system startup or shutdown to perform a
7094 specific task, for example, setting the system's clock
7095 using <prgn>netdate</prgn> or killing all processes
7096 when the system shuts down. Your message should look
7097 like this:
7098 <example compact="compact">
7099 Doing something very useful...done.
7100 </example>
7101 You should print the <tt>done.</tt> immediately after
7102 the job has been completed, so that the user is
7103 informed why they have to wait. You can get this
7104 behavior by saying
7105 <example compact="compact">
7106 echo -n "Doing something very useful..."
7107 do_something
7108 echo "done."
7109 </example>
7110 in your script.
7111 </p>
7112 </item>
7114 <item>
7115 <p>When the configuration is reloaded</p>
7118 When a daemon is forced to reload its configuration
7119 files you should use the following format:
7120 <example compact="compact">
7121 Reloading <var>description</var> configuration...done.
7122 </example>
7123 where <var>description</var> is the same as in the
7124 daemon starting message.
7125 </p>
7126 </item>
7127 </list>
7128 </p>
7129 </sect>
7131 <sect>
7132 <heading>Cron jobs</heading>
7135 Packages must not modify the configuration file
7136 <file>/etc/crontab</file>, and they must not modify the files in
7137 <file>/var/spool/cron/crontabs</file>.</p>
7140 If a package wants to install a job that has to be executed
7141 via cron, it should place a file with the name of the
7142 package in one or more of the following directories:
7143 <example compact="compact">
7144 /etc/cron.hourly
7145 /etc/cron.daily
7146 /etc/cron.weekly
7147 /etc/cron.monthly
7148 </example>
7149 As these directory names imply, the files within them are
7150 executed on an hourly, daily, weekly, or monthly basis,
7151 respectively. The exact times are listed in
7152 <file>/etc/crontab</file>.</p>
7155 All files installed in any of these directories must be
7156 scripts (e.g., shell scripts or Perl scripts) so that they
7157 can easily be modified by the local system administrator.
7158 In addition, they must be treated as configuration files.
7159 </p>
7162 If a certain job has to be executed at some other frequency or
7163 at a specific time, the package should install a file
7164 <file>/etc/cron.d/<var>package</var></file>. This file uses the
7165 same syntax as <file>/etc/crontab</file> and is processed by
7166 <prgn>cron</prgn> automatically. The file must also be
7167 treated as a configuration file. (Note that entries in the
7168 <file>/etc/cron.d</file> directory are not handled by
7169 <prgn>anacron</prgn>. Thus, you should only use this
7170 directory for jobs which may be skipped if the system is not
7171 running.)</p>
7173 Unlike <file>crontab</file> files described in the IEEE Std
7174 1003.1-2008 (POSIX.1) available from
7175 <url id="http://www.opengroup.org/onlinepubs/9699919799/"
7176 name="The Open Group">, the files in
7177 <file>/etc/cron.d</file> and the file
7178 <file>/etc/crontab</file> have seven fields; namely:
7179 <enumlist>
7180 <item>Minute [0,59]</item>
7181 <item>Hour [0,23]</item>
7182 <item>Day of the month [1,31]</item>
7183 <item>Month of the year [1,12]</item>
7184 <item>Day of the week ([0,6] with 0=Sunday)</item>
7185 <item>Username</item>
7186 <item>Command to be run</item>
7187 </enumlist>
7188 Ranges of numbers are allowed. Ranges are two numbers
7189 separated with a hyphen. The specified range is inclusive.
7190 Lists are allowed. A list is a set of numbers (or ranges)
7191 separated by commas. Step values can be used in conjunction
7192 with ranges.
7193 </p>
7196 The scripts or <tt>crontab</tt> entries in these directories should
7197 check if all necessary programs are installed before they
7198 try to execute them. Otherwise, problems will arise when a
7199 package was removed but not purged since configuration files
7200 are kept on the system in this situation.
7201 </p>
7204 Any <tt>cron</tt> daemon must provide
7205 <file>/usr/bin/crontab</file> and support normal
7206 <tt>crontab</tt> entries as specified in POSIX. The daemon
7207 must also support names for days and months, ranges, and
7208 step values. It has to support <file>/etc/crontab</file>,
7209 and correctly execute the scripts in
7210 <file>/etc/cron.d</file>. The daemon must also correctly
7211 execute scripts in
7212 <file>/etc/cron.{hourly,daily,weekly,monthly}</file>.
7213 </p>
7214 </sect>
7216 <sect id="menus">
7217 <heading>Menus</heading>
7220 The Debian <tt>menu</tt> package provides a standard
7221 interface between packages providing applications and
7222 <em>menu programs</em> (either X window managers or
7223 text-based menu programs such as <prgn>pdmenu</prgn>).
7224 </p>
7227 All packages that provide applications that need not be
7228 passed any special command line arguments for normal
7229 operation should register a menu entry for those
7230 applications, so that users of the <tt>menu</tt> package
7231 will automatically get menu entries in their window
7232 managers, as well in shells like <tt>pdmenu</tt>.
7233 </p>
7236 Menu entries should follow the current menu policy.
7237 </p>
7240 The menu policy can be found in the <tt>menu-policy</tt>
7241 files in the <tt>debian-policy</tt> package.
7242 It is also available from the Debian web mirrors at
7243 <tt><url name="/doc/packaging-manuals/menu-policy/"
7244 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/menu-policy/"></tt>.
7245 </p>
7248 Please also refer to the <em>Debian Menu System</em>
7249 documentation that comes with the <package>menu</package>
7250 package for information about how to register your
7251 applications.
7252 </p>
7253 </sect>
7255 <sect id="mime">
7256 <heading>Multimedia handlers</heading>
7259 MIME (Multipurpose Internet Mail Extensions, RFCs 2045-2049)
7260 is a mechanism for encoding files and data streams and
7261 providing meta-information about them, in particular their
7262 type (e.g. audio or video) and format (e.g. PNG, HTML,
7263 MP3).
7264 </p>
7267 Registration of MIME type handlers allows programs like mail
7268 user agents and web browsers to invoke these handlers to
7269 view, edit or display MIME types they don't support directly.
7270 </p>
7273 Packages which provide the ability to view/show/play,
7274 compose, edit or print MIME types should register themselves
7275 as such following the current MIME support policy.
7276 </p>
7279 The MIME support policy can be found in the <tt>mime-policy</tt>
7280 files in the <tt>debian-policy</tt> package.
7281 It is also available from the Debian web mirrors at
7282 <tt><url name="/doc/packaging-manuals/mime-policy/"
7283 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/mime-policy/"></tt>.
7284 </p>
7286 </sect>
7288 <sect>
7289 <heading>Keyboard configuration</heading>
7292 To achieve a consistent keyboard configuration so that all
7293 applications interpret a keyboard event the same way, all
7294 programs in the Debian distribution must be configured to
7295 comply with the following guidelines.
7296 </p>
7299 The following keys must have the specified interpretations:
7301 <taglist>
7302 <tag><tt>&lt;--</tt></tag>
7303 <item>delete the character to the left of the cursor</item>
7305 <tag><tt>Delete</tt></tag>
7306 <item>delete the character to the right of the cursor</item>
7308 <tag><tt>Control+H</tt></tag>
7309 <item>emacs: the help prefix</item>
7310 </taglist>
7312 The interpretation of any keyboard events should be
7313 independent of the terminal that is used, be it a virtual
7314 console, an X terminal emulator, an rlogin/telnet session,
7315 etc.
7316 </p>
7319 The following list explains how the different programs
7320 should be set up to achieve this:
7321 </p>
7324 <list>
7325 <item>
7326 <tt>&lt;--</tt> generates <tt>KB_BackSpace</tt> in X.
7327 </item>
7329 <item>
7330 <tt>Delete</tt> generates <tt>KB_Delete</tt> in X.
7331 </item>
7333 <item>
7334 X translations are set up to make
7335 <tt>KB_Backspace</tt> generate ASCII DEL, and to make
7336 <tt>KB_Delete</tt> generate <tt>ESC [ 3 ~</tt> (this
7337 is the vt220 escape code for the "delete character"
7338 key). This must be done by loading the X resources
7339 using <prgn>xrdb</prgn> on all local X displays, not
7340 using the application defaults, so that the
7341 translation resources used correspond to the
7342 <prgn>xmodmap</prgn> settings.
7343 </item>
7345 <item>
7346 The Linux console is configured to make
7347 <tt>&lt;--</tt> generate DEL, and <tt>Delete</tt>
7348 generate <tt>ESC [ 3 ~</tt>.
7349 </item>
7351 <item>
7352 X applications are configured so that <tt>&lt;</tt>
7353 deletes left, and <tt>Delete</tt> deletes right. Motif
7354 applications already work like this.
7355 </item>
7357 <item>
7358 Terminals should have <tt>stty erase ^?</tt> .
7359 </item>
7361 <item>
7362 The <tt>xterm</tt> terminfo entry should have <tt>ESC
7363 [ 3 ~</tt> for <tt>kdch1</tt>, just as for
7364 <tt>TERM=linux</tt> and <tt>TERM=vt220</tt>.
7365 </item>
7367 <item>
7368 Emacs is programmed to map <tt>KB_Backspace</tt> or
7369 the <tt>stty erase</tt> character to
7370 <tt>delete-backward-char</tt>, and <tt>KB_Delete</tt>
7371 or <tt>kdch1</tt> to <tt>delete-forward-char</tt>, and
7372 <tt>^H</tt> to <tt>help</tt> as always.
7373 </item>
7375 <item>
7376 Other applications use the <tt>stty erase</tt>
7377 character and <tt>kdch1</tt> for the two delete keys,
7378 with ASCII DEL being "delete previous character" and
7379 <tt>kdch1</tt> being "delete character under
7380 cursor".
7381 </item>
7383 </list>
7384 </p>
7387 This will solve the problem except for the following
7388 cases:
7389 </p>
7392 <list>
7393 <item>
7394 Some terminals have a <tt>&lt;--</tt> key that cannot
7395 be made to produce anything except <tt>^H</tt>. On
7396 these terminals Emacs help will be unavailable on
7397 <tt>^H</tt> (assuming that the <tt>stty erase</tt>
7398 character takes precedence in Emacs, and has been set
7399 correctly). <tt>M-x help</tt> or <tt>F1</tt> (if
7400 available) can be used instead.
7401 </item>
7403 <item>
7404 Some operating systems use <tt>^H</tt> for <tt>stty
7405 erase</tt>. However, modern telnet versions and all
7406 rlogin versions propagate <tt>stty</tt> settings, and
7407 almost all UNIX versions honour <tt>stty erase</tt>.
7408 Where the <tt>stty</tt> settings are not propagated
7409 correctly, things can be made to work by using
7410 <tt>stty</tt> manually.
7411 </item>
7413 <item>
7414 Some systems (including previous Debian versions) use
7415 <prgn>xmodmap</prgn> to arrange for both
7416 <tt>&lt;--</tt> and <tt>Delete</tt> to generate
7417 <tt>KB_Delete</tt>. We can change the behavior of
7418 their X clients using the same X resources that we use
7419 to do it for our own clients, or configure our clients
7420 using their resources when things are the other way
7421 around. On displays configured like this
7422 <tt>Delete</tt> will not work, but <tt>&lt;--</tt>
7423 will.
7424 </item>
7426 <item>
7427 Some operating systems have different <tt>kdch1</tt>
7428 settings in their <tt>terminfo</tt> database for
7429 <tt>xterm</tt> and others. On these systems the
7430 <tt>Delete</tt> key will not work correctly when you
7431 log in from a system conforming to our policy, but
7432 <tt>&lt;--</tt> will.
7433 </item>
7434 </list>
7435 </p>
7436 </sect>
7438 <sect>
7439 <heading>Environment variables</heading>
7442 A program must not depend on environment variables to get
7443 reasonable defaults. (That's because these environment
7444 variables would have to be set in a system-wide
7445 configuration file like <file>/etc/profile</file>, which is not
7446 supported by all shells.)
7447 </p>
7450 If a program usually depends on environment variables for its
7451 configuration, the program should be changed to fall back to
7452 a reasonable default configuration if these environment
7453 variables are not present. If this cannot be done easily
7454 (e.g., if the source code of a non-free program is not
7455 available), the program must be replaced by a small
7456 "wrapper" shell script which sets the environment variables
7457 if they are not already defined, and calls the original program.
7458 </p>
7461 Here is an example of a wrapper script for this purpose:
7463 <example compact="compact">
7464 #!/bin/sh
7465 BAR=${BAR:-/var/lib/fubar}
7466 export BAR
7467 exec /usr/lib/foo/foo "$@"
7468 </example>
7469 </p>
7472 Furthermore, as <file>/etc/profile</file> is a configuration
7473 file of the <prgn>base-files</prgn> package, other packages must
7474 not put any environment variables or other commands into that
7475 file.
7476 </p>
7477 </sect>
7479 <sect id="doc-base">
7480 <heading>Registering Documents using doc-base</heading>
7483 The <package>doc-base</package> package implements a
7484 flexible mechanism for handling and presenting
7485 documentation. The recommended practice is for every Debian
7486 package that provides online documentation (other than just
7487 manual pages) to register these documents with
7488 <package>doc-base</package> by installing a
7489 <package>doc-base</package> control file via the
7490 <prgn/install-docs/ script at installation time and
7491 de-register the manuals again when the package is removed.
7492 </p>
7494 Please refer to the documentation that comes with the
7495 <package>doc-base</package> package for information and
7496 details.
7497 </p>
7498 </sect>
7500 </chapt>
7503 <chapt id="files">
7504 <heading>Files</heading>
7506 <sect id="binaries">
7507 <heading>Binaries</heading>
7510 Two different packages must not install programs with
7511 different functionality but with the same filenames. (The
7512 case of two programs having the same functionality but
7513 different implementations is handled via "alternatives" or
7514 the "Conflicts" mechanism. See <ref id="maintscripts"> and
7515 <ref id="conflicts"> respectively.) If this case happens,
7516 one of the programs must be renamed. The maintainers should
7517 report this to the <tt>debian-devel</tt> mailing list and
7518 try to find a consensus about which program will have to be
7519 renamed. If a consensus cannot be reached, <em>both</em>
7520 programs must be renamed.
7521 </p>
7524 By default, when a package is being built, any binaries
7525 created should include debugging information, as well as
7526 being compiled with optimization. You should also turn on
7527 as many reasonable compilation warnings as possible; this
7528 makes life easier for porters, who can then look at build
7529 logs for possible problems. For the C programming language,
7530 this means the following compilation parameters should be
7531 used:
7532 <example compact="compact">
7533 CC = gcc
7534 CFLAGS = -O2 -g -Wall # sane warning options vary between programs
7535 LDFLAGS = # none
7536 INSTALL = install -s # (or use strip on the files in debian/tmp)
7537 </example>
7538 </p>
7541 Note that by default all installed binaries should be stripped,
7542 either by using the <tt>-s</tt> flag to
7543 <prgn>install</prgn>, or by calling <prgn>strip</prgn> on
7544 the binaries after they have been copied into
7545 <file>debian/tmp</file> but before the tree is made into a
7546 package.
7547 </p>
7550 Although binaries in the build tree should be compiled with
7551 debugging information by default, it can often be difficult to
7552 debug programs if they are also subjected to compiler
7553 optimization. For this reason, it is recommended to support the
7554 standardized environment variable <tt>DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS</tt>
7555 (see <ref id="debianrules-options">). This variable can contain
7556 several flags to change how a package is compiled and built.
7557 </p>
7560 It is up to the package maintainer to decide what
7561 compilation options are best for the package. Certain
7562 binaries (such as computationally-intensive programs) will
7563 function better with certain flags (<tt>-O3</tt>, for
7564 example); feel free to use them. Please use good judgment
7565 here. Don't use flags for the sake of it; only use them
7566 if there is good reason to do so. Feel free to override
7567 the upstream author's ideas about which compilation
7568 options are best: they are often inappropriate for our
7569 environment.
7570 </p>
7571 </sect>
7574 <sect id="libraries">
7575 <heading>Libraries</heading>
7578 If the package is <strong>architecture: any</strong>, then
7579 the shared library compilation and linking flags must have
7580 <tt>-fPIC</tt>, or the package shall not build on some of
7581 the supported architectures<footnote>
7583 If you are using GCC, <tt>-fPIC</tt> produces code with
7584 relocatable position independent code, which is required for
7585 most architectures to create a shared library, with i386 and
7586 perhaps some others where non position independent code is
7587 permitted in a shared library.
7588 </p>
7590 Position independent code may have a performance penalty,
7591 especially on <tt>i386</tt>. However, in most cases the
7592 speed penalty must be measured against the memory wasted on
7593 the few architectures where non position independent code is
7594 even possible.
7595 </p>
7596 </footnote>. Any exception to this rule must be discussed on
7597 the mailing list <em>debian-devel@lists.debian.org</em>, and
7598 a rough consensus obtained. The reasons for not compiling
7599 with <tt>-fPIC</tt> flag must be recorded in the file
7600 <tt>README.Debian</tt>, and care must be taken to either
7601 restrict the architecture or arrange for <tt>-fPIC</tt> to
7602 be used on architectures where it is required.<footnote>
7604 Some of the reasons why this might be required is if the
7605 library contains hand crafted assembly code that is not
7606 relocatable, the speed penalty is excessive for compute
7607 intensive libs, and similar reasons.
7608 </p>
7609 </footnote>
7610 </p>
7612 As to the static libraries, the common case is not to have
7613 relocatable code, since there is no benefit, unless in specific
7614 cases; therefore the static version must not be compiled
7615 with the <tt>-fPIC</tt> flag. Any exception to this rule
7616 should be discussed on the mailing list
7617 <em>debian-devel@lists.debian.org</em>, and the reasons for
7618 compiling with the <tt>-fPIC</tt> flag must be recorded in
7619 the file <tt>README.Debian</tt>. <footnote>
7621 Some of the reasons for linking static libraries with
7622 the <tt>-fPIC</tt> flag are if, for example, one needs a
7623 Perl API for a library that is under rapid development,
7624 and has an unstable API, so shared libraries are
7625 pointless at this phase of the library's development. In
7626 that case, since Perl needs a library with relocatable
7627 code, it may make sense to create a static library with
7628 relocatable code. Another reason cited is if you are
7629 distilling various libraries into a common shared
7630 library, like <tt>mklibs</tt> does in the Debian
7631 installer project.
7632 </p>
7633 </footnote>
7634 </p>
7636 In other words, if both a shared and a static library is
7637 being built, each source unit (<tt>*.c</tt>, for example,
7638 for C files) will need to be compiled twice, for the normal
7639 case.
7640 </p>
7643 Libraries should be built with threading support and to be
7644 thread-safe if the library supports this.
7645 </p>
7648 Although not enforced by the build tools, shared libraries
7649 must be linked against all libraries that they use symbols from
7650 in the same way that binaries are. This ensures the correct
7651 functioning of the <qref id="sharedlibs-shlibdeps">shlibs</qref>
7652 system and guarantees that all libraries can be safely opened
7653 with <tt>dlopen()</tt>. Packagers may wish to use the gcc
7654 option <tt>-Wl,-z,defs</tt> when building a shared library.
7655 Since this option enforces symbol resolution at build time,
7656 a missing library reference will be caught early as a fatal
7657 build error.
7658 </p>
7661 All installed shared libraries should be stripped with
7662 <example compact="compact">
7663 strip --strip-unneeded <var>your-lib</var>
7664 </example>
7665 (The option <tt>--strip-unneeded</tt> makes
7666 <prgn>strip</prgn> remove only the symbols which aren't
7667 needed for relocation processing.) Shared libraries can
7668 function perfectly well when stripped, since the symbols for
7669 dynamic linking are in a separate part of the ELF object
7670 file.<footnote>
7671 You might also want to use the options
7672 <tt>--remove-section=.comment</tt> and
7673 <tt>--remove-section=.note</tt> on both shared libraries
7674 and executables, and <tt>--strip-debug</tt> on static
7675 libraries.
7676 </footnote>
7677 </p>
7680 Note that under some circumstances it may be useful to
7681 install a shared library unstripped, for example when
7682 building a separate package to support debugging.
7683 </p>
7686 Shared object files (often <file>.so</file> files) that are not
7687 public libraries, that is, they are not meant to be linked
7688 to by third party executables (binaries of other packages),
7689 should be installed in subdirectories of the
7690 <file>/usr/lib</file> directory. Such files are exempt from the
7691 rules that govern ordinary shared libraries, except that
7692 they must not be installed executable and should be
7693 stripped.<footnote>
7694 A common example are the so-called "plug-ins",
7695 internal shared objects that are dynamically loaded by
7696 programs using <manref name="dlopen" section="3">.
7697 </footnote>
7698 </p>
7701 Packages that use <prgn>libtool</prgn> to create and install
7702 their shared libraries install a file containing additional
7703 metadata (ending in <file>.la</file>) alongside the library.
7704 For public libraries intended for use by other packages, these
7705 files normally should not be included in the Debian package,
7706 since the information they include is not necessary to link with
7707 the shared library on Debian and can add unnecessary additional
7708 dependencies to other programs or libraries.<footnote>
7709 These files store, among other things, all libraries on which
7710 that shared library depends. Unfortunately, if
7711 the <file>.la</file> file is present and contains that
7712 dependency information, using <prgn>libtool</prgn> when
7713 linking against that library will cause the resulting program
7714 or library to be linked against those dependencies as well,
7715 even if this is unnecessary. This can create unneeded
7716 dependencies on shared library packages that would otherwise
7717 be hidden behind the library ABI, and can make library
7718 transitions to new SONAMEs unnecessarily complicated and
7719 difficult to manage.
7720 </footnote>
7721 If the <file>.la</file> file is required for that library (if,
7722 for instance, it's loaded via <tt>libltdl</tt> in a way that
7723 requires that meta-information), the <tt>dependency_libs</tt>
7724 setting in the <file>.la</file> file should normally be set to
7725 the empty string. If the shared library development package has
7726 historically included the <file>.la</file>, it must be retained
7727 in the development package (with <tt>dependency_libs</tt>
7728 emptied) until all libraries that depend on it have removed or
7729 emptied <tt>dependency_libs</tt> in their <file>.la</file>
7730 files to prevent linking with those other libraries
7731 using <prgn>libtool</prgn> from failing.
7732 </p>
7735 If the <file>.la</file> must be included, it should be included
7736 in the development (<tt>-dev</tt>) package, unless the library
7737 will be loaded by <prgn>libtool</prgn>'s <tt>libltdl</tt>
7738 library. If it is intended for use with <tt>libltdl</tt>,
7739 the <file>.la</file> files must go in the run-time library
7740 package.
7741 </p>
7744 These requirements for handling of <file>.la</file> files do not
7745 apply to loadable modules or libraries not installed in
7746 directories searched by default by the dynamic linker. Packages
7747 installing loadable modules will frequently need to install
7748 the <file>.la</file> files alongside the modules so that they
7749 can be loaded by <tt>libltdl</tt>. <tt>dependency_libs</tt>
7750 does not need to be modified for libraries or modules that are
7751 not installed in directories searched by the dynamic linker by
7752 default and not intended for use by other packages.
7753 </p>
7756 You must make sure that you use only released versions of
7757 shared libraries to build your packages; otherwise other
7758 users will not be able to run your binaries
7759 properly. Producing source packages that depend on
7760 unreleased compilers is also usually a bad
7761 idea.
7762 </p>
7763 </sect>
7766 <sect>
7767 <heading>Shared libraries</heading>
7769 This section has moved to <ref id="sharedlibs">.
7770 </p>
7771 </sect>
7774 <sect id="scripts">
7775 <heading>Scripts</heading>
7778 All command scripts, including the package maintainer
7779 scripts inside the package and used by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>,
7780 should have a <tt>#!</tt> line naming the shell to be used
7781 to interpret them.
7782 </p>
7785 In the case of Perl scripts this should be
7786 <tt>#!/usr/bin/perl</tt>.
7787 </p>
7790 When scripts are installed into a directory in the system
7791 PATH, the script name should not include an extension such
7792 as <tt>.sh</tt> or <tt>.pl</tt> that denotes the scripting
7793 language currently used to implement it.
7794 </p>
7796 Shell scripts (<prgn>sh</prgn> and <prgn>bash</prgn>) other than
7797 <file>init.d</file> scripts should almost certainly start
7798 with <tt>set -e</tt> so that errors are detected.
7799 <file>init.d</file> scripts are something of a special case, due
7800 to how frequently they need to call commands that are allowed to
7801 fail, and it may instead be easier to check the exit status of
7802 commands directly. See <ref id="writing-init"> for more
7803 information about writing <file>init.d</file> scripts.
7804 </p>
7806 Every script should use <tt>set -e</tt> or check the exit status
7807 of <em>every</em> command.
7808 </p>
7810 Scripts may assume that <file>/bin/sh</file> implements the
7811 SUSv3 Shell Command Language<footnote>
7812 Single UNIX Specification, version 3, which is also IEEE
7813 1003.1-2004 (POSIX), and is available on the World Wide Web
7814 from <url id="http://www.unix.org/version3/online.html"
7815 name="The Open Group"> after free
7816 registration.</footnote>
7817 plus the following additional features not mandated by
7818 SUSv3:<footnote>
7819 These features are in widespread use in the Linux community
7820 and are implemented in all of bash, dash, and ksh, the most
7821 common shells users may wish to use as <file>/bin/sh</file>.
7822 </footnote>
7823 <list>
7824 <item><tt>echo -n</tt>, if implemented as a shell built-in,
7825 must not generate a newline.</item>
7826 <item><tt>test</tt>, if implemented as a shell built-in, must
7827 support <tt>-a</tt> and <tt>-o</tt> as binary logical
7828 operators.</item>
7829 <item><tt>local</tt> to create a scoped variable must be
7830 supported, including listing multiple variables in a single
7831 local command and assigning a value to a variable at the
7832 same time as localizing it. <tt>local</tt> may or
7833 may not preserve the variable value from an outer scope if
7834 no assignment is present. Uses such as:
7835 <example compact>
7836 fname () {
7837 local a b c=delta d
7838 # ... use a, b, c, d ...
7840 </example>
7841 must be supported and must set the value of <tt>c</tt> to
7842 <tt>delta</tt>.
7843 </item>
7844 <item>The XSI extension to <prgn>kill</prgn> allowing <tt>kill
7845 -<var>signal</var></tt>, where <var>signal</var> is either
7846 the name of a signal or one of the numeric signals listed in
7847 the XSI extension (0, 1, 2, 3, 6, 9, 14, and 15), must be
7848 supported if <prgn>kill</prgn> is implemented as a shell
7849 built-in.
7850 </item>
7851 <item>The XSI extension to <prgn>trap</prgn> allowing numeric
7852 signals must be supported. In addition to the signal
7853 numbers listed in the extension, which are the same as for
7854 <prgn>kill</prgn> above, 13 (SIGPIPE) must be allowed.
7855 </item>
7856 </list>
7857 If a shell script requires non-SUSv3 features from the shell
7858 interpreter other than those listed above, the appropriate shell
7859 must be specified in the first line of the script (e.g.,
7860 <tt>#!/bin/bash</tt>) and the package must depend on the package
7861 providing the shell (unless the shell package is marked
7862 "Essential", as in the case of <prgn>bash</prgn>).
7863 </p>
7866 You may wish to restrict your script to SUSv3 features plus the
7867 above set when possible so that it may use <file>/bin/sh</file>
7868 as its interpreter. If your script works with <prgn>dash</prgn>
7869 (originally called <prgn>ash</prgn>), it probably complies with
7870 the above requirements, but if you are in doubt, use
7871 <file>/bin/bash</file>.
7872 </p>
7875 Perl scripts should check for errors when making any
7876 system calls, including <tt>open</tt>, <tt>print</tt>,
7877 <tt>close</tt>, <tt>rename</tt> and <tt>system</tt>.
7878 </p>
7881 <prgn>csh</prgn> and <prgn>tcsh</prgn> should be avoided as
7882 scripting languages. See <em>Csh Programming Considered
7883 Harmful</em>, one of the <tt>comp.unix.*</tt> FAQs, which
7884 can be found at <url id="http://www.faqs.org/faqs/unix-faq/shell/csh-whynot/">.
7885 If an upstream package comes with <prgn>csh</prgn> scripts
7886 then you must make sure that they start with
7887 <tt>#!/bin/csh</tt> and make your package depend on the
7888 <prgn>c-shell</prgn> virtual package.
7889 </p>
7892 Any scripts which create files in world-writeable
7893 directories (e.g., in <file>/tmp</file>) must use a
7894 mechanism which will fail atomically if a file with the same
7895 name already exists.
7896 </p>
7899 The Debian base system provides the <prgn>tempfile</prgn>
7900 and <prgn>mktemp</prgn> utilities for use by scripts for
7901 this purpose.
7902 </p>
7903 </sect>
7906 <sect>
7907 <heading>Symbolic links</heading>
7910 In general, symbolic links within a top-level directory
7911 should be relative, and symbolic links pointing from one
7912 top-level directory into another should be absolute. (A
7913 top-level directory is a sub-directory of the root
7914 directory <file>/</file>.)
7915 </p>
7918 In addition, symbolic links should be specified as short as
7919 possible, i.e., link targets like <file>foo/../bar</file> are
7920 deprecated.
7921 </p>
7924 Note that when creating a relative link using
7925 <prgn>ln</prgn> it is not necessary for the target of the
7926 link to exist relative to the working directory you're
7927 running <prgn>ln</prgn> from, nor is it necessary to change
7928 directory to the directory where the link is to be made.
7929 Simply include the string that should appear as the target
7930 of the link (this will be a pathname relative to the
7931 directory in which the link resides) as the first argument
7932 to <prgn>ln</prgn>.
7933 </p>
7936 For example, in your <prgn>Makefile</prgn> or
7937 <file>debian/rules</file>, you can do things like:
7938 <example compact="compact">
7939 ln -fs gcc $(prefix)/bin/cc
7940 ln -fs gcc debian/tmp/usr/bin/cc
7941 ln -fs ../sbin/sendmail $(prefix)/bin/runq
7942 ln -fs ../sbin/sendmail debian/tmp/usr/bin/runq
7943 </example>
7944 </p>
7947 A symbolic link pointing to a compressed file should always
7948 have the same file extension as the referenced file. (For
7949 example, if a file <file>foo.gz</file> is referenced by a
7950 symbolic link, the filename of the link has to end with
7951 "<file>.gz</file>" too, as in <file>bar.gz</file>.)
7952 </p>
7953 </sect>
7955 <sect>
7956 <heading>Device files</heading>
7959 Packages must not include device files or named pipes in the
7960 package file tree.
7961 </p>
7964 If a package needs any special device files that are not
7965 included in the base system, it must call
7966 <prgn>MAKEDEV</prgn> in the <prgn>postinst</prgn> script,
7967 after notifying the user<footnote>
7968 This notification could be done via a (low-priority)
7969 debconf message, or an echo (printf) statement.
7970 </footnote>.
7971 </p>
7974 Packages must not remove any device files in the
7975 <prgn>postrm</prgn> or any other script. This is left to the
7976 system administrator.
7977 </p>
7980 Debian uses the serial devices
7981 <file>/dev/ttyS*</file>. Programs using the old
7982 <file>/dev/cu*</file> devices should be changed to use
7983 <file>/dev/ttyS*</file>.
7984 </p>
7987 Named pipes needed by the package must be created in
7988 the <prgn>postinst</prgn> script<footnote>
7989 It's better to use <prgn>mkfifo</prgn> rather
7990 than <prgn>mknod</prgn> to create named pipes so that
7991 automated checks for packages incorrectly creating device
7992 files with <prgn>mknod</prgn> won't have false positives.
7993 </footnote> and removed in
7994 the <prgn>prerm</prgn> or <prgn>postrm</prgn> script as
7995 appropriate.
7996 </p>
7997 </sect>
7999 <sect id="config-files">
8000 <heading>Configuration files</heading>
8002 <sect1>
8003 <heading>Definitions</heading>
8006 <taglist>
8007 <tag>configuration file</tag>
8008 <item>
8009 A file that affects the operation of a program, or
8010 provides site- or host-specific information, or
8011 otherwise customizes the behavior of a program.
8012 Typically, configuration files are intended to be
8013 modified by the system administrator (if needed or
8014 desired) to conform to local policy or to provide
8015 more useful site-specific behavior.
8016 </item>
8018 <tag><tt>conffile</tt></tag>
8019 <item>
8020 A file listed in a package's <tt>conffiles</tt>
8021 file, and is treated specially by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
8022 (see <ref id="configdetails">).
8023 </item>
8024 </taglist>
8025 </p>
8028 The distinction between these two is important; they are
8029 not interchangeable concepts. Almost all
8030 <tt>conffile</tt>s are configuration files, but many
8031 configuration files are not <tt>conffiles</tt>.
8032 </p>
8035 As noted elsewhere, <file>/etc/init.d</file> scripts,
8036 <file>/etc/default</file> files, scripts installed in
8037 <file>/etc/cron.{hourly,daily,weekly,monthly}</file>, and cron
8038 configuration installed in <file>/etc/cron.d</file> must be
8039 treated as configuration files. In general, any script that
8040 embeds configuration information is de-facto a configuration
8041 file and should be treated as such.
8042 </p>
8043 </sect1>
8045 <sect1>
8046 <heading>Location</heading>
8049 Any configuration files created or used by your package
8050 must reside in <file>/etc</file>. If there are several,
8051 consider creating a subdirectory of <file>/etc</file>
8052 named after your package.
8053 </p>
8056 If your package creates or uses configuration files
8057 outside of <file>/etc</file>, and it is not feasible to modify
8058 the package to use <file>/etc</file> directly, put the files
8059 in <file>/etc</file> and create symbolic links to those files
8060 from the location that the package requires.
8061 </p>
8062 </sect1>
8064 <sect1>
8065 <heading>Behavior</heading>
8068 Configuration file handling must conform to the following
8069 behavior:
8070 <list compact="compact">
8071 <item>
8072 local changes must be preserved during a package
8073 upgrade, and
8074 </item>
8075 <item>
8076 configuration files must be preserved when the
8077 package is removed, and only deleted when the
8078 package is purged.
8079 </item>
8080 </list>
8081 Obsolete configuration files without local changes may be
8082 removed by the package during upgrade.
8083 </p>
8086 The easy way to achieve this behavior is to make the
8087 configuration file a <tt>conffile</tt>. This is
8088 appropriate only if it is possible to distribute a default
8089 version that will work for most installations, although
8090 some system administrators may choose to modify it. This
8091 implies that the default version will be part of the
8092 package distribution, and must not be modified by the
8093 maintainer scripts during installation (or at any other
8094 time).
8095 </p>
8098 In order to ensure that local changes are preserved
8099 correctly, no package may contain or make hard links to
8100 conffiles.<footnote>
8101 Rationale: There are two problems with hard links.
8102 The first is that some editors break the link while
8103 editing one of the files, so that the two files may
8104 unwittingly become unlinked and different. The second
8105 is that <prgn>dpkg</prgn> might break the hard link
8106 while upgrading <tt>conffile</tt>s.
8107 </footnote>
8108 </p>
8111 The other way to do it is via the maintainer scripts. In
8112 this case, the configuration file must not be listed as a
8113 <tt>conffile</tt> and must not be part of the package
8114 distribution. If the existence of a file is required for
8115 the package to be sensibly configured it is the
8116 responsibility of the package maintainer to provide
8117 maintainer scripts which correctly create, update and
8118 maintain the file and remove it on purge. (See <ref
8119 id="maintainerscripts"> for more information.) These
8120 scripts must be idempotent (i.e., must work correctly if
8121 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> needs to re-run them due to errors
8122 during installation or removal), must cope with all the
8123 variety of ways <prgn>dpkg</prgn> can call maintainer
8124 scripts, must not overwrite or otherwise mangle the user's
8125 configuration without asking, must not ask unnecessary
8126 questions (particularly during upgrades), and must
8127 otherwise be good citizens.
8128 </p>
8131 The scripts are not required to configure every possible
8132 option for the package, but only those necessary to get
8133 the package running on a given system. Ideally the
8134 sysadmin should not have to do any configuration other
8135 than that done (semi-)automatically by the
8136 <prgn>postinst</prgn> script.
8137 </p>
8140 A common practice is to create a script called
8141 <file><var>package</var>-configure</file> and have the
8142 package's <prgn>postinst</prgn> call it if and only if the
8143 configuration file does not already exist. In certain
8144 cases it is useful for there to be an example or template
8145 file which the maintainer scripts use. Such files should
8146 be in <file>/usr/share/<var>package</var></file> or
8147 <file>/usr/lib/<var>package</var></file> (depending on whether
8148 they are architecture-independent or not). There should
8149 be symbolic links to them from
8150 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/examples</file> if
8151 they are examples, and should be perfectly ordinary
8152 <prgn>dpkg</prgn>-handled files (<em>not</em>
8153 configuration files).
8154 </p>
8157 These two styles of configuration file handling must
8158 not be mixed, for that way lies madness:
8159 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will ask about overwriting the file
8160 every time the package is upgraded.
8161 </p>
8162 </sect1>
8164 <sect1>
8165 <heading>Sharing configuration files</heading>
8168 If two or more packages use the same configuration file
8169 and it is reasonable for both to be installed at the same
8170 time, one of these packages must be defined as
8171 <em>owner</em> of the configuration file, i.e., it will be
8172 the package which handles that file as a configuration
8173 file. Other packages that use the configuration file must
8174 depend on the owning package if they require the
8175 configuration file to operate. If the other package will
8176 use the configuration file if present, but is capable of
8177 operating without it, no dependency need be declared.
8178 </p>
8181 If it is desirable for two or more related packages to
8182 share a configuration file <em>and</em> for all of the
8183 related packages to be able to modify that configuration
8184 file, then the following should be done:
8185 <enumlist compact="compact">
8186 <item>
8187 One of the related packages (the "owning" package)
8188 will manage the configuration file with maintainer
8189 scripts as described in the previous section.
8190 </item>
8191 <item>
8192 The owning package should also provide a program
8193 that the other packages may use to modify the
8194 configuration file.
8195 </item>
8196 <item>
8197 The related packages must use the provided program
8198 to make any desired modifications to the
8199 configuration file. They should either depend on
8200 the core package to guarantee that the configuration
8201 modifier program is available or accept gracefully
8202 that they cannot modify the configuration file if it
8203 is not. (This is in addition to the fact that the
8204 configuration file may not even be present in the
8205 latter scenario.)
8206 </item>
8207 </enumlist>
8208 </p>
8211 Sometimes it's appropriate to create a new package which
8212 provides the basic infrastructure for the other packages
8213 and which manages the shared configuration files. (The
8214 <tt>sgml-base</tt> package is a good example.)
8215 </p>
8218 If the configuration file cannot be shared as described above,
8219 the packages must be marked as conflicting with each other.
8220 Two packages that specify the same file as
8221 a <tt>conffile</tt> must conflict. This is an instance of the
8222 general rule about not sharing files. Neither alternatives
8223 nor diversions are likely to be appropriate in this case; in
8224 particular, <prgn>dpkg</prgn> does not handle diverted
8225 <tt>conffile</tt>s well.
8226 </p>
8229 When two packages both declare the same <tt>conffile</tt>, they
8230 may see left-over configuration files from each other even
8231 though they conflict with each other. If a user removes
8232 (without purging) one of the packages and installs the other,
8233 the new package will take over the <tt>conffile</tt> from the
8234 old package. If the file was modified by the user, it will be
8235 treated the same as any other locally
8236 modified <tt>conffile</tt> during an upgrade.
8237 </p>
8240 The maintainer scripts must not alter a <tt>conffile</tt>
8241 of <em>any</em> package, including the one the scripts
8242 belong to.
8243 </p>
8244 </sect1>
8246 <sect1>
8247 <heading>User configuration files ("dotfiles")</heading>
8250 The files in <file>/etc/skel</file> will automatically be
8251 copied into new user accounts by <prgn>adduser</prgn>.
8252 No other program should reference the files in
8253 <file>/etc/skel</file>.
8254 </p>
8257 Therefore, if a program needs a dotfile to exist in
8258 advance in <file>$HOME</file> to work sensibly, that dotfile
8259 should be installed in <file>/etc/skel</file> and treated as a
8260 configuration file.
8261 </p>
8264 However, programs that require dotfiles in order to
8265 operate sensibly are a bad thing, unless they do create
8266 the dotfiles themselves automatically.
8267 </p>
8270 Furthermore, programs should be configured by the Debian
8271 default installation to behave as closely to the upstream
8272 default behavior as possible.
8273 </p>
8276 Therefore, if a program in a Debian package needs to be
8277 configured in some way in order to operate sensibly, that
8278 should be done using a site-wide configuration file placed
8279 in <file>/etc</file>. Only if the program doesn't support a
8280 site-wide default configuration and the package maintainer
8281 doesn't have time to add it may a default per-user file be
8282 placed in <file>/etc/skel</file>.
8283 </p>
8286 <file>/etc/skel</file> should be as empty as we can make it.
8287 This is particularly true because there is no easy (or
8288 necessarily desirable) mechanism for ensuring that the
8289 appropriate dotfiles are copied into the accounts of
8290 existing users when a package is installed.
8291 </p>
8292 </sect1>
8293 </sect>
8295 <sect>
8296 <heading>Log files</heading>
8298 Log files should usually be named
8299 <file>/var/log/<var>package</var>.log</file>. If you have many
8300 log files, or need a separate directory for permission
8301 reasons (<file>/var/log</file> is writable only by
8302 <file>root</file>), you should usually create a directory named
8303 <file>/var/log/<var>package</var></file> and place your log
8304 files there.
8305 </p>
8308 Log files must be rotated occasionally so that they don't grow
8309 indefinitely. The best way to do this is to install a log
8310 rotation configuration file in the
8311 directory <file>/etc/logrotate.d</file>, normally
8312 named <file>/etc/logrotate.d/<var>package</var></file>, and use
8313 the facilities provided by <prgn>logrotate</prgn>.
8314 <footnote>
8316 The traditional approach to log files has been to set up
8317 <em>ad hoc</em> log rotation schemes using simple shell
8318 scripts and cron. While this approach is highly
8319 customizable, it requires quite a lot of sysadmin work.
8320 Even though the original Debian system helped a little
8321 by automatically installing a system which can be used
8322 as a template, this was deemed not enough.
8323 </p>
8326 The use of <prgn>logrotate</prgn>, a program developed
8327 by Red Hat, is better, as it centralizes log management.
8328 It has both a configuration file
8329 (<file>/etc/logrotate.conf</file>) and a directory where
8330 packages can drop their individual log rotation
8331 configurations (<file>/etc/logrotate.d</file>).
8332 </p>
8333 </footnote>
8334 Here is a good example for a logrotate config
8335 file (for more information see <manref name="logrotate"
8336 section="8">):
8337 <example compact="compact">
8338 /var/log/foo/*.log {
8339 rotate 12
8340 weekly
8341 compress
8342 missingok
8343 postrotate
8344 start-stop-daemon -K -p /var/run/foo.pid -s HUP -x /usr/sbin/foo -q
8345 endscript
8347 </example>
8348 This rotates all files under <file>/var/log/foo</file>, saves 12
8349 compressed generations, and tells the daemon to reopen its log
8350 files after the log rotation. It skips this log rotation
8351 (via <tt>missingok</tt>) if no such log file is present, which
8352 avoids errors if the package is removed but not purged.
8353 </p>
8356 Log files should be removed when the package is
8357 purged (but not when it is only removed). This should be
8358 done by the <prgn>postrm</prgn> script when it is called
8359 with the argument <tt>purge</tt> (see <ref
8360 id="removedetails">).
8361 </p>
8362 </sect>
8364 <sect id="permissions-owners">
8365 <heading>Permissions and owners</heading>
8368 The rules in this section are guidelines for general use.
8369 If necessary you may deviate from the details below.
8370 However, if you do so you must make sure that what is done
8371 is secure and you should try to be as consistent as possible
8372 with the rest of the system. You should probably also
8373 discuss it on <prgn>debian-devel</prgn> first.
8374 </p>
8377 Files should be owned by <tt>root:root</tt>, and made
8378 writable only by the owner and universally readable (and
8379 executable, if appropriate), that is mode 644 or 755.
8380 </p>
8383 Directories should be mode 755 or (for group-writability)
8384 mode 2775. The ownership of the directory should be
8385 consistent with its mode: if a directory is mode 2775, it
8386 should be owned by the group that needs write access to
8387 it.<footnote>
8389 When a package is upgraded, and the owner or permissions
8390 of a file included in the package has changed, dpkg
8391 arranges for the ownership and permissions to be
8392 correctly set upon installation. However, this does not
8393 extend to directories; the permissions and ownership of
8394 directories already on the system does not change on
8395 install or upgrade of packages. This makes sense, since
8396 otherwise common directories like <tt>/usr</tt> would
8397 always be in flux. To correctly change permissions of a
8398 directory the package owns, explicit action is required,
8399 usually in the <tt>postinst</tt> script. Care must be
8400 taken to handle downgrades as well, in that case.
8401 </p>
8402 </footnote>
8403 </p>
8406 Control information files should be owned by <tt>root:root</tt>
8407 and either mode 644 (for most files) or mode 755 (for
8408 executables such as <qref id="maintscripts">maintainer
8409 scripts</qref>).
8410 </p>
8413 Setuid and setgid executables should be mode 4755 or 2755
8414 respectively, and owned by the appropriate user or group.
8415 They should not be made unreadable (modes like 4711 or
8416 2711 or even 4111); doing so achieves no extra security,
8417 because anyone can find the binary in the freely available
8418 Debian package; it is merely inconvenient. For the same
8419 reason you should not restrict read or execute permissions
8420 on non-set-id executables.
8421 </p>
8424 Some setuid programs need to be restricted to particular
8425 sets of users, using file permissions. In this case they
8426 should be owned by the uid to which they are set-id, and by
8427 the group which should be allowed to execute them. They
8428 should have mode 4754; again there is no point in making
8429 them unreadable to those users who must not be allowed to
8430 execute them.
8431 </p>
8434 It is possible to arrange that the system administrator can
8435 reconfigure the package to correspond to their local
8436 security policy by changing the permissions on a binary:
8437 they can do this by using <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn>, as
8438 described below.<footnote>
8439 Ordinary files installed by <prgn>dpkg</prgn> (as
8440 opposed to <tt>conffile</tt>s and other similar objects)
8441 normally have their permissions reset to the distributed
8442 permissions when the package is reinstalled. However,
8443 the use of <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn> overrides this
8444 default behavior.
8445 </footnote>
8446 Another method you should consider is to create a group for
8447 people allowed to use the program(s) and make any setuid
8448 executables executable only by that group.
8449 </p>
8452 If you need to create a new user or group for your package
8453 there are two possibilities. Firstly, you may need to
8454 make some files in the binary package be owned by this
8455 user or group, or you may need to compile the user or
8456 group id (rather than just the name) into the binary
8457 (though this latter should be avoided if possible, as in
8458 this case you need a statically allocated id).</p>
8461 If you need a statically allocated id, you must ask for a
8462 user or group id from the <tt>base-passwd</tt> maintainer,
8463 and must not release the package until you have been
8464 allocated one. Once you have been allocated one you must
8465 either make the package depend on a version of the
8466 <tt>base-passwd</tt> package with the id present in
8467 <file>/etc/passwd</file> or <file>/etc/group</file>, or arrange for
8468 your package to create the user or group itself with the
8469 correct id (using <tt>adduser</tt>) in its
8470 <prgn>preinst</prgn> or <prgn>postinst</prgn>. (Doing it in
8471 the <prgn>postinst</prgn> is to be preferred if it is
8472 possible, otherwise a pre-dependency will be needed on the
8473 <tt>adduser</tt> package.)
8474 </p>
8477 On the other hand, the program might be able to determine
8478 the uid or gid from the user or group name at runtime, so
8479 that a dynamically allocated id can be used. In this case
8480 you should choose an appropriate user or group name,
8481 discussing this on <prgn>debian-devel</prgn> and checking
8482 with the <package/base-passwd/ maintainer that it is unique and that
8483 they do not wish you to use a statically allocated id
8484 instead. When this has been checked you must arrange for
8485 your package to create the user or group if necessary using
8486 <prgn>adduser</prgn> in the <prgn>preinst</prgn> or
8487 <prgn>postinst</prgn> script (again, the latter is to be
8488 preferred if it is possible).
8489 </p>
8492 Note that changing the numeric value of an id associated
8493 with a name is very difficult, and involves searching the
8494 file system for all appropriate files. You need to think
8495 carefully whether a static or dynamic id is required, since
8496 changing your mind later will cause problems.
8497 </p>
8499 <sect1><heading>The use of <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn></heading>
8501 This section is not intended as policy, but as a
8502 description of the use of <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn>.
8503 </p>
8506 If a system administrator wishes to have a file (or
8507 directory or other such thing) installed with owner and
8508 permissions different from those in the distributed Debian
8509 package, they can use the <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn>
8510 program to instruct <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to use the different
8511 settings every time the file is installed. Thus the
8512 package maintainer should distribute the files with their
8513 normal permissions, and leave it for the system
8514 administrator to make any desired changes. For example, a
8515 daemon which is normally required to be setuid root, but
8516 in certain situations could be used without being setuid,
8517 should be installed setuid in the <tt>.deb</tt>. Then the
8518 local system administrator can change this if they wish.
8519 If there are two standard ways of doing it, the package
8520 maintainer can use <tt>debconf</tt> to find out the
8521 preference, and call <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn> in the
8522 maintainer script if necessary to accommodate the system
8523 administrator's choice. Care must be taken during
8524 upgrades to not override an existing setting.
8525 </p>
8528 Given the above, <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn> is
8529 essentially a tool for system administrators and would not
8530 normally be needed in the maintainer scripts. There is
8531 one type of situation, though, where calls to
8532 <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn> would be needed in the
8533 maintainer scripts, and that involves packages which use
8534 dynamically allocated user or group ids. In such a
8535 situation, something like the following idiom can be very
8536 helpful in the package's <prgn>postinst</prgn>, where
8537 <tt>sysuser</tt> is a dynamically allocated id:
8538 <example>
8539 for i in /usr/bin/foo /usr/sbin/bar
8541 # only do something when no setting exists
8542 if ! dpkg-statoverride --list $i >/dev/null 2>&1
8543 then
8544 #include: debconf processing, question about foo and bar
8545 if [ "$RET" = "true" ] ; then
8546 dpkg-statoverride --update --add sysuser root 4755 $i
8549 done
8550 </example>
8551 The corresponding code to remove the override when the package
8552 is purged would be:
8553 <example>
8554 for i in /usr/bin/foo /usr/sbin/bar
8556 if dpkg-statoverride --list $i >/dev/null 2>&1
8557 then
8558 dpkg-statoverride --remove $i
8560 done
8561 </example>
8562 </p>
8563 </sect1>
8564 </sect>
8565 </chapt>
8568 <chapt id="customized-programs">
8569 <heading>Customized programs</heading>
8571 <sect id="arch-spec">
8572 <heading>Architecture specification strings</heading>
8575 If a program needs to specify an <em>architecture specification
8576 string</em> in some place, it should select one of the strings
8577 provided by <tt>dpkg-architecture -L</tt>. The strings are in
8578 the format <tt><var>os</var>-<var>arch</var></tt>, though the OS
8579 part is sometimes elided, as when the OS is Linux.
8580 </p>
8583 Note that we don't want to use
8584 <tt><var>arch</var>-debian-linux</tt> to apply to the rule
8585 <tt><var>architecture</var>-<var>vendor</var>-<var>os</var></tt>
8586 since this would make our programs incompatible with other
8587 Linux distributions. We also don't use something like
8588 <tt><var>arch</var>-unknown-linux</tt>, since the
8589 <tt>unknown</tt> does not look very good.
8590 </p>
8592 <sect1 id="arch-wildcard-spec">
8593 <heading>Architecture wildcards</heading>
8596 A package may specify an architecture wildcard. Architecture
8597 wildcards are in the format <tt>any</tt> (which matches every
8598 architecture), <tt><var>os</var></tt>-any, or
8599 any-<tt><var>cpu</var></tt>. <footnote>
8600 Internally, the package system normalizes the GNU triplets
8601 and the Debian arches into Debian arch triplets (which are
8602 kind of inverted GNU triplets), with the first component of
8603 the triplet representing the libc and ABI in use, and then
8604 does matching against those triplets. However, such
8605 triplets are an internal implementation detail that should
8606 not be used by packages directly. The libc and ABI portion
8607 is handled internally by the package system based on
8608 the <var>os</var> and <var>cpu</var>.
8609 </footnote>
8610 </p>
8611 </sect1>
8612 </sect>
8614 <sect>
8615 <heading>Daemons</heading>
8618 The configuration files <file>/etc/services</file>,
8619 <file>/etc/protocols</file>, and <file>/etc/rpc</file> are managed
8620 by the <prgn>netbase</prgn> package and must not be modified
8621 by other packages.
8622 </p>
8625 If a package requires a new entry in one of these files, the
8626 maintainer should get in contact with the
8627 <prgn>netbase</prgn> maintainer, who will add the entries
8628 and release a new version of the <prgn>netbase</prgn>
8629 package.
8630 </p>
8633 The configuration file <file>/etc/inetd.conf</file> must not be
8634 modified by the package's scripts except via the
8635 <prgn>update-inetd</prgn> script or the
8636 <file>DebianNet.pm</file> Perl module. See their documentation
8637 for details on how to add entries.
8638 </p>
8641 If a package wants to install an example entry into
8642 <file>/etc/inetd.conf</file>, the entry must be preceded with
8643 exactly one hash character (<tt>#</tt>). Such lines are
8644 treated as "commented out by user" by the
8645 <prgn>update-inetd</prgn> script and are not changed or
8646 activated during package updates.
8647 </p>
8648 </sect>
8650 <sect>
8651 <heading>Using pseudo-ttys and modifying wtmp, utmp and
8652 lastlog</heading>
8655 Some programs need to create pseudo-ttys. This should be done
8656 using Unix98 ptys if the C library supports it. The resulting
8657 program must not be installed setuid root, unless that
8658 is required for other functionality.
8659 </p>
8662 The files <file>/var/run/utmp</file>, <file>/var/log/wtmp</file> and
8663 <file>/var/log/lastlog</file> must be installed writable by
8664 group <tt>utmp</tt>. Programs which need to modify those
8665 files must be installed setgid <tt>utmp</tt>.
8666 </p>
8667 </sect>
8669 <sect>
8670 <heading>Editors and pagers</heading>
8673 Some programs have the ability to launch an editor or pager
8674 program to edit or display a text document. Since there are
8675 lots of different editors and pagers available in the Debian
8676 distribution, the system administrator and each user should
8677 have the possibility to choose their preferred editor and
8678 pager.
8679 </p>
8682 In addition, every program should choose a good default
8683 editor/pager if none is selected by the user or system
8684 administrator.
8685 </p>
8688 Thus, every program that launches an editor or pager must
8689 use the EDITOR or PAGER environment variable to determine
8690 the editor or pager the user wishes to use. If these
8691 variables are not set, the programs <file>/usr/bin/editor</file>
8692 and <file>/usr/bin/pager</file> should be used, respectively.
8693 </p>
8696 These two files are managed through the <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
8697 "alternatives" mechanism. Every package providing an editor or
8698 pager must call the <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn> script to
8699 register as an alternative for <file>/usr/bin/editor</file>
8700 or <file>/usr/bin/pager</file> as appropriate. The alternative
8701 should have a slave alternative
8702 for <file>/usr/share/man/man1/editor.1.gz</file>
8703 or <file>/usr/share/man/man1/pager.1.gz</file> pointing to the
8704 corresponding manual page.
8705 </p>
8708 If it is very hard to adapt a program to make use of the
8709 EDITOR or PAGER variables, that program may be configured to
8710 use <file>/usr/bin/sensible-editor</file> and
8711 <file>/usr/bin/sensible-pager</file> as the editor or pager
8712 program respectively. These are two scripts provided in the
8713 <package>sensible-utils</package> package that check the EDITOR
8714 and PAGER variables and launch the appropriate program, and fall
8715 back to <file>/usr/bin/editor</file>
8716 and <file>/usr/bin/pager</file> if the variable is not set.
8717 </p>
8720 A program may also use the VISUAL environment variable to
8721 determine the user's choice of editor. If it exists, it
8722 should take precedence over EDITOR. This is in fact what
8723 <file>/usr/bin/sensible-editor</file> does.
8724 </p>
8727 It is not required for a package to depend on
8728 <tt>editor</tt> and <tt>pager</tt>, nor is it required for a
8729 package to provide such virtual packages.<footnote>
8730 The Debian base system already provides an editor and a
8731 pager program.
8732 </footnote>
8733 </p>
8734 </sect>
8736 <sect id="web-appl">
8737 <heading>Web servers and applications</heading>
8740 This section describes the locations and URLs that should
8741 be used by all web servers and web applications in the
8742 Debian system.
8743 </p>
8746 <enumlist>
8747 <item>
8748 Cgi-bin executable files are installed in the
8749 directory
8750 <example compact="compact">
8751 /usr/lib/cgi-bin/<var>cgi-bin-name</var>
8752 </example>
8753 or a subdirectory of that directory, and should be
8754 referred to as
8755 <example compact="compact">
8756 http://localhost/cgi-bin/<var>cgi-bin-name</var>
8757 </example>
8758 (possibly with a subdirectory name
8759 before <var>cgi-bin-name</var>).
8760 </item>
8762 <item>
8763 <p>Access to HTML documents</p>
8766 HTML documents for a package are stored in
8767 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file>
8768 and can be referred to as
8769 <example compact="compact">
8770 http://localhost/doc/<var>package</var>/<var>filename</var>
8771 </example>
8772 </p>
8775 The web server should restrict access to the document
8776 tree so that only clients on the same host can read
8777 the documents. If the web server does not support such
8778 access controls, then it should not provide access at
8779 all, or ask about providing access during installation.
8780 </p>
8781 </item>
8783 <item>
8784 <p>Access to images</p>
8786 It is recommended that images for a package be stored
8787 in <tt>/usr/share/images/<var>package</var></tt> and
8788 may be referred to through an alias <tt>/images/</tt>
8790 <example>
8791 http://localhost/images/&lt;package&gt;/&lt;filename&gt;
8792 </example>
8794 </p>
8795 </item>
8797 <item>
8798 <p>Web Document Root</p>
8801 Web Applications should try to avoid storing files in
8802 the Web Document Root. Instead they should use the
8803 /usr/share/doc/<var>package</var> directory for
8804 documents and register the Web Application via the
8805 <package>doc-base</package> package. If access to the
8806 web document root is unavoidable then use
8807 <example compact="compact">
8808 /var/www
8809 </example>
8810 as the Document Root. This might be just a symbolic
8811 link to the location where the system administrator
8812 has put the real document root.
8813 </p>
8814 </item>
8815 <item><p>Providing httpd and/or httpd-cgi</p>
8817 All web servers should provide the virtual package
8818 <tt>httpd</tt>. If a web server has CGI support it should
8819 provide <tt>httpd-cgi</tt> additionally.
8820 </p>
8822 All web applications which do not contain CGI scripts should
8823 depend on <tt>httpd</tt>, all those web applications which
8824 <tt>do</tt> contain CGI scripts, should depend on
8825 <tt>httpd-cgi</tt>.
8826 </p>
8827 </item>
8828 </enumlist>
8829 </p>
8830 </sect>
8832 <sect id="mail-transport-agents">
8833 <heading>Mail transport, delivery and user agents</heading>
8836 Debian packages which process electronic mail, whether mail
8837 user agents (MUAs) or mail transport agents (MTAs), must
8838 ensure that they are compatible with the configuration
8839 decisions below. Failure to do this may result in lost
8840 mail, broken <tt>From:</tt> lines, and other serious brain
8841 damage!
8842 </p>
8845 The mail spool is <file>/var/mail</file> and the interface to
8846 send a mail message is <file>/usr/sbin/sendmail</file> (as per
8847 the FHS). On older systems, the mail spool may be
8848 physically located in <file>/var/spool/mail</file>, but all
8849 access to the mail spool should be via the
8850 <file>/var/mail</file> symlink. The mail spool is part of the
8851 base system and not part of the MTA package.
8852 </p>
8855 All Debian MUAs, MTAs, MDAs and other mailbox accessing
8856 programs (such as IMAP daemons) must lock the mailbox in an
8857 NFS-safe way. This means that <tt>fcntl()</tt> locking must
8858 be combined with dot locking. To avoid deadlocks, a program
8859 should use <tt>fcntl()</tt> first and dot locking after
8860 this, or alternatively implement the two locking methods in
8861 a non blocking way<footnote>
8862 If it is not possible to establish both locks, the
8863 system shouldn't wait for the second lock to be
8864 established, but remove the first lock, wait a (random)
8865 time, and start over locking again.
8866 </footnote>. Using the functions <tt>maillock</tt> and
8867 <tt>mailunlock</tt> provided by the
8868 <tt>liblockfile*</tt><footnote>
8869 You will need to depend on <tt>liblockfile1 (&gt;&gt;1.01)</tt>
8870 to use these functions.
8871 </footnote> packages is the recommended way to realize this.
8872 </p>
8875 Mailboxes are generally either mode 600 and owned by
8876 <var>user</var> or mode 660 and owned by
8877 <tt><var>user</var>:mail</tt><footnote>
8878 There are two traditional permission schemes for mail spools:
8879 mode 600 with all mail delivery done by processes running as
8880 the destination user, or mode 660 and owned by group mail with
8881 mail delivery done by a process running as a system user in
8882 group mail. Historically, Debian required mode 660 mail
8883 spools to enable the latter model, but that model has become
8884 increasingly uncommon and the principle of least privilege
8885 indicates that mail systems that use the first model should
8886 use permissions of 600. If delivery to programs is permitted,
8887 it's easier to keep the mail system secure if the delivery
8888 agent runs as the destination user. Debian Policy therefore
8889 permits either scheme.
8890 </footnote>. The local system administrator may choose a
8891 different permission scheme; packages should not make
8892 assumptions about the permission and ownership of mailboxes
8893 unless required (such as when creating a new mailbox). A MUA
8894 may remove a mailbox (unless it has nonstandard permissions) in
8895 which case the MTA or another MUA must recreate it if needed.
8896 </p>
8899 The mail spool is 2775 <tt>root:mail</tt>, and MUAs should
8900 be setgid mail to do the locking mentioned above (and
8901 must obviously avoid accessing other users' mailboxes
8902 using this privilege).</p>
8905 <file>/etc/aliases</file> is the source file for the system mail
8906 aliases (e.g., postmaster, usenet, etc.), it is the one
8907 which the sysadmin and <prgn>postinst</prgn> scripts may
8908 edit. After <file>/etc/aliases</file> is edited the program or
8909 human editing it must call <prgn>newaliases</prgn>. All MTA
8910 packages must come with a <prgn>newaliases</prgn> program,
8911 even if it does nothing, but older MTA packages did not do
8912 this so programs should not fail if <prgn>newaliases</prgn>
8913 cannot be found. Note that because of this, all MTA
8914 packages must have <tt>Provides</tt>, <tt>Conflicts</tt> and
8915 <tt>Replaces: mail-transport-agent</tt> control fields.
8916 </p>
8919 The convention of writing <tt>forward to
8920 <var>address</var></tt> in the mailbox itself is not
8921 supported. Use a <tt>.forward</tt> file instead.</p>
8924 The <prgn>rmail</prgn> program used by UUCP
8925 for incoming mail should be <file>/usr/sbin/rmail</file>.
8926 Likewise, <prgn>rsmtp</prgn>, for receiving
8927 batch-SMTP-over-UUCP, should be <file>/usr/sbin/rsmtp</file> if it
8928 is supported.</p>
8931 If your package needs to know what hostname to use on (for
8932 example) outgoing news and mail messages which are generated
8933 locally, you should use the file <file>/etc/mailname</file>. It
8934 will contain the portion after the username and <tt>@</tt>
8935 (at) sign for email addresses of users on the machine
8936 (followed by a newline).
8937 </p>
8940 Such a package should check for the existence of this file
8941 when it is being configured. If it exists, it should be
8942 used without comment, although an MTA's configuration script
8943 may wish to prompt the user even if it finds that this file
8944 exists. If the file does not exist, the package should
8945 prompt the user for the value (preferably using
8946 <prgn>debconf</prgn>) and store it in <file>/etc/mailname</file>
8947 as well as using it in the package's configuration. The
8948 prompt should make it clear that the name will not just be
8949 used by that package. For example, in this situation the
8950 <tt>inn</tt> package could say something like:
8951 <example compact="compact">
8952 Please enter the "mail name" of your system. This is the
8953 hostname portion of the address to be shown on outgoing
8954 news and mail messages. The default is
8955 <var>syshostname</var>, your system's host name. Mail
8956 name ["<var>syshostname</var>"]:
8957 </example>
8958 where <var>syshostname</var> is the output of <tt>hostname
8959 --fqdn</tt>.
8960 </p>
8961 </sect>
8963 <sect>
8964 <heading>News system configuration</heading>
8967 All the configuration files related to the NNTP (news)
8968 servers and clients should be located under
8969 <file>/etc/news</file>.</p>
8972 There are some configuration issues that apply to a number
8973 of news clients and server packages on the machine. These
8974 are:
8976 <taglist>
8977 <tag><file>/etc/news/organization</file></tag>
8978 <item>
8979 A string which should appear as the
8980 organization header for all messages posted
8981 by NNTP clients on the machine
8982 </item>
8984 <tag><file>/etc/news/server</file></tag>
8985 <item>
8986 Contains the FQDN of the upstream NNTP
8987 server, or localhost if the local machine is
8988 an NNTP server.
8989 </item>
8990 </taglist>
8992 Other global files may be added as required for cross-package news
8993 configuration.
8994 </p>
8995 </sect>
8998 <sect>
8999 <heading>Programs for the X Window System</heading>
9001 <sect1>
9002 <heading>Providing X support and package priorities</heading>
9005 Programs that can be configured with support for the X
9006 Window System must be configured to do so and must declare
9007 any package dependencies necessary to satisfy their
9008 runtime requirements when using the X Window System. If
9009 such a package is of higher priority than the X packages
9010 on which it depends, it is required that either the
9011 X-specific components be split into a separate package, or
9012 that an alternative version of the package, which includes
9013 X support, be provided, or that the package's priority be
9014 lowered.
9015 </p>
9016 </sect1>
9018 <sect1>
9019 <heading>Packages providing an X server</heading>
9022 Packages that provide an X server that, directly or
9023 indirectly, communicates with real input and display
9024 hardware should declare in their <tt>Provides</tt> control
9025 field that they provide the virtual
9026 package <tt>xserver</tt>.<footnote>
9027 This implements current practice, and provides an
9028 actual policy for usage of the <tt>xserver</tt>
9029 virtual package which appears in the virtual packages
9030 list. In a nutshell, X servers that interface
9031 directly with the display and input hardware or via
9032 another subsystem (e.g., GGI) should provide
9033 <tt>xserver</tt>. Things like <tt>Xvfb</tt>,
9034 <tt>Xnest</tt>, and <tt>Xprt</tt> should not.
9035 </footnote>
9036 </p>
9037 </sect1>
9039 <sect1>
9040 <heading>Packages providing a terminal emulator</heading>
9043 Packages that provide a terminal emulator for the X Window
9044 System which meet the criteria listed below should declare in
9045 their <tt>Provides</tt> control field that they provide the
9046 virtual package <tt>x-terminal-emulator</tt>. They should
9047 also register themselves as an alternative for
9048 <file>/usr/bin/x-terminal-emulator</file>, with a priority of
9049 20. That alternative should have a slave alternative
9050 for <file>/usr/share/man/man1/x-terminal-emulator.1.gz</file>
9051 pointing to the corresponding manual page.
9052 </p>
9055 To be an <tt>x-terminal-emulator</tt>, a program must:
9056 <list compact="compact">
9057 <item>
9058 Be able to emulate a DEC VT100 terminal, or a
9059 compatible terminal.
9060 </item>
9062 <item>
9063 Support the command-line option <tt>-e
9064 <var>command</var></tt>, which creates a new
9065 terminal window<footnote>
9066 "New terminal window" does not necessarily mean
9067 a new top-level X window directly parented by
9068 the window manager; it could, if the terminal
9069 emulator application were so coded, be a new
9070 "view" in a multiple-document interface (MDI).
9071 </footnote>
9072 and runs the specified <var>command</var>,
9073 interpreting the entirety of the rest of the command
9074 line as a command to pass straight to exec, in the
9075 manner that <tt>xterm</tt> does.
9076 </item>
9078 <item>
9079 Support the command-line option <tt>-T
9080 <var>title</var></tt>, which creates a new terminal
9081 window with the window title <var>title</var>.
9082 </item>
9083 </list>
9084 </p>
9085 </sect1>
9087 <sect1>
9088 <heading>Packages providing a window manager</heading>
9091 Packages that provide a window manager should declare in
9092 their <tt>Provides</tt> control field that they provide the
9093 virtual package <tt>x-window-manager</tt>. They should also
9094 register themselves as an alternative for
9095 <file>/usr/bin/x-window-manager</file>, with a priority
9096 calculated as follows:
9097 <list compact="compact">
9098 <item>
9099 Start with a priority of 20.
9100 </item>
9102 <item>
9103 If the window manager supports the Debian menu
9104 system, add 20 points if this support is available
9105 in the package's default configuration (i.e., no
9106 configuration files belonging to the system or user
9107 have to be edited to activate the feature); if
9108 configuration files must be modified, add only 10
9109 points.
9110 </p>
9111 </item>
9113 <item>
9114 If the window manager complies with <url
9115 id="http://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec"
9116 name="The Window Manager Specification Project">,
9117 written by the <url id="http://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/"
9118 name="Free Desktop Group">, add 40 points.
9119 </item>
9121 <item>
9122 If the window manager permits the X session to be
9123 restarted using a <em>different</em> window manager
9124 (without killing the X server) in its default
9125 configuration, add 10 points; otherwise add none.
9126 </item>
9127 </list>
9128 That alternative should have a slave alternative
9129 for <file>/usr/share/man/man1/x-window-manager.1.gz</file>
9130 pointing to the corresponding manual page.
9131 </p>
9132 </sect1>
9134 <sect1>
9135 <heading>Packages providing fonts</heading>
9138 Packages that provide fonts for the X Window
9139 System<footnote>
9140 For the purposes of Debian Policy, a "font for the X
9141 Window System" is one which is accessed via X protocol
9142 requests. Fonts for the Linux console, for PostScript
9143 renderer, or any other purpose, do not fit this
9144 definition. Any tool which makes such fonts available
9145 to the X Window System, however, must abide by this
9146 font policy.
9147 </footnote>
9148 must do a number of things to ensure that they are both
9149 available without modification of the X or font server
9150 configuration, and that they do not corrupt files used by
9151 other font packages to register information about
9152 themselves.
9153 <enumlist>
9154 <item>
9155 Fonts of any type supported by the X Window System
9156 must be in a separate binary package from any
9157 executables, libraries, or documentation (except
9158 that specific to the fonts shipped, such as their
9159 license information). If one or more of the fonts
9160 so packaged are necessary for proper operation of
9161 the package with which they are associated the font
9162 package may be Recommended; if the fonts merely
9163 provide an enhancement, a Suggests relationship may
9164 be used. Packages must not Depend on font
9165 packages.<footnote>
9166 This is because the X server may retrieve fonts
9167 from the local file system or over the network
9168 from an X font server; the Debian package system
9169 is empowered to deal only with the local
9170 file system.
9171 </footnote>
9172 </item>
9174 <item>
9175 BDF fonts must be converted to PCF fonts with the
9176 <prgn>bdftopcf</prgn> utility (available in the
9177 <tt>xfonts-utils</tt> package, <prgn>gzip</prgn>ped, and
9178 placed in a directory that corresponds to their
9179 resolution:
9180 <list compact="compact">
9181 <item>
9182 100 dpi fonts must be placed in
9183 <file>/usr/share/fonts/X11/100dpi/</file>.
9184 </item>
9186 <item>
9187 75 dpi fonts must be placed in
9188 <file>/usr/share/fonts/X11/75dpi/</file>.
9189 </item>
9191 <item>
9192 Character-cell fonts, cursor fonts, and other
9193 low-resolution fonts must be placed in
9194 <file>/usr/share/fonts/X11/misc/</file>.
9195 </item>
9196 </list>
9197 </item>
9199 <item>
9200 Type 1 fonts must be placed in
9201 <file>/usr/share/fonts/X11/Type1/</file>. If font
9202 metric files are available, they must be placed here
9203 as well.
9204 </item>
9206 <item>
9207 Subdirectories of <file>/usr/share/fonts/X11/</file>
9208 other than those listed above must be neither
9209 created nor used. (The <file>PEX</file>, <file>CID</file>,
9210 <file>Speedo</file>, and <file>cyrillic</file> directories
9211 are excepted for historical reasons, but installation of
9212 files into these directories remains discouraged.)
9213 </item>
9215 <item>
9216 Font packages may, instead of placing files directly
9217 in the X font directories listed above, provide
9218 symbolic links in that font directory pointing to
9219 the files' actual location in the filesystem. Such
9220 a location must comply with the FHS.
9221 </item>
9223 <item>
9224 Font packages should not contain both 75dpi and
9225 100dpi versions of a font. If both are available,
9226 they should be provided in separate binary packages
9227 with <tt>-75dpi</tt> or <tt>-100dpi</tt> appended to
9228 the names of the packages containing the
9229 corresponding fonts.
9230 </item>
9232 <item>
9233 Fonts destined for the <file>misc</file> subdirectory
9234 should not be included in the same package as 75dpi
9235 or 100dpi fonts; instead, they should be provided in
9236 a separate package with <tt>-misc</tt> appended to
9237 its name.
9238 </item>
9240 <item>
9241 Font packages must not provide the files
9242 <file>fonts.dir</file>, <file>fonts.alias</file>, or
9243 <file>fonts.scale</file> in a font directory:
9244 <list>
9245 <item>
9246 <file>fonts.dir</file> files must not be provided at all.
9247 </item>
9249 <item>
9250 <file>fonts.alias</file> and <file>fonts.scale</file>
9251 files, if needed, should be provided in the
9252 directory
9253 <file>/etc/X11/fonts/<var>fontdir</var>/<var>package</var>.<var>extension</var></file>,
9254 where <var>fontdir</var> is the name of the
9255 subdirectory of
9256 <file>/usr/share/fonts/X11/</file> where the
9257 package's corresponding fonts are stored
9258 (e.g., <tt>75dpi</tt> or <tt>misc</tt>),
9259 <var>package</var> is the name of the package
9260 that provides these fonts, and
9261 <var>extension</var> is either <tt>scale</tt>
9262 or <tt>alias</tt>, whichever corresponds to
9263 the file contents.
9264 </item>
9265 </list>
9266 </item>
9268 <item>
9269 Font packages must declare a dependency on
9270 <tt>xfonts-utils</tt> in their <tt>Depends</tt>
9271 or <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> control field.
9272 </item>
9274 <item>
9275 Font packages that provide one or more
9276 <file>fonts.scale</file> files as described above must
9277 invoke <prgn>update-fonts-scale</prgn> on each
9278 directory into which they installed fonts
9279 <em>before</em> invoking
9280 <prgn>update-fonts-dir</prgn> on that directory.
9281 This invocation must occur in both the
9282 <prgn>postinst</prgn> (for all arguments) and
9283 <prgn>postrm</prgn> (for all arguments except
9284 <tt>upgrade</tt>) scripts.
9285 </item>
9287 <item>
9288 Font packages that provide one or more
9289 <file>fonts.alias</file> files as described above must
9290 invoke <prgn>update-fonts-alias</prgn> on each
9291 directory into which they installed fonts. This
9292 invocation must occur in both the
9293 <prgn>postinst</prgn> (for all arguments) and
9294 <prgn>postrm</prgn> (for all arguments except
9295 <tt>upgrade</tt>) scripts.
9296 </item>
9298 <item>
9299 Font packages must invoke
9300 <prgn>update-fonts-dir</prgn> on each directory into
9301 which they installed fonts. This invocation must
9302 occur in both the <prgn>postinst</prgn> (for all
9303 arguments) and <prgn>postrm</prgn> (for all
9304 arguments except <tt>upgrade</tt>) scripts.
9305 </item>
9307 <item>
9308 Font packages must not provide alias names for the
9309 fonts they include which collide with alias names
9310 already in use by fonts already packaged.
9311 </item>
9313 <item>
9314 Font packages must not provide fonts with the same
9315 XLFD registry name as another font already packaged.
9316 </item>
9317 </enumlist>
9318 </p>
9319 </sect1>
9321 <sect1 id="appdefaults">
9322 <heading>Application defaults files</heading>
9325 Application defaults files must be installed in the
9326 directory <file>/etc/X11/app-defaults/</file> (use of a
9327 localized subdirectory of <file>/etc/X11/</file> as described
9328 in the <em>X Toolkit Intrinsics - C Language
9329 Interface</em> manual is also permitted). They must be
9330 registered as <tt>conffile</tt>s or handled as
9331 configuration files.
9332 </p>
9335 Customization of programs' X resources may also be
9336 supported with the provision of a file with the same name
9337 as that of the package placed in
9338 the <file>/etc/X11/Xresources/</file> directory, which
9339 must be registered as a <tt>conffile</tt> or handled as a
9340 configuration file.<footnote>
9341 Note that this mechanism is not the same as using
9342 app-defaults; app-defaults are tied to the client
9343 binary on the local file system, whereas X resources
9344 are stored in the X server and affect all connecting
9345 clients.
9346 </footnote>
9347 </p>
9348 </sect1>
9350 <sect1>
9351 <heading>Installation directory issues</heading>
9354 Historically, packages using the X Window System used a
9355 separate set of installation directories from other packages.
9356 This practice has been discontinued and packages using the X
9357 Window System should now generally be installed in the same
9358 directories as any other package. Specifically, packages must
9359 not install files under the <file>/usr/X11R6/</file> directory
9360 and the <file>/usr/X11R6/</file> directory hierarchy should be
9361 regarded as obsolete.
9362 </p>
9365 Include files previously installed under
9366 <file>/usr/X11R6/include/X11/</file> should be installed into
9367 <file>/usr/include/X11/</file>. For files previously
9368 installed into subdirectories of
9369 <file>/usr/X11R6/lib/X11/</file>, package maintainers should
9370 determine if subdirectories of <file>/usr/lib/</file> and
9371 <file>/usr/share/</file> can be used. If not, a subdirectory
9372 of <file>/usr/lib/X11/</file> should be used.
9373 </p>
9376 Configuration files for window, display, or session managers
9377 or other applications that are tightly integrated with the X
9378 Window System may be placed in a subdirectory
9379 of <file>/etc/X11/</file> corresponding to the package name.
9380 Other X Window System applications should use
9381 the <file>/etc/</file> directory unless otherwise mandated by
9382 policy (such as for <ref id="appdefaults">).
9383 </p>
9384 </sect1>
9386 <sect1>
9387 <heading>The OSF/Motif and OpenMotif libraries</heading>
9390 <em>Programs that require the non-DFSG-compliant OSF/Motif or
9391 OpenMotif libraries</em><footnote>
9392 OSF/Motif and OpenMotif are collectively referred to as
9393 "Motif" in this policy document.
9394 </footnote>
9395 should be compiled against and tested with LessTif (a free
9396 re-implementation of Motif) instead. If the maintainer
9397 judges that the program or programs do not work
9398 sufficiently well with LessTif to be distributed and
9399 supported, but do so when compiled against Motif, then two
9400 versions of the package should be created; one linked
9401 statically against Motif and with <tt>-smotif</tt>
9402 appended to the package name, and one linked dynamically
9403 against Motif and with <tt>-dmotif</tt> appended to the
9404 package name.
9405 </p>
9408 Both Motif-linked versions are dependent
9409 upon non-DFSG-compliant software and thus cannot be
9410 uploaded to the <em>main</em> distribution; if the
9411 software is itself DFSG-compliant it may be uploaded to
9412 the <em>contrib</em> distribution. While known existing
9413 versions of Motif permit unlimited redistribution of
9414 binaries linked against the library (whether statically or
9415 dynamically), it is the package maintainer's
9416 responsibility to determine whether this is permitted by
9417 the license of the copy of Motif in their possession.
9418 </p>
9419 </sect1>
9420 </sect>
9422 <sect id="perl">
9423 <heading>Perl programs and modules</heading>
9426 Perl programs and modules should follow the current Perl policy.
9427 </p>
9430 The Perl policy can be found in the <tt>perl-policy</tt>
9431 files in the <tt>debian-policy</tt> package.
9432 It is also available from the Debian web mirrors at
9433 <tt><url name="/doc/packaging-manuals/perl-policy/"
9434 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/perl-policy/"></tt>.
9435 </p>
9436 </sect>
9438 <sect id="emacs">
9439 <heading>Emacs lisp programs</heading>
9442 Please refer to the "Debian Emacs Policy" for details of how to
9443 package emacs lisp programs.
9444 </p>
9447 The Emacs policy is available in
9448 <file>debian-emacs-policy.gz</file> of the
9449 <package>emacsen-common</package> package.
9450 It is also available from the Debian web mirrors at
9451 <tt><url name="/doc/packaging-manuals/debian-emacs-policy"
9452 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/debian-emacs-policy"></tt>.
9453 </p>
9454 </sect>
9456 <sect>
9457 <heading>Games</heading>
9460 The permissions on <file>/var/games</file> are mode 755, owner
9461 <tt>root</tt> and group <tt>root</tt>.
9462 </p>
9465 Each game decides on its own security policy.</p>
9468 Games which require protected, privileged access to
9469 high-score files, saved games, etc., may be made
9470 set-<em>group</em>-id (mode 2755) and owned by
9471 <tt>root:games</tt>, and use files and directories with
9472 appropriate permissions (770 <tt>root:games</tt>, for
9473 example). They must not be made
9474 set-<em>user</em>-id, as this causes security problems. (If
9475 an attacker can subvert any set-user-id game they can
9476 overwrite the executable of any other, causing other players
9477 of these games to run a Trojan horse program. With a
9478 set-group-id game the attacker only gets access to less
9479 important game data, and if they can get at the other
9480 players' accounts at all it will take considerably more
9481 effort.)</p>
9484 Some packages, for example some fortune cookie programs, are
9485 configured by the upstream authors to install with their
9486 data files or other static information made unreadable so
9487 that they can only be accessed through set-id programs
9488 provided. You should not do this in a Debian package: anyone can
9489 download the <file>.deb</file> file and read the data from it,
9490 so there is no point making the files unreadable. Not
9491 making the files unreadable also means that you don't have
9492 to make so many programs set-id, which reduces the risk of a
9493 security hole.</p>
9496 As described in the FHS, binaries of games should be
9497 installed in the directory <file>/usr/games</file>. This also
9498 applies to games that use the X Window System. Manual pages
9499 for games (X and non-X games) should be installed in
9500 <file>/usr/share/man/man6</file>.</p>
9501 </sect>
9502 </chapt>
9505 <chapt id="docs">
9506 <heading>Documentation</heading>
9508 <sect>
9509 <heading>Manual pages</heading>
9512 You should install manual pages in <prgn>nroff</prgn> source
9513 form, in appropriate places under <file>/usr/share/man</file>.
9514 You should only use sections 1 to 9 (see the FHS for more
9515 details). You must not install a pre-formatted "cat page".
9516 </p>
9519 Each program, utility, and function should have an
9520 associated manual page included in the same package. It is
9521 suggested that all configuration files also have a manual
9522 page included as well. Manual pages for protocols and other
9523 auxiliary things are optional.
9524 </p>
9527 If no manual page is available, this is considered as a bug
9528 and should be reported to the Debian Bug Tracking System (the
9529 maintainer of the package is allowed to write this bug report
9530 themselves, if they so desire). Do not close the bug report
9531 until a proper man page is available.<footnote>
9532 It is not very hard to write a man page. See the
9533 <url id="http://www.schweikhardt.net/man_page_howto.html"
9534 name="Man-Page-HOWTO">,
9535 <manref name="man" section="7">, the examples created
9536 by <prgn>dh_make</prgn>, the helper
9537 program <prgn>help2man</prgn>, or the
9538 directory <file>/usr/share/doc/man-db/examples</file>.
9539 </footnote>
9540 </p>
9543 You may forward a complaint about a missing man page to the
9544 upstream authors, and mark the bug as forwarded in the
9545 Debian bug tracking system. Even though the GNU Project do
9546 not in general consider the lack of a man page to be a bug,
9547 we do; if they tell you that they don't consider it a bug
9548 you should leave the bug in our bug tracking system open
9549 anyway.
9550 </p>
9553 Manual pages should be installed compressed using <tt>gzip -9</tt>.
9554 </p>
9557 If one man page needs to be accessible via several names it
9558 is better to use a symbolic link than the <file>.so</file>
9559 feature, but there is no need to fiddle with the relevant
9560 parts of the upstream source to change from <file>.so</file> to
9561 symlinks: don't do it unless it's easy. You should not
9562 create hard links in the manual page directories, nor put
9563 absolute filenames in <file>.so</file> directives. The filename
9564 in a <file>.so</file> in a man page should be relative to the
9565 base of the man page tree (usually
9566 <file>/usr/share/man</file>). If you do not create any links
9567 (whether symlinks, hard links, or <tt>.so</tt> directives)
9568 in the file system to the alternate names of the man page,
9569 then you should not rely on <prgn>man</prgn> finding your
9570 man page under those names based solely on the information in
9571 the man page's header.<footnote>
9572 Supporting this in <prgn>man</prgn> often requires
9573 unreasonable processing time to find a manual page or to
9574 report that none exists, and moves knowledge into man's
9575 database that would be better left in the file system.
9576 This support is therefore deprecated and will cease to
9577 be present in the future.
9578 </footnote>
9579 </p>
9582 Manual pages in locale-specific subdirectories of
9583 <file>/usr/share/man</file> should use either UTF-8 or the usual
9584 legacy encoding for that language (normally the one corresponding
9585 to the shortest relevant locale name in
9586 <file>/usr/share/i18n/SUPPORTED</file>). For example, pages under
9587 <file>/usr/share/man/fr</file> should use either UTF-8 or
9588 ISO-8859-1.<footnote>
9589 <prgn>man</prgn> will automatically detect whether UTF-8 is in
9590 use. In future, all manual pages will be required to use
9591 UTF-8.
9592 </footnote>
9593 </p>
9596 A country name (the <tt>DE</tt> in <tt>de_DE</tt>) should not be
9597 included in the subdirectory name unless it indicates a
9598 significant difference in the language, as this excludes
9599 speakers of the language in other countries.<footnote>
9600 At the time of writing, Chinese and Portuguese are the main
9601 languages with such differences, so <file>pt_BR</file>,
9602 <file>zh_CN</file>, and <file>zh_TW</file> are all allowed.
9603 </footnote>
9604 </p>
9607 If a localized version of a manual page is provided, it should
9608 either be up-to-date or it should be obvious to the reader that
9609 it is outdated and the original manual page should be used
9610 instead. This can be done either by a note at the beginning of
9611 the manual page or by showing the missing or changed portions in
9612 the original language instead of the target language.
9613 </p>
9614 </sect>
9616 <sect>
9617 <heading>Info documents</heading>
9620 Info documents should be installed in <file>/usr/share/info</file>.
9621 They should be compressed with <tt>gzip -9</tt>.
9622 </p>
9625 The <prgn>install-info</prgn> program maintains a directory of
9626 installed info documents in <file>/usr/share/info/dir</file> for
9627 the use of info readers.<footnote>
9628 It was previously necessary for packages installing info
9629 documents to run <prgn>install-info</prgn> from maintainer
9630 scripts. This is no longer necessary. The installation
9631 system now uses dpkg triggers.
9632 </footnote>
9633 This file must not be included in packages. Packages containing
9634 info documents should depend on <tt>dpkg (>= 1.15.4) |
9635 install-info</tt> to ensure that the directory file is properly
9636 rebuilt during partial upgrades from Debian 5.0 (lenny) and
9637 earlier.
9638 </p>
9641 Info documents should contain section and directory entry
9642 information in the document for the use
9643 of <prgn>install-info</prgn>. The section should be specified
9644 via a line starting with <tt>INFO-DIR-SECTION</tt> followed by a
9645 space and the section of this info page. The directory entry or
9646 entries should be included between
9647 a <tt>START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY</tt> line and
9648 an <tt>END-INFO-DIR-ENTRY</tt> line. For example:
9649 <example>
9650 INFO-DIR-SECTION Individual utilities
9651 START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY
9652 * example: (example). An example info directory entry.
9653 END-INFO-DIR-ENTRY
9654 </example>
9655 To determine which section to use, you should look
9656 at <file>/usr/share/info/dir</file> on your system and choose
9657 the most relevant (or create a new section if none of the
9658 current sections are relevant).<footnote>
9659 Normally, info documents are generated from Texinfo source.
9660 To include this information in the generated info document, if
9661 it is absent, add commands like:
9662 <example>
9663 @dircategory Individual utilities
9664 @direntry
9665 * example: (example). An example info directory entry.
9666 @end direntry
9667 </example>
9668 to the Texinfo source of the document and ensure that the info
9669 documents are rebuilt from source during the package build.
9670 </footnote>
9671 </p>
9672 </sect>
9674 <sect>
9675 <heading>Additional documentation</heading>
9678 Any additional documentation that comes with the package may
9679 be installed at the discretion of the package maintainer.
9680 Plain text documentation should be installed in the directory
9681 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file>, where
9682 <var>package</var> is the name of the package, and
9683 compressed with <tt>gzip -9</tt> unless it is small.
9684 </p>
9687 If a package comes with large amounts of documentation which
9688 many users of the package will not require you should create
9689 a separate binary package to contain it, so that it does not
9690 take up disk space on the machines of users who do not need
9691 or want it installed.</p>
9694 It is often a good idea to put text information files
9695 (<file>README</file>s, changelogs, and so forth) that come with
9696 the source package in <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file>
9697 in the binary package. However, you don't need to install
9698 the instructions for building and installing the package, of
9699 course!</p>
9702 Packages must not require the existence of any files in
9703 <file>/usr/share/doc/</file> in order to function
9704 <footnote>
9705 The system administrator should be able to
9706 delete files in <file>/usr/share/doc/</file> without causing
9707 any programs to break.
9708 </footnote>.
9709 Any files that are referenced by programs but are also
9710 useful as stand alone documentation should be installed under
9711 <file>/usr/share/<var>package</var>/</file> with symbolic links from
9712 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file>.
9713 </p>
9716 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file> may be a symbolic
9717 link to another directory in <file>/usr/share/doc</file> only if
9718 the two packages both come from the same source and the
9719 first package Depends on the second.<footnote>
9721 Please note that this does not override the section on
9722 changelog files below, so the file
9723 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/changelog.Debian.gz</file>
9724 must refer to the changelog for the current version of
9725 <var>package</var> in question. In practice, this means
9726 that the sources of the target and the destination of the
9727 symlink must be the same (same source package and
9728 version).
9729 </p>
9730 </footnote>
9731 </p>
9734 Former Debian releases placed all additional documentation
9735 in <file>/usr/doc/<var>package</var></file>. This has been
9736 changed to <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file>,
9737 and packages must not put documentation in the directory
9738 <file>/usr/doc/<var>package</var></file>. <footnote>
9739 At this phase of the transition, we no longer require a
9740 symbolic link in <file>/usr/doc/</file>. At a later point,
9741 policy shall change to make the symbolic links a bug.
9742 </footnote>
9743 </p>
9744 </sect>
9746 <sect>
9747 <heading>Preferred documentation formats</heading>
9750 The unification of Debian documentation is being carried out
9751 via HTML.</p>
9754 If your package comes with extensive documentation in a
9755 markup format that can be converted to various other formats
9756 you should if possible ship HTML versions in a binary
9757 package, in the directory
9758 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>appropriate-package</var></file> or
9759 its subdirectories.<footnote>
9760 The rationale: The important thing here is that HTML
9761 docs should be available in <em>some</em> package, not
9762 necessarily in the main binary package.
9763 </footnote>
9764 </p>
9767 Other formats such as PostScript may be provided at the
9768 package maintainer's discretion.
9769 </p>
9770 </sect>
9772 <sect id="copyrightfile">
9773 <heading>Copyright information</heading>
9776 Every package must be accompanied by a verbatim copy of its
9777 copyright information and distribution license in the file
9778 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/copyright</file>. This
9779 file must neither be compressed nor be a symbolic link.
9780 </p>
9783 In addition, the copyright file must say where the upstream
9784 sources (if any) were obtained. It should name the original
9785 authors of the package and the Debian maintainer(s) who were
9786 involved with its creation.
9787 </p>
9790 Packages in the <em>contrib</em> or <em>non-free</em> archive
9791 areas should state in the copyright file that the package is not
9792 part of the Debian distribution and briefly explain why.
9793 </p>
9796 A copy of the file which will be installed in
9797 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/copyright</file> should
9798 be in <file>debian/copyright</file> in the source package.
9799 </p>
9802 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file> may be a symbolic
9803 link to another directory in <file>/usr/share/doc</file> only if
9804 the two packages both come from the same source and the
9805 first package Depends on the second. These rules are
9806 important because copyrights must be extractable by
9807 mechanical means.
9808 </p>
9811 Packages distributed under the Apache license (version 2.0), the
9812 Artistic license, the GNU GPL (versions 1, 2, or 3), the GNU
9813 LGPL (versions 2, 2.1, or 3), and the GNU FDL (versions 1.2 or
9814 1.3) should refer to the corresponding files
9815 under <file>/usr/share/common-licenses</file>,<footnote>
9817 In particular,
9818 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/Apache-2.0</file>,
9819 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/Artistic</file>,
9820 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/GPL-1</file>,
9821 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/GPL-2</file>,
9822 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/GPL-3</file>,
9823 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/LGPL-2</file>,
9824 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/LGPL-2.1</file>,
9825 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/LGPL-3</file>,
9826 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/GFDL-1.2</file>, and
9827 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/GFDL-1.3</file>
9828 respectively. The University of California BSD license is
9829 also included in <package>base-files</package> as
9830 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/BSD</file>, but given the
9831 brevity of this license, its specificity to code whose
9832 copyright is held by the Regents of the University of
9833 California, and the frequency of minor wording changes, its
9834 text should be included in the copyright file rather than
9835 referencing this file.
9836 </p>
9837 </footnote> rather than quoting them in the copyright
9838 file.
9839 </p>
9842 You should not use the copyright file as a general <file>README</file>
9843 file. If your package has such a file it should be
9844 installed in <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/README</file> or
9845 <file>README.Debian</file> or some other appropriate place.</p>
9846 </sect>
9848 <sect>
9849 <heading>Examples</heading>
9852 Any examples (configurations, source files, whatever),
9853 should be installed in a directory
9854 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/examples</file>. These
9855 files should not be referenced by any program: they're there
9856 for the benefit of the system administrator and users as
9857 documentation only. Architecture-specific example files
9858 should be installed in a directory
9859 <file>/usr/lib/<var>package</var>/examples</file> with symbolic
9860 links to them from
9861 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/examples</file>, or the
9862 latter directory itself may be a symbolic link to the
9863 former.
9864 </p>
9867 If the purpose of a package is to provide examples, then the
9868 example files may be installed into
9869 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file>.
9870 </p>
9871 </sect>
9873 <sect id="changelogs">
9874 <heading>Changelog files</heading>
9877 Packages that are not Debian-native must contain a
9878 compressed copy of the <file>debian/changelog</file> file from
9879 the Debian source tree in
9880 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file> with the name
9881 <file>changelog.Debian.gz</file>.
9882 </p>
9885 If an upstream changelog is available, it should be accessible as
9886 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/changelog.gz</file> in
9887 plain text. If the upstream changelog is distributed in
9888 HTML, it should be made available in that form as
9889 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/changelog.html.gz</file>
9890 and a plain text <file>changelog.gz</file> should be generated
9891 from it using, for example, <tt>lynx -dump -nolist</tt>. If
9892 the upstream changelog files do not already conform to this
9893 naming convention, then this may be achieved either by
9894 renaming the files, or by adding a symbolic link, at the
9895 maintainer's discretion.<footnote>
9896 Rationale: People should not have to look in places for
9897 upstream changelogs merely because they are given
9898 different names or are distributed in HTML format.
9899 </footnote>
9900 </p>
9903 All of these files should be installed compressed using
9904 <tt>gzip -9</tt>, as they will become large with time even
9905 if they start out small.
9906 </p>
9909 If the package has only one changelog which is used both as
9910 the Debian changelog and the upstream one because there is
9911 no separate upstream maintainer then that changelog should
9912 usually be installed as
9913 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/changelog.gz</file>; if
9914 there is a separate upstream maintainer, but no upstream
9915 changelog, then the Debian changelog should still be called
9916 <file>changelog.Debian.gz</file>.
9917 </p>
9920 For details about the format and contents of the Debian
9921 changelog file, please see <ref id="dpkgchangelog">.
9922 </p>
9923 </sect>
9924 </chapt>
9926 <appendix id="pkg-scope">
9927 <heading>Introduction and scope of these appendices</heading>
9930 These appendices are taken essentially verbatim from the
9931 now-deprecated Packaging Manual, version 3.2.1.0. They are
9932 the chapters which are likely to be of use to package
9933 maintainers and which have not already been included in the
9934 policy document itself. Most of these sections are very likely
9935 not relevant to policy; they should be treated as
9936 documentation for the packaging system. Please note that these
9937 appendices are included for convenience, and for historical
9938 reasons: they used to be part of policy package, and they have
9939 not yet been incorporated into dpkg documentation. However,
9940 they still have value, and hence they are presented here.
9941 </p>
9944 They have not yet been checked to ensure that they are
9945 compatible with the contents of policy, and if there are any
9946 contradictions, the version in the main policy document takes
9947 precedence. The remaining chapters of the old Packaging
9948 Manual have also not been read in detail to ensure that there
9949 are not parts which have been left out. Both of these will be
9950 done in due course.
9951 </p>
9954 Certain parts of the Packaging manual were integrated into the
9955 Policy Manual proper, and removed from the appendices. Links
9956 have been placed from the old locations to the new ones.
9957 </p>
9960 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> is a suite of programs for creating binary
9961 package files and installing and removing them on Unix
9962 systems.<footnote>
9963 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> is targeted primarily at Debian, but may
9964 work on or be ported to other systems.
9965 </footnote>
9966 </p>
9969 The binary packages are designed for the management of
9970 installed executable programs (usually compiled binaries) and
9971 their associated data, though source code examples and
9972 documentation are provided as part of some packages.</p>
9975 This manual describes the technical aspects of creating Debian
9976 binary packages (<file>.deb</file> files). It documents the
9977 behavior of the package management programs
9978 <prgn>dpkg</prgn>, <prgn>dselect</prgn> et al. and the way
9979 they interact with packages.</p>
9982 It also documents the interaction between
9983 <prgn>dselect</prgn>'s core and the access method scripts it
9984 uses to actually install the selected packages, and describes
9985 how to create a new access method.</p>
9988 This manual does not go into detail about the options and
9989 usage of the package building and installation tools. It
9990 should therefore be read in conjunction with those programs'
9991 man pages.
9992 </p>
9995 The utility programs which are provided with <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
9996 for managing various system configuration and similar issues,
9997 such as <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> and
9998 <prgn>install-info</prgn>, are not described in detail here -
9999 please see their man pages.
10000 </p>
10003 It is assumed that the reader is reasonably familiar with the
10004 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> System Administrators' manual.
10005 Unfortunately this manual does not yet exist.
10006 </p>
10009 The Debian version of the FSF's GNU hello program is provided as
10010 an example for people wishing to create Debian packages. However,
10011 while the examples are helpful, they do not replace the need to
10012 read and follow the Policy and Programmer's Manual.</p>
10013 </appendix>
10015 <appendix id="pkg-binarypkg">
10016 <heading>Binary packages (from old Packaging Manual)</heading>
10019 The binary package has two main sections. The first part
10020 consists of various control information files and scripts used
10021 by <prgn>dpkg</prgn> when installing and removing. See <ref
10022 id="pkg-controlarea">.
10023 </p>
10026 The second part is an archive containing the files and
10027 directories to be installed.
10028 </p>
10031 In the future binary packages may also contain other
10032 components, such as checksums and digital signatures. The
10033 format for the archive is described in full in the
10034 <file>deb(5)</file> man page.
10035 </p>
10038 <sect id="pkg-bincreating"><heading>Creating package files -
10039 <prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn>
10040 </heading>
10043 All manipulation of binary package files is done by
10044 <prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn>; it's the only program that has
10045 knowledge of the format. (<prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn> may be
10046 invoked by calling <prgn>dpkg</prgn>, as <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
10047 will spot that the options requested are appropriate to
10048 <prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn> and invoke that instead with the same
10049 arguments.)
10050 </p>
10053 In order to create a binary package you must make a
10054 directory tree which contains all the files and directories
10055 you want to have in the file system data part of the package.
10056 In Debian-format source packages this directory is usually
10057 <file>debian/tmp</file>, relative to the top of the package's
10058 source tree.
10059 </p>
10062 They should have the locations (relative to the root of the
10063 directory tree you're constructing) ownerships and
10064 permissions which you want them to have on the system when
10065 they are installed.
10066 </p>
10069 With current versions of <prgn>dpkg</prgn> the uid/username
10070 and gid/groupname mappings for the users and groups being
10071 used should be the same on the system where the package is
10072 built and the one where it is installed.
10073 </p>
10076 You need to add one special directory to the root of the
10077 miniature file system tree you're creating:
10078 <prgn>DEBIAN</prgn>. It should contain the control
10079 information files, notably the binary package control file
10080 (see <ref id="pkg-controlfile">).
10081 </p>
10084 The <prgn>DEBIAN</prgn> directory will not appear in the
10085 file system archive of the package, and so won't be installed
10086 by <prgn>dpkg</prgn> when the package is unpacked.
10087 </p>
10090 When you've prepared the package, you should invoke:
10091 <example>
10092 dpkg --build <var>directory</var>
10093 </example>
10094 </p>
10097 This will build the package in
10098 <file><var>directory</var>.deb</file>. (<prgn>dpkg</prgn> knows
10099 that <tt>--build</tt> is a <prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn> option, so
10100 it invokes <prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn> with the same arguments to
10101 build the package.)
10102 </p>
10105 See the man page <manref name="dpkg-deb" section="8"> for details of how
10106 to examine the contents of this newly-created file. You may find the
10107 output of following commands enlightening:
10108 <example>
10109 dpkg-deb --info <var>filename</var>.deb
10110 dpkg-deb --contents <var>filename</var>.deb
10111 dpkg --contents <var>filename</var>.deb
10112 </example>
10113 To view the copyright file for a package you could use this command:
10114 <example>
10115 dpkg --fsys-tarfile <var>filename</var>.deb | tar xOf - --wildcards \*/copyright | pager
10116 </example>
10117 </p>
10118 </sect>
10120 <sect id="pkg-controlarea">
10121 <heading>Package control information files</heading>
10124 The control information portion of a binary package is a
10125 collection of files with names known to <prgn>dpkg</prgn>.
10126 It will treat the contents of these files specially - some
10127 of them contain information used by <prgn>dpkg</prgn> when
10128 installing or removing the package; others are scripts which
10129 the package maintainer wants <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to run.
10130 </p>
10133 It is possible to put other files in the package control
10134 information file area, but this is not generally a good idea
10135 (though they will largely be ignored).
10136 </p>
10139 Here is a brief list of the control information files supported
10140 by <prgn>dpkg</prgn> and a summary of what they're used for.
10141 </p>
10144 <taglist>
10145 <tag><tt>control</tt>
10146 <item>
10148 This is the key description file used by
10149 <prgn>dpkg</prgn>. It specifies the package's name
10150 and version, gives its description for the user,
10151 states its relationships with other packages, and so
10152 forth. See <ref id="sourcecontrolfiles"> and
10153 <ref id="binarycontrolfiles">.
10154 </p>
10157 It is usually generated automatically from information
10158 in the source package by the
10159 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> program, and with
10160 assistance from <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn>.
10161 See <ref id="pkg-sourcetools">.
10162 </p>
10163 </item>
10165 <tag><tt>postinst</tt>, <tt>preinst</tt>, <tt>postrm</tt>,
10166 <tt>prerm</tt>
10167 </tag>
10168 <item>
10170 These are executable files (usually scripts) which
10171 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> runs during installation, upgrade
10172 and removal of packages. They allow the package to
10173 deal with matters which are particular to that package
10174 or require more complicated processing than that
10175 provided by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>. Details of when and
10176 how they are called are in <ref id="maintainerscripts">.
10177 </p>
10180 It is very important to make these scripts idempotent.
10181 See <ref id="idempotency">.
10182 </p>
10185 The maintainer scripts are not guaranteed to run with a
10186 controlling terminal and may not be able to interact with
10187 the user. See <ref id="controllingterminal">.
10188 </p>
10189 </item>
10191 <tag><tt>conffiles</tt>
10192 </tag>
10193 <item>
10194 This file contains a list of configuration files which
10195 are to be handled automatically by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
10196 (see <ref id="pkg-conffiles">). Note that not necessarily
10197 every configuration file should be listed here.
10198 </item>
10200 <tag><tt>shlibs</tt>
10201 </tag>
10202 <item>
10203 This file contains a list of the shared libraries
10204 supplied by the package, with dependency details for
10205 each. This is used by <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn>
10206 when it determines what dependencies are required in a
10207 package control file. The <tt>shlibs</tt> file format
10208 is described on <ref id="shlibs">.
10209 </item>
10210 </taglist>
10211 </p>
10213 <sect id="pkg-controlfile">
10214 <heading>The main control information file: <tt>control</tt></heading>
10217 The most important control information file used by
10218 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> when it installs a package is
10219 <tt>control</tt>. It contains all the package's "vital
10220 statistics".
10221 </p>
10224 The binary package control files of packages built from
10225 Debian sources are made by a special tool,
10226 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn>, which reads
10227 <file>debian/control</file> and <file>debian/changelog</file> to
10228 find the information it needs. See <ref id="pkg-sourcepkg"> for
10229 more details.
10230 </p>
10233 The fields in binary package control files are listed in
10234 <ref id="binarycontrolfiles">.
10235 </p>
10238 A description of the syntax of control files and the purpose
10239 of the fields is available in <ref id="controlfields">.
10240 </p>
10241 </sect>
10243 <sect>
10244 <heading>Time Stamps</heading>
10247 See <ref id="timestamps">.
10248 </p>
10249 </sect>
10250 </appendix>
10252 <appendix id="pkg-sourcepkg">
10253 <heading>Source packages (from old Packaging Manual) </heading>
10256 The Debian binary packages in the distribution are generated
10257 from Debian sources, which are in a special format to assist
10258 the easy and automatic building of binaries.
10259 </p>
10261 <sect id="pkg-sourcetools">
10262 <heading>Tools for processing source packages</heading>
10265 Various tools are provided for manipulating source packages;
10266 they pack and unpack sources and help build of binary
10267 packages and help manage the distribution of new versions.
10268 </p>
10271 They are introduced and typical uses described here; see
10272 <manref name="dpkg-source" section="1"> for full
10273 documentation about their arguments and operation.
10274 </p>
10277 For examples of how to construct a Debian source package,
10278 and how to use those utilities that are used by Debian
10279 source packages, please see the <prgn>hello</prgn> example
10280 package.
10281 </p>
10283 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-source">
10284 <heading>
10285 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> - packs and unpacks Debian source
10286 packages
10287 </heading>
10290 This program is frequently used by hand, and is also
10291 called from package-independent automated building scripts
10292 such as <prgn>dpkg-buildpackage</prgn>.
10293 </p>
10296 To unpack a package it is typically invoked with
10297 <example>
10298 dpkg-source -x <var>.../path/to/filename</var>.dsc
10299 </example>
10300 </p>
10303 with the <file><var>filename</var>.tar.gz</file> and
10304 <file><var>filename</var>.diff.gz</file> (if applicable) in
10305 the same directory. It unpacks into
10306 <file><var>package</var>-<var>version</var></file>, and if
10307 applicable
10308 <file><var>package</var>-<var>version</var>.orig</file>, in
10309 the current directory.
10310 </p>
10313 To create a packed source archive it is typically invoked:
10314 <example>
10315 dpkg-source -b <var>package</var>-<var>version</var>
10316 </example>
10317 </p>
10320 This will create the <file>.dsc</file>, <file>.tar.gz</file> and
10321 <file>.diff.gz</file> (if appropriate) in the current
10322 directory. <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> does not clean the
10323 source tree first - this must be done separately if it is
10324 required.
10325 </p>
10328 See also <ref id="pkg-sourcearchives">.</p>
10329 </sect1>
10332 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-buildpackage">
10333 <heading>
10334 <prgn>dpkg-buildpackage</prgn> - overall package-building
10335 control script
10336 </heading>
10339 <prgn>dpkg-buildpackage</prgn> is a script which invokes
10340 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn>, the <file>debian/rules</file>
10341 targets <tt>clean</tt>, <tt>build</tt> and
10342 <tt>binary</tt>, <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> and
10343 <prgn>gpg</prgn> (or <prgn>pgp</prgn>) to build a signed
10344 source and binary package upload.
10345 </p>
10348 It is usually invoked by hand from the top level of the
10349 built or unbuilt source directory. It may be invoked with
10350 no arguments; useful arguments include:
10351 <taglist compact="compact">
10352 <tag><tt>-uc</tt>, <tt>-us</tt></tag>
10353 <item>
10355 Do not sign the <tt>.changes</tt> file or the
10356 source package <tt>.dsc</tt> file, respectively.</p>
10357 </item>
10358 <tag><tt>-p<var>sign-command</var></tt></tag>
10359 <item>
10361 Invoke <var>sign-command</var> instead of finding
10362 <tt>gpg</tt> or <tt>pgp</tt> on the <prgn>PATH</prgn>.
10363 <var>sign-command</var> must behave just like
10364 <prgn>gpg</prgn> or <tt>pgp</tt>.</p>
10365 </item>
10366 <tag><tt>-r<var>root-command</var></tt></tag>
10367 <item>
10369 When root privilege is required, invoke the command
10370 <var>root-command</var>. <var>root-command</var>
10371 should invoke its first argument as a command, from
10372 the <prgn>PATH</prgn> if necessary, and pass its
10373 second and subsequent arguments to the command it
10374 calls. If no <var>root-command</var> is supplied
10375 then <var>dpkg-buildpackage</var> will take no
10376 special action to gain root privilege, so that for
10377 most packages it will have to be invoked as root to
10378 start with.</p>
10379 </item>
10380 <tag><tt>-b</tt>, <tt>-B</tt></tag>
10381 <item>
10383 Two types of binary-only build and upload - see
10384 <manref name="dpkg-source" section="1">.
10385 </p>
10386 </item>
10387 </taglist>
10388 </p>
10389 </sect1>
10391 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-gencontrol">
10392 <heading>
10393 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> - generates binary package
10394 control files
10395 </heading>
10398 This program is usually called from <file>debian/rules</file>
10399 (see <ref id="pkg-sourcetree">) in the top level of the source
10400 tree.
10401 </p>
10404 This is usually done just before the files and directories in the
10405 temporary directory tree where the package is being built have their
10406 permissions and ownerships set and the package is constructed using
10407 <prgn>dpkg-deb/</prgn>
10408 <footnote>
10409 This is so that the control file which is produced has
10410 the right permissions
10411 </footnote>.
10412 </p>
10415 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> must be called after all the
10416 files which are to go into the package have been placed in
10417 the temporary build directory, so that its calculation of
10418 the installed size of a package is correct.
10419 </p>
10422 It is also necessary for <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> to
10423 be run after <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> so that the
10424 variable substitutions created by
10425 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> in <file>debian/substvars</file>
10426 are available.
10427 </p>
10430 For a package which generates only one binary package, and
10431 which builds it in <file>debian/tmp</file> relative to the top
10432 of the source package, it is usually sufficient to call
10433 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn>.
10434 </p>
10437 Sources which build several binaries will typically need
10438 something like:
10439 <example>
10440 dpkg-gencontrol -Pdebian/tmp-<var>pkg</var> -p<var>package</var>
10441 </example> The <tt>-P</tt> tells
10442 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> that the package is being
10443 built in a non-default directory, and the <tt>-p</tt>
10444 tells it which package's control file should be generated.
10445 </p>
10448 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> also adds information to the
10449 list of files in <file>debian/files</file>, for the benefit of
10450 (for example) a future invocation of
10451 <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn>.</p>
10452 </sect1>
10454 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-shlibdeps">
10455 <heading>
10456 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> - calculates shared library
10457 dependencies
10458 </heading>
10461 This program is usually called from <file>debian/rules</file>
10462 just before <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> (see <ref
10463 id="pkg-sourcetree">), in the top level of the source tree.
10464 </p>
10467 Its arguments are executables and shared libraries
10468 <footnote>
10470 They may be specified either in the locations in the
10471 source tree where they are created or in the locations
10472 in the temporary build tree where they are installed
10473 prior to binary package creation.
10474 </p>
10475 </footnote> for which shared library dependencies should
10476 be included in the binary package's control file.
10477 </p>
10480 If some of the found shared libraries should only
10481 warrant a <tt>Recommends</tt> or <tt>Suggests</tt>, or if
10482 some warrant a <tt>Pre-Depends</tt>, this can be achieved
10483 by using the <tt>-d<var>dependency-field</var></tt> option
10484 before those executable(s). (Each <tt>-d</tt> option
10485 takes effect until the next <tt>-d</tt>.)
10486 </p>
10489 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> does not directly cause the
10490 output control file to be modified. Instead by default it
10491 adds to the <file>debian/substvars</file> file variable
10492 settings like <tt>shlibs:Depends</tt>. These variable
10493 settings must be referenced in dependency fields in the
10494 appropriate per-binary-package sections of the source
10495 control file.
10496 </p>
10499 For example, a package that generates an essential part
10500 which requires dependencies, and optional parts that
10501 which only require a recommendation, would separate those
10502 two sets of dependencies into two different fields.<footnote>
10503 At the time of writing, an example for this was the
10504 <package/xmms/ package, with Depends used for the xmms
10505 executable, Recommends for the plug-ins and Suggests for
10506 even more optional features provided by unzip.
10507 </footnote>
10508 It can say in its <file>debian/rules</file>:
10509 <example>
10510 dpkg-shlibdeps -dDepends <var>program anotherprogram ...</var> \
10511 -dRecommends <var>optionalpart anotheroptionalpart</var>
10512 </example>
10513 and then in its main control file <file>debian/control</file>:
10514 <example>
10515 <var>...</var>
10516 Depends: ${shlibs:Depends}
10517 Recommends: ${shlibs:Recommends}
10518 <var>...</var>
10519 </example>
10520 </p>
10523 Sources which produce several binary packages with
10524 different shared library dependency requirements can use
10525 the <tt>-p<var>varnameprefix</var></tt> option to override
10526 the default <tt>shlibs:</tt> prefix (one invocation of
10527 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> per setting of this option).
10528 They can thus produce several sets of dependency
10529 variables, each of the form
10530 <tt><var>varnameprefix</var>:<var>dependencyfield</var></tt>,
10531 which can be referred to in the appropriate parts of the
10532 binary package control files.
10533 </p>
10534 </sect1>
10537 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-distaddfile">
10538 <heading>
10539 <prgn>dpkg-distaddfile</prgn> - adds a file to
10540 <file>debian/files</file>
10541 </heading>
10544 Some packages' uploads need to include files other than
10545 the source and binary package files.
10546 </p>
10549 <prgn>dpkg-distaddfile</prgn> adds a file to the
10550 <file>debian/files</file> file so that it will be included in
10551 the <file>.changes</file> file when
10552 <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> is run.
10553 </p>
10556 It is usually invoked from the <tt>binary</tt> target of
10557 <file>debian/rules</file>:
10558 <example>
10559 dpkg-distaddfile <var>filename</var> <var>section</var> <var>priority</var>
10560 </example>
10561 The <var>filename</var> is relative to the directory where
10562 <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> will expect to find it - this
10563 is usually the directory above the top level of the source
10564 tree. The <file>debian/rules</file> target should put the
10565 file there just before or just after calling
10566 <prgn>dpkg-distaddfile</prgn>.
10567 </p>
10570 The <var>section</var> and <var>priority</var> are passed
10571 unchanged into the resulting <file>.changes</file> file.
10572 </p>
10573 </sect1>
10576 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-genchanges">
10577 <heading>
10578 <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> - generates a <file>.changes</file>
10579 upload control file
10580 </heading>
10583 This program is usually called by package-independent
10584 automatic building scripts such as
10585 <prgn>dpkg-buildpackage</prgn>, but it may also be called
10586 by hand.
10587 </p>
10590 It is usually called in the top level of a built source
10591 tree, and when invoked with no arguments will print out a
10592 straightforward <file>.changes</file> file based on the
10593 information in the source package's changelog and control
10594 file and the binary and source packages which should have
10595 been built.
10596 </p>
10597 </sect1>
10600 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-parsechangelog">
10601 <heading>
10602 <prgn>dpkg-parsechangelog</prgn> - produces parsed
10603 representation of a changelog
10604 </heading>
10607 This program is used internally by
10608 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> et al. It may also occasionally
10609 be useful in <file>debian/rules</file> and elsewhere. It
10610 parses a changelog, <file>debian/changelog</file> by default,
10611 and prints a control-file format representation of the
10612 information in it to standard output.
10613 </p>
10614 </sect1>
10616 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-architecture">
10617 <heading>
10618 <prgn>dpkg-architecture</prgn> - information about the build and
10619 host system
10620 </heading>
10623 This program can be used manually, but is also invoked by
10624 <tt>dpkg-buildpackage</tt> or <file>debian/rules</file> to set
10625 environment or make variables which specify the build and host
10626 architecture for the package building process.
10627 </p>
10628 </sect1>
10629 </sect>
10631 <sect id="pkg-sourcetree">
10632 <heading>The Debian package source tree</heading>
10635 The source archive scheme described later is intended to
10636 allow a Debian package source tree with some associated
10637 control information to be reproduced and transported easily.
10638 The Debian package source tree is a version of the original
10639 program with certain files added for the benefit of the
10640 packaging process, and with any other changes required
10641 made to the rest of the source code and installation
10642 scripts.
10643 </p>
10646 The extra files created for Debian are in the subdirectory
10647 <file>debian</file> of the top level of the Debian package
10648 source tree. They are described below.
10649 </p>
10651 <sect1 id="pkg-debianrules">
10652 <heading><file>debian/rules</file> - the main building script</heading>
10655 See <ref id="debianrules">.
10656 </p>
10657 </sect1>
10659 <sect1 id="pkg-srcsubstvars">
10660 <heading><file>debian/substvars</file> and variable substitutions</heading>
10663 See <ref id="substvars">.
10664 </p>
10666 </sect1>
10668 <sect1>
10669 <heading><file>debian/files</file></heading>
10672 See <ref id="debianfiles">.
10673 </p>
10674 </sect1>
10676 <sect1><heading><file>debian/tmp</file>
10677 </heading>
10680 This is the canonical temporary location for the
10681 construction of binary packages by the <tt>binary</tt>
10682 target. The directory <file>tmp</file> serves as the root of
10683 the file system tree as it is being constructed (for
10684 example, by using the package's upstream makefiles install
10685 targets and redirecting the output there), and it also
10686 contains the <tt>DEBIAN</tt> subdirectory. See <ref
10687 id="pkg-bincreating">.
10688 </p>
10691 If several binary packages are generated from the same
10692 source tree it is usual to use several
10693 <file>debian/tmp<var>something</var></file> directories, for
10694 example <file>tmp-a</file> or <file>tmp-doc</file>.
10695 </p>
10698 Whatever <file>tmp</file> directories are created and used by
10699 <tt>binary</tt> must of course be removed by the
10700 <tt>clean</tt> target.</p></sect1>
10701 </sect>
10704 <sect id="pkg-sourcearchives"><heading>Source packages as archives
10705 </heading>
10708 As it exists on the FTP site, a Debian source package
10709 consists of three related files. You must have the right
10710 versions of all three to be able to use them.
10711 </p>
10714 <taglist>
10715 <tag>Debian source control file - <tt>.dsc</tt></tag>
10716 <item>
10717 This file is a control file used by <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn>
10718 to extract a source package.
10719 See <ref id="debiansourcecontrolfiles">.
10720 </item>
10722 <tag>
10723 Original source archive -
10724 <file>
10725 <var>package</var>_<var>upstream-version</var>.orig.tar.gz
10726 </file>
10727 </tag>
10729 <item>
10731 This is a compressed (with <tt>gzip -9</tt>)
10732 <prgn>tar</prgn> file containing the source code from
10733 the upstream authors of the program.
10734 </p>
10735 </item>
10737 <tag>
10738 Debian package diff -
10739 <file>
10740 <var>package</var>_<var>upstream_version-revision</var>.diff.gz
10741 </file>
10742 </tag>
10743 <item>
10746 This is a unified context diff (<tt>diff -u</tt>)
10747 giving the changes which are required to turn the
10748 original source into the Debian source. These changes
10749 may only include editing and creating plain files.
10750 The permissions of files, the targets of symbolic
10751 links and the characteristics of special files or
10752 pipes may not be changed and no files may be removed
10753 or renamed.
10754 </p>
10757 All the directories in the diff must exist, except the
10758 <file>debian</file> subdirectory of the top of the source
10759 tree, which will be created by
10760 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> if necessary when unpacking.
10761 </p>
10764 The <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> program will
10765 automatically make the <file>debian/rules</file> file
10766 executable (see below).</p></item>
10767 </taglist>
10768 </p>
10771 If there is no original source code - for example, if the
10772 package is specially prepared for Debian or the Debian
10773 maintainer is the same as the upstream maintainer - the
10774 format is slightly different: then there is no diff, and the
10775 tarfile is named
10776 <file><var>package</var>_<var>version</var>.tar.gz</file>,
10777 and preferably contains a directory named
10778 <file><var>package</var>-<var>version</var></file>.
10779 </p>
10780 </sect>
10782 <sect>
10783 <heading>Unpacking a Debian source package without <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn></heading>
10786 <tt>dpkg-source -x</tt> is the recommended way to unpack a
10787 Debian source package. However, if it is not available it
10788 is possible to unpack a Debian source archive as follows:
10789 <enumlist compact="compact">
10790 <item>
10792 Untar the tarfile, which will create a <file>.orig</file>
10793 directory.</p>
10794 </item>
10795 <item>
10796 <p>Rename the <file>.orig</file> directory to
10797 <file><var>package</var>-<var>version</var></file>.</p>
10798 </item>
10799 <item>
10801 Create the subdirectory <file>debian</file> at the top of
10802 the source tree.</p>
10803 </item>
10804 <item><p>Apply the diff using <tt>patch -p0</tt>.</p>
10805 </item>
10806 <item><p>Untar the tarfile again if you want a copy of the original
10807 source code alongside the Debian version.</p>
10808 </item>
10809 </enumlist>
10812 It is not possible to generate a valid Debian source archive
10813 without using <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn>. In particular,
10814 attempting to use <prgn>diff</prgn> directly to generate the
10815 <file>.diff.gz</file> file will not work.
10816 </p>
10818 <sect1>
10819 <heading>Restrictions on objects in source packages</heading>
10822 The source package may not contain any hard links
10823 <footnote>
10824 This is not currently detected when building source
10825 packages, but only when extracting
10826 them.
10827 </footnote>
10828 <footnote>
10829 Hard links may be permitted at some point in the
10830 future, but would require a fair amount of
10831 work.
10832 </footnote>, device special files, sockets or setuid or
10833 setgid files.
10834 <footnote>
10835 Setgid directories are allowed.
10836 </footnote>
10837 </p>
10840 The source packaging tools manage the changes between the
10841 original and Debian source using <prgn>diff</prgn> and
10842 <prgn>patch</prgn>. Turning the original source tree as
10843 included in the <file>.orig.tar.gz</file> into the Debian
10844 package source must not involve any changes which cannot be
10845 handled by these tools. Problematic changes which cause
10846 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> to halt with an error when
10847 building the source package are:
10848 <list compact="compact">
10849 <item><p>Adding or removing symbolic links, sockets or pipes.</p>
10850 </item>
10851 <item><p>Changing the targets of symbolic links.</p>
10852 </item>
10853 <item><p>Creating directories, other than <file>debian</file>.</p>
10854 </item>
10855 <item><p>Changes to the contents of binary files.</p></item>
10856 </list> Changes which cause <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> to
10857 print a warning but continue anyway are:
10858 <list compact="compact">
10859 <item>
10861 Removing files, directories or symlinks.
10862 <footnote>
10863 Renaming a file is not treated specially - it is
10864 seen as the removal of the old file (which
10865 generates a warning, but is otherwise ignored),
10866 and the creation of the new one.
10867 </footnote>
10868 </p>
10869 </item>
10870 <item>
10872 Changed text files which are missing the usual final
10873 newline (either in the original or the modified
10874 source tree).
10875 </p>
10876 </item>
10877 </list>
10878 Changes which are not represented, but which are not detected by
10879 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn>, are:
10880 <list compact="compact">
10881 <item><p>Changing the permissions of files (other than
10882 <file>debian/rules</file>) and directories.</p></item>
10883 </list>
10884 </p>
10887 The <file>debian</file> directory and <file>debian/rules</file>
10888 are handled specially by <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> - before
10889 applying the changes it will create the <file>debian</file>
10890 directory, and afterwards it will make
10891 <file>debian/rules</file> world-executable.
10892 </p>
10893 </sect1>
10894 </sect>
10895 </appendix>
10897 <appendix id="pkg-controlfields">
10898 <heading>Control files and their fields (from old Packaging Manual)</heading>
10901 Many of the tools in the <prgn>dpkg</prgn> suite manipulate
10902 data in a common format, known as control files. Binary and
10903 source packages have control data as do the <file>.changes</file>
10904 files which control the installation of uploaded files, and
10905 <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s internal databases are in a similar
10906 format.
10907 </p>
10909 <sect>
10910 <heading>Syntax of control files</heading>
10913 See <ref id="controlsyntax">.
10914 </p>
10917 It is important to note that there are several fields which
10918 are optional as far as <prgn>dpkg</prgn> and the related
10919 tools are concerned, but which must appear in every Debian
10920 package, or whose omission may cause problems.
10921 </p>
10922 </sect>
10924 <sect>
10925 <heading>List of fields</heading>
10928 See <ref id="controlfieldslist">.
10929 </p>
10932 This section now contains only the fields that didn't belong
10933 to the Policy manual.
10934 </p>
10936 <sect1 id="pkg-f-Filename">
10937 <heading><tt>Filename</tt> and <tt>MSDOS-Filename</tt></heading>
10940 These fields in <tt>Packages</tt> files give the
10941 filename(s) of (the parts of) a package in the
10942 distribution directories, relative to the root of the
10943 Debian hierarchy. If the package has been split into
10944 several parts the parts are all listed in order, separated
10945 by spaces.
10946 </p>
10947 </sect1>
10949 <sect1 id="pkg-f-Size">
10950 <heading><tt>Size</tt> and <tt>MD5sum</tt></heading>
10953 These fields in <file>Packages</file> files give the size (in
10954 bytes, expressed in decimal) and MD5 checksum of the
10955 file(s) which make(s) up a binary package in the
10956 distribution. If the package is split into several parts
10957 the values for the parts are listed in order, separated by
10958 spaces.
10959 </p>
10960 </sect1>
10962 <sect1 id="pkg-f-Status">
10963 <heading><tt>Status</tt></heading>
10966 This field in <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s status file records
10967 whether the user wants a package installed, removed or
10968 left alone, whether it is broken (requiring
10969 re-installation) or not and what its current state on the
10970 system is. Each of these pieces of information is a
10971 single word.
10972 </p>
10973 </sect1>
10975 <sect1 id="pkg-f-Config-Version">
10976 <heading><tt>Config-Version</tt></heading>
10979 If a package is not installed or not configured, this
10980 field in <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s status file records the last
10981 version of the package which was successfully
10982 configured.
10983 </p>
10984 </sect1>
10986 <sect1 id="pkg-f-Conffiles">
10987 <heading><tt>Conffiles</tt></heading>
10990 This field in <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s status file contains
10991 information about the automatically-managed configuration
10992 files held by a package. This field should <em>not</em>
10993 appear anywhere in a package!
10994 </p>
10995 </sect1>
10997 <sect1>
10998 <heading>Obsolete fields</heading>
11001 These are still recognized by <prgn>dpkg</prgn> but should
11002 not appear anywhere any more.
11004 <taglist compact="compact">
11006 <tag><tt>Revision</tt></tag>
11007 <tag><tt>Package-Revision</tt></tag>
11008 <tag><tt>Package_Revision</tt></tag>
11009 <item>
11010 The Debian revision part of the package version was
11011 at one point in a separate control field. This
11012 field went through several names.
11013 </item>
11015 <tag><tt>Recommended</tt></tag>
11016 <item>Old name for <tt>Recommends</tt>.</item>
11018 <tag><tt>Optional</tt></tag>
11019 <item>Old name for <tt>Suggests</tt>.</item>
11021 <tag><tt>Class</tt></tag>
11022 <item>Old name for <tt>Priority</tt>.</item>
11024 </taglist>
11025 </p>
11026 </sect1>
11027 </sect>
11029 </appendix>
11031 <appendix id="pkg-conffiles">
11032 <heading>Configuration file handling (from old Packaging Manual)</heading>
11035 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> can do a certain amount of automatic
11036 handling of package configuration files.
11037 </p>
11040 Whether this mechanism is appropriate depends on a number of
11041 factors, but basically there are two approaches to any
11042 particular configuration file.
11043 </p>
11046 The easy method is to ship a best-effort configuration in the
11047 package, and use <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s conffile mechanism to
11048 handle updates. If the user is unlikely to want to edit the
11049 file, but you need them to be able to without losing their
11050 changes, and a new package with a changed version of the file
11051 is only released infrequently, this is a good approach.
11052 </p>
11055 The hard method is to build the configuration file from
11056 scratch in the <prgn>postinst</prgn> script, and to take the
11057 responsibility for fixing any mistakes made in earlier
11058 versions of the package automatically. This will be
11059 appropriate if the file is likely to need to be different on
11060 each system.
11061 </p>
11063 <sect><heading>Automatic handling of configuration files by
11064 <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
11065 </heading>
11068 A package may contain a control information file called
11069 <tt>conffiles</tt>. This file should be a list of filenames
11070 of configuration files needing automatic handling, separated
11071 by newlines. The filenames should be absolute pathnames,
11072 and the files referred to should actually exist in the
11073 package.
11074 </p>
11077 When a package is upgraded <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will process
11078 the configuration files during the configuration stage,
11079 shortly before it runs the package's <prgn>postinst</prgn>
11080 script,
11081 </p>
11084 For each file it checks to see whether the version of the
11085 file included in the package is the same as the one that was
11086 included in the last version of the package (the one that is
11087 being upgraded from); it also compares the version currently
11088 installed on the system with the one shipped with the last
11089 version.
11090 </p>
11093 If neither the user nor the package maintainer has changed
11094 the file, it is left alone. If one or the other has changed
11095 their version, then the changed version is preferred - i.e.,
11096 if the user edits their file, but the package maintainer
11097 doesn't ship a different version, the user's changes will
11098 stay, silently, but if the maintainer ships a new version
11099 and the user hasn't edited it the new version will be
11100 installed (with an informative message). If both have
11101 changed their version the user is prompted about the problem
11102 and must resolve the differences themselves.
11103 </p>
11106 The comparisons are done by calculating the MD5 message
11107 digests of the files, and storing the MD5 of the file as it
11108 was included in the most recent version of the package.
11109 </p>
11112 When a package is installed for the first time
11113 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will install the file that comes with it,
11114 unless that would mean overwriting a file already on the
11115 file system.
11116 </p>
11119 However, note that <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will <em>not</em>
11120 replace a conffile that was removed by the user (or by a
11121 script). This is necessary because with some programs a
11122 missing file produces an effect hard or impossible to
11123 achieve in another way, so that a missing file needs to be
11124 kept that way if the user did it.
11125 </p>
11128 Note that a package should <em>not</em> modify a
11129 <prgn>dpkg</prgn>-handled conffile in its maintainer
11130 scripts. Doing this will lead to <prgn>dpkg</prgn> giving
11131 the user confusing and possibly dangerous options for
11132 conffile update when the package is upgraded.</p>
11133 </sect>
11135 <sect><heading>Fully-featured maintainer script configuration
11136 handling
11137 </heading>
11140 For files which contain site-specific information such as
11141 the hostname and networking details and so forth, it is
11142 better to create the file in the package's
11143 <prgn>postinst</prgn> script.
11144 </p>
11147 This will typically involve examining the state of the rest
11148 of the system to determine values and other information, and
11149 may involve prompting the user for some information which
11150 can't be obtained some other way.
11151 </p>
11154 When using this method there are a couple of important
11155 issues which should be considered:
11156 </p>
11159 If you discover a bug in the program which generates the
11160 configuration file, or if the format of the file changes
11161 from one version to the next, you will have to arrange for
11162 the postinst script to do something sensible - usually this
11163 will mean editing the installed configuration file to remove
11164 the problem or change the syntax. You will have to do this
11165 very carefully, since the user may have changed the file,
11166 perhaps to fix the very problem that your script is trying
11167 to deal with - you will have to detect these situations and
11168 deal with them correctly.
11169 </p>
11172 If you do go down this route it's probably a good idea to
11173 make the program that generates the configuration file(s) a
11174 separate program in <file>/usr/sbin</file>, by convention called
11175 <file><var>package</var>config</file> and then run that if
11176 appropriate from the post-installation script. The
11177 <tt><var>package</var>config</tt> program should not
11178 unquestioningly overwrite an existing configuration - if its
11179 mode of operation is geared towards setting up a package for
11180 the first time (rather than any arbitrary reconfiguration
11181 later) you should have it check whether the configuration
11182 already exists, and require a <tt>--force</tt> flag to
11183 overwrite it.</p></sect>
11184 </appendix>
11186 <appendix id="pkg-alternatives"><heading>Alternative versions of
11187 an interface - <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn> (from old
11188 Packaging Manual)
11189 </heading>
11192 When several packages all provide different versions of the
11193 same program or file it is useful to have the system select a
11194 default, but to allow the system administrator to change it
11195 and have their decisions respected.
11196 </p>
11199 For example, there are several versions of the <prgn>vi</prgn>
11200 editor, and there is no reason to prevent all of them from
11201 being installed at once, each under their own name
11202 (<prgn>nvi</prgn>, <prgn>vim</prgn> or whatever).
11203 Nevertheless it is desirable to have the name <tt>vi</tt>
11204 refer to something, at least by default.
11205 </p>
11208 If all the packages involved cooperate, this can be done with
11209 <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn>.
11210 </p>
11213 Each package provides its own version under its own name, and
11214 calls <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn> in its postinst to
11215 register its version (and again in its prerm to deregister
11216 it).
11217 </p>
11220 See the man page <manref name="update-alternatives"
11221 section="8"> for details.
11222 </p>
11225 If <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn> does not seem appropriate
11226 you may wish to consider using diversions instead.</p>
11227 </appendix>
11229 <appendix id="pkg-diversions"><heading>Diversions - overriding a
11230 package's version of a file (from old Packaging Manual)
11231 </heading>
11234 It is possible to have <prgn>dpkg</prgn> not overwrite a file
11235 when it reinstalls the package it belongs to, and to have it
11236 put the file from the package somewhere else instead.
11237 </p>
11240 This can be used locally to override a package's version of a
11241 file, or by one package to override another's version (or
11242 provide a wrapper for it).
11243 </p>
11246 Before deciding to use a diversion, read <ref
11247 id="pkg-alternatives"> to see if you really want a diversion
11248 rather than several alternative versions of a program.
11249 </p>
11252 There is a diversion list, which is read by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>,
11253 and updated by a special program <prgn>dpkg-divert</prgn>.
11254 Please see <manref name="dpkg-divert" section="8"> for full
11255 details of its operation.
11256 </p>
11259 When a package wishes to divert a file from another, it should
11260 call <prgn>dpkg-divert</prgn> in its preinst to add the
11261 diversion and rename the existing file. For example,
11262 supposing that a <prgn>smailwrapper</prgn> package wishes to
11263 install a wrapper around <file>/usr/sbin/smail</file>:
11264 <example>
11265 dpkg-divert --package smailwrapper --add --rename \
11266 --divert /usr/sbin/smail.real /usr/sbin/smail
11267 </example> The <tt>--package smailwrapper</tt> ensures that
11268 <prgn>smailwrapper</prgn>'s copy of <file>/usr/sbin/smail</file>
11269 can bypass the diversion and get installed as the true version.
11270 It's safe to add the diversion unconditionally on upgrades since
11271 it will be left unchanged if it already exists, but
11272 <prgn>dpkg-divert</prgn> will display a message. To suppress that
11273 message, make the command conditional on the version from which
11274 the package is being upgraded:
11275 <example>
11276 if [ upgrade != "$1" ] || dpkg --compare-versions "$2" lt 1.0-2; then
11277 dpkg-divert --package smailwrapper --add --rename \
11278 --divert /usr/sbin/smail.real /usr/sbin/smail
11280 </example> where <tt>1.0-2</tt> is the version at which the
11281 diversion was first added to the package. Running the command
11282 during abort-upgrade is pointless but harmless.
11283 </p>
11286 The postrm has to do the reverse:
11287 <example>
11288 if [ remove = "$1" -o abort-install = "$1" -o disappear = "$1" ]; then
11289 dpkg-divert --package smailwrapper --remove --rename \
11290 --divert /usr/sbin/smail.real /usr/sbin/smail
11292 </example> If the diversion was added at a particular version, the
11293 postrm should also handle the failure case of upgrading from an
11294 older version (unless the older version is so old that direct
11295 upgrades are no longer supported):
11296 <example>
11297 if [ abort-upgrade = "$1" ] && dpkg --compare-versions "$2" lt 1.0-2; then
11298 dpkg-divert --package smailwrapper --remove --rename \
11299 --divert /usr/sbin/smail.real /usr/sbin/smail
11301 </example> where <tt>1.02-2</tt> is the version at which the
11302 diversion was first added to the package. The postrm should not
11303 remove the diversion on upgrades both because there's no reason to
11304 remove the diversion only to immediately re-add it and since the
11305 postrm of the old package is run after unpacking so the removal of
11306 the diversion will fail.
11307 </p>
11310 Do not attempt to divert a file which is vitally important for
11311 the system's operation - when using <prgn>dpkg-divert</prgn>
11312 there is a time, after it has been diverted but before
11313 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> has installed the new version, when the file
11314 does not exist.</p>
11315 </appendix>
11317 </book>
11318 </debiandoc>
11319 <!-- Local variables: -->
11320 <!-- indent-tabs-mode: t -->
11321 <!-- End: -->
11322 <!-- vim:set ai et sts=2 sw=2 tw=76: -->